~ oe eet oro’? er tr lr \ my ) Lal . oe hy : whe Pa A AS: \ ‘ ' 1 ‘ wetap oe hy Hee ty: Ya - 7 . ) La ; oat | } “ . ' _ ~~. He ’ . vas a . ‘ - . ; : 5 F ‘ : res iio Rent Ene aj ET a oe : Ate a ete ’ * + norl ' ' } oe ; - seated esera at ‘ ase ‘ Eres 2 ° aad . . are uit s ey big wee dat asks se oot ‘ . < a} a ae ae mart 7 iw Te ' . ” THE JO UR Na OF THE LINNEAN SOCIETY. ZOOLOGY. VOL. XXI. LONDON: SOLD AT THE SOCIETY’S’ APARTMENTS, BURLINGTON HOUSE, AND BY LONGMANS, GREEN, AND CO., AND WILLIAMS AND NORGATE. 1889. Dates of Publication of the several Numbers included in this Volume. No. 126, pp. 1- 60, published Nov. 13, 1886. 5 ie) : es 128, / ” 61 120, 99 Mar. Pall 1887. 129) Syretho--— 4, —- Tune 30, 4 180, 5 15529995 Fever co Si. » 181, ,, 223-266, ,, June 30, 1888. 1 182) ©) 2672308, aM 17, 1869: ” 1 , 803-372, Oct. 24, ,, 3 (With Index and "Titlepage. ) PRINTED BY TAYLOR AND FRANCIS, RED LION COURT, FLEET STREET. Bvt LIST OF PAPERS. ’ Page AnveErson, Dr. Joun, M.D., LL.D., F.R.S., F.LS., F.Z.S., &e. List of Birds, chiefly from the Mergui Archipelago, collected for the Trustees of the Indian Museum .............0..-: 136 Report on the Mammals, Reptiles, and Batrachians, chiefly from the Mergui Archipelago, collected for the Trustees of the Hiei ORSe RIM raya Rake Sad ae eae eR Gee 381 Batss, Henry WALTER, F.R.S., F.LS. On a new Species of Brachyonychus from the Mergui Archipelago 135 BEDDaRD, Frank E., M.A., F.ZS. Report on Annelids from the Mergui Archipelago, collected for the Trustees of the Indian Museum, Calcutta, by Dr. John Anderson, F.R.S., F.L.S., Superintendent of the Museum. (Communicated by Dr. John Anderson, F.R.S., F.L.S.) | LBS ACG be ainda ites dirt Sect Nirtngss SiS San eats. aan 256 BEL, Prof. F. Jurrrery, M.A., Sec. R.M.S. On the Holothurians of the Mergui Archipelago, collected for the Trustees of the Indian Museum, Calcutta, by Dr. John Anderson, F.R.S., F.L.S., Superintendent of the Museum. (Communicated by Dr. John Anderson, F.R.S., F.L.S.) Renter) a vip. < ccoeke ipa cated te oe eee RI: eee oe 2 Or CarpENTER, P. HERBERT, D.Sc., F.R.S., F.L.S., Assistant-Master at Eton College. Report on the Comatule of the Mergui Archipelago, collected for the Trustees of the Indian Museum, Calcutta, by Dr. John Anderson, F.R.S., F.L.S., Superintendent of the Museum. GET a eseNeNG V Meiae ROL," «MMB tatugteeatpny Seatsie tarace 504 1V Page Carter, Henry J., F.R.S. Report on the Marine Sponges, chiefly from King Island in the Mergui Archipelago, collected for the Trustees of the Indian Museum, Calcutta, by Dr. John Anderson, F.R.S., F.LS., Superintendent of the Museum. (Communicated by Dr. John Anderson, F.R.S., F.L.S.) (Plates V.-VIL)...........-+. 61 Duncan, Prof. P. Martin, M.B. (Lond.), F.R.S., F.LS. On the Madreporaria of the Mergui Archipelago, collected for the Trustees of the Indian Museum, Calcutta, by Dr. John Anderson, F.R.S., F.L.S., Superintendent of the Museum. CE llsite ec eaedaieeeucs hee at ts tose pont -< shotemeehe phen volke Gee Oe en i On the Ophiuride of the Mereui Archipelago, collected for the Trustees of the Indian Museum, Calcutta, by Dr. John Anderson, F.R.S., F.L.S., Superintendent of the Museum. (lates Wai, Xe, & Xa digs: 28-A0)) oe ew ene 85 On some Parts of the Anatomy of Ophiothrix variabilis, Dunc., and Ophiocampsis pelicula, Dunc., based on materials fur- nished by the Trustees of the Indian Museum, Calcutta. (Plates XG XE. Tesh 1= 272) We how aan ce eae ee 107 Dunoan, Prof. P. Martin, M.B. (Lond.), F.R.S., F.LS., and W. Percy SiapbeEn, F.G.S., Sec. L.S. On the Echinoidea of the Mergui Archipelago, collected for the Trustees of the Indian Museum, Calcutta, by Dr. John Ander- son, F.R.S8., F.L.S., Superintendent of the Museum ........ 316 Happon, Prof. ALFRED C., M.A., M.R.LA. On two Species of Actiniz from the Mergui Archipelago, col- lected for the Trustees of the Indian Museum, Calcutta, by Dr. John Anderson, F.R.S., F.L.S., Superintendent of the Museum, (Communicated by Dr. John Anderson, F.R.S., K.LS.) (Blates XIX, & XX.) i.5 00: ae acon eee 247 Hincxs, Rey. Tuos., B.A., F.R.S. On the Polyzoa and Hydroida of the Mergui Archipelago, col- lected for the Trustees of the Indian Museum, Calcutta, by Dr. John Anderson, F.R.S., F.L.S., Superintendent of the Museum. (Communicated by Dr. John Anderson, F.R.S., FiL:S.) (Plate DI). eivatiiahats tices eves 6 121 Vv Horx, Dr. P. P. C., Member Royal Academy of Science of the Netherlands, Leiden. On Dichelaspis pellucida, Darwin, from the Scales of an Hydro- phid obtained at Mergui. (Communicated by Dr. John ATIMeTSOM HES, HLS.) Celabe Xe) Fria csr etetotcsete + « MarsHatt, Prof. A. Mitnss, M.A., M.D., F.R.S., and G. HERBERT Fow ter, B.A., Ph.D. Report on the Pennatulida of the Mergui Archipelego, collected for the Trustees of the Indian Museum, Calcutta, by Dr. John Anderson, F.R.S., F.L.S., Superintendent of the Museum. (Communicated by Dr. John Anderson, F.R.S., F.L.S.) (Rates eRe ANON LEIA Sood ewals wales oes =a teratata eas Marrens, Prof. Epuarp von, M.D., C.M.Z.S., of the University of Berlin. List of the Shells of Mergui and its Archipelago, collected for the Trustees of the Indian Museum, Calcutta, by Dr. John Anderson, F.R.S., F.L.S., Superintendent of the Museum. (Communicated by Dr. John Anderson, F.R.S., F.L.S.) GEetie se NOUN ONG VT) ea eio es, rermiedse s cotlslans, ole lenoe © alms Moors, FrEpERIc, A.L.S., F.Z.S. List of the Lepidoptera of Mergui and its Archipelago, collected for the Trustees of the Indian Museum, Calcutta, by Dr. John Anderson, F.R.S., F.L.S., Superintendent of the Museum. esis Le smu er cp EN] s\ier cn ccnctavokalshaletacene) vc + via doksy eRe an a tia Pocock, R. 1, Assistant in the Zoological Department, British Museum. Report on the Myriopoda of the Mereui Archipelago, collected for the Trustees of the Indian Museum, Calcutta, by Dr. John Anderson, F.R.S., F.L.S., Superintendent of the Museum. (Communicated by Dr. John Anderson, F.R.S., F.L.S.) Misiates! MONTY! & XEN .)>..< 2 ths Mieka nitois seamen Riv.ey, Stuart O., M.A., F.L.S., late Assistant in the Zoological Department, British Museum. Report on the Alcyoniid and Gorgoniid Alcyonaria of the Mergui Archipelago, collected for the Trustees of the Indian Museum, Calcutta, by Dr. John Anderson, F.R.S., F.L.S., Superintendent of the Museum, (Plates XVII. & XVII.) Page 154 267 155 29 287 vi Page SELENKA, Prof. Emit. On the Gephyreans of the Mergui Archipelago, collected for the Trustees of the Indian Museum, Calcutta, by Dr. John Anderson, F.R.S., F.L.S., Superintendent of the Museum. (Communicated by Dr. John Anderson, F’.R.S., F.L.S.) .... 220 SLaDEN, W. Percy, F.G.S., Sec. L.S. On the Asteroidea of the Mergui Archipelago, collected for the Trustees of the Indian Museum, Calcutta, by Dr. John Anderson, F.R.S., F.L.S., Superintendent of the Museum. (Blate XOXGVAIIN) ecoys cox, sive exeesehe ofp sues eget aetotn iether ee re 319 Vii EXPLANATION OF THE PLATES. PLATE I. Mapreporarra from Mergui Archipelago. Cucumarta Forsest and C. AssrMizis. Li) III. ‘ Tv, | Lerrworrrra from Mergui Archipelago. A SVE pSvonors from Mergui Archipelago, vu 2 Orniurt# from Mergui Archipelago. “J Srrvucrure of Ophiuride. ei Hyprozoa and Potyzoa from Mergui Archipelago. XIII. Dricneasprs pewtucipa, Darwin. XIV. XV. >} Mottusca from Mergui Archipelago. DOE 18) xv \ AxcyonartA from Mergui Archipelago. Actini& from Mergui Archipelago. =a Anneips from Mergui Archipelago. XXIV al aa \ Pennatuipa from Mergui Archipelago. | Myrropopa from Mergui Archipelago. Poss ComatuL from Mergui Archipelago. XXVIII. AsrerorEA from Mergui Archipelago. Note.—The Crustacea of the Mergui Archipelago are described and figured in Vol. XXII. viii ERRATA. Page 36, line 14 from bottom, for Neptis Hira, Kiel, read Neptis lira, Kheil. 57, first line, for Ennommpa read ENNoMIDA. 57, line 2 from bottom, for Briada reliquenda read Briarda reliquenda. 59, line 4 from bottom, for Botys rutilatis read Botys rutilalis. 140, line 11 from bottom, for Hypothornis azurea read Hypothymis azurea. THE JOURNAL OF THE LINNEAN SOCIETY. On the Madreporaria of the Mergui Archipelago collected for the Trustees of the Indian Museum, Calcutta, by Dr. John Anderson, F.R.S., Superintendent of the Museum. By Prof. P. Martin Duncan, M.B. (Lond.), F.RS., F.LS. [Read 18th March, 1886.] (Puate I.) Contents :—Introduction. List of Genera and Species found. List of new Species. Description of the new Species. Remarks; and the Affinities of the Coral-fauna of Mergui. Description of Plate. Introduction. Tue Madreporaria which are classified and in part described in this communication were personally collected by Dr. Anderson in the Mergui Archipelago off the coast of Tenasserim. The collection is very interesting on account of the numerous species which it contains and of their alliances with the forms of the Coral-faunas of the Red Sea, of Ceylon, of the Eastern Archipelago, and of the Central-American coast. The facies of the large collec- tion of 84 determinable species is stamped and characterized by the presence of numerous encrusting species, and by the evidence that even some of the species of the reef-building genus Madrepora appear to have grown under unfavourable conditions. Encrusting species of genera, hitherto known as freely growing, occur, and many species which are recognized without difficulty in more LINN. JOURN.—ZOOLOGY, VOL. XXI. 1 2 PROF. P. M. DUNCAN ON THE MADREPORARIA vigorously growing faunas, are represented at Mergui by varieties which have given me much trouble in their classification. This difficulty was intensified on account of the predominance in the fauna of such large and therefore very variable genera as Mussa, Meandrina (Celoria), Symphylha, Favia, and Goniastrea. Several species which were described by MM. Milne-Edwards and Jules Haime, the habitats of which were not known to them, are recognized at Mergui. The following is the list of genera and species constituting the fauna. List of Genera and Species. MADREPORARIA APOROSA. 29. Favia tubulifera, Klunz, ; 30. cavernosa, Forskal, sp. Family Tursinotipz. 31. —— Geoffroyi (Val.), Ed. § H. 1. Paracyathus Andersoni, sp. nov. 32. Goniastrea favus, Forsk., sp.,and 2: profundus, sp. nov. variety. 3. —— indicus, sp. nov. 33. retiformis, Lmk., sp. 4, cruleus, sp. NOV. 34, —— Bournoni, Ed. § H. 5 merguiensis, sp. Nov. 30. halicora, Hemp. § Ehr., sp., 6, Polycyathus Verrilli, sp. noy. and variety. 7. difficilis, sp. nov, 36. —— incrustans, sp. nov. 37. Heliastrea (Ulastreea) crispata, Family Pocinioporipz, Dune, Imk., sp. é : 38. Phymastrea irregularis, Dune. 8. Pocillopora czespitosa, Dana. 39 aspera, Quelch ; hi ; ) ate : 9. favosa, Ehr. 40. Solenastreea (Quelchia) spongi- . formis, sp. nov. peraiilly ASTD, 41. Plesiastreea ae Verrill, 10. Mussa cristata, H’sper, sp. variety. 11. flexuosa, Hd. & H. 42. Hchinopora aspera, Solander, sp. 12. corymbosa, Forskdl, sp. 43. Leptastrza humilis, sp. nov. 13. Huphyllia striata, Hd. § H., sp. 44, Galaxea irregularis, Ld, §& ., sp. 14. rugosa, Dana. 45, Prionastrea abdita, Solander, 15. —— plicata, Ed. & H. sp. 16. Mzeandrina (Ceeloria) dedalea, 46. vasta, Klunz. Solander, sp. 47. robusta, Dana, sp. 17. —— (C.) Hsperi, Hd. § H., sp. 48. Merulina ampliata, Solander, sp. 18. ——(C.) astreiformis, Ed. ¢ H., | 49. ramosa, Hhr. sp. 19. —— (C.) labyrinthiformis, Zinn., s p. MADREPORARIA FUNGIDA. 20. Brachymeandrina _pachychila, Family Puestoruneipm, Dune. Lhr., sp. 21. Symphyllia grandis, Kd. § H. 50. Siderastrea radians, Pallas, sp., 22 recta, Dana, sp. yariety pulchella=S. pul- 23. —— (lsophyllia) erythrza, chella, Hd. §& H. Klunz., sp. 24. Hydnophora microcona, Lmk., Family Funes. sp: 25. Tridacophyllia lactuca, Pallas, 51. Fungia crassa, Dana. sp. 52. dentata, Dana. 26. Favia Ehrenbergi, Klunz., var. | 53. patella, Solander, sp. laticollis, Klunz. 54. ——- glans, Dana? 27, —— Okeni, Hd. § H. 55. —— (Haliglossa) echinata, 28. —— Rousseaui, Ed. § H., sp, Pallas, sp. OF THE MERGUI ARCHIPELAGO. 56. Halomitra (Podabacia) crus- Family Mapreporips. tacea, Hd. § H. we 57. Oryptabacia talpina, Zmk., sp. 69. Madrepora gracilis, Ed. § H. 58. Herpolitha limax, Esper, sp. 70. valida, Dana. (le surculosa, Dana, Family Lornosrrip 2. 72. —— hebes, Dana. 59. Lophoseris cristata, Solander, sp. Vera BIE adel UE 60. cactus, Hemp. § Ehr., sp. ia Mec ligera, v i a 61. Pachyseris speciosa, Dana, sp. 6) ies Pee OE 62. Coscinarea mxandrina, Hhr., sp. 76 spicifera, Dana. 63 monile, Forskiil, sp 77. Turbinaria cinerascens, Solan- z 4 are der, sp. Family Purstoporitipx, Dune. 78 erater, Pallas, sp. 64. Meeandroseris Botte, Rouss. MADREPORARIA PERFORATA. . Family Portrip2. Family HupsamMips. 65. Balanophyllia merguiensis, 79. Porites conglomerata, Quoy & sp. nov. Gaim., variety. 66. Dendrophyllia coarctata, sp. 80. —— nodifera, Klhinz. nov. 81. excavata, Verrill. 67. —— (Cceenopsammia) affinis, 82. Synarza lutea, Verrill. Sp. nov. 83. Goniopora columna, Dana. 68. Astropsammia Pedersoni, Verrill. lobata, Ed. & A. Indeterminable Species of the Genera :— Heliastrea. Aphrastrea. Astropora. Fungia. New Species :— Paracyathus Andersoni. profundus. indicus. —— ceruleus. merguiensis. Polycyathus Verrilli. — difficilis. Goniastrea incrustans. Solenastrzea (Quelchia) spongiformis. (Plate I. figs. 23, 24.) (Plate I. figs. 25, 26.) (Plate I. figs. 27, 28.) (Plate I. figs. 29, 30.) Leptastrea humilis. Balanophyllia merguiensis. Dendrophyllia coarctata. —— (Cenopsammia) affinis. (Plate I. figs. 1-3.) (Plate I. figs. 4-6.) (Plate I. figs. 7-9.) (Plate I. figs. 10, 11.) (Plate I. figs. 12-14.) (Plate I. figs. 15, 16.) (Plate I. figs. 17, 18.) (Plate I. figs. 19, 20.) (Plate I. figs. 21, 22.) Description of the new Species. Section MADREPORARIA APOROSA, Ed. & H. Family TURBINOLIDA, Ed. & H. Genus Paracyaruus, Hd. & H. PaRAcYATHUS ANDERSONI, sp. nov. .(Plate I. figs. 1-3.) The corallum is short, has a slightly compressed, broad base, 1* 4: PROF. P. M. DUNCAN ON THE MADREPORARIA above which there is some constriction, and a compressed ellip- tical calice. The calice is deep, broad at the margin, where the longer axis is on a slightly lower plane than the shorter. The septa are in nearly complete five cycles, slightly and unequally exsert, unequal in breadth, close, projecting outwards slightly at the margin, and only the primaries and secondaries projecting much into the calice. First three cycles nearly equal in size; the septa of the fourth cycle of a half-system unite with the ter- tiary, and the highest orders may unite with the fourth and fifth higher up in the calice. All are sharply spinulose at the sides, and the larger septa have plain and lobed margins, the others being crenulated. ‘The pali of the primaries and secondaries are bilobed, rounded, and the upper lobe is large ; those of the ter- tiaries and combined orders are smaller, much subdivided, and stout. The columella is small, deeply seated, concave, papillose, and the outer processes resemble the small pali. Coste sub- equal, broad, low, large in relation to the smaller septa, and minutely granulated ; some project near the calice. Height 12°5 millim.; breadth of calice 10 millim., length 14 millim. The septaare coloured brown. Locality, Mergui Archi- pelago. PARACYATHUS PROFUNDUS, sp. nov. (Plate I. figs. 4-6.) The corallum is short with a broad adherent base, above which there is aslight constriction, very slightly compressed at the sides, and the calice equal to the base in diameter. Calice elliptical, deep and open ; marginal planes on the same level. Septa unequal, very crowded, in incomplete five cycles, very slightly exsert and not projecting much into the calice. The fourth and fifth orders unite with the tertiaries near the columella, and all are spinulose at the sides, and the larger are lobed. Pali of the larger septa trilobed and large, and those of the tertiaries are stout, numerous, and crenulated. Columella deep, concave; papilla numerous and ragged and united at their bases. Coste subequal, large, broad, granular, and with marked grooves between them near the calice and less so lower down. Height 7 millim.; length of calice 11 millim., breadth of calice 10 millim. The dry corallum has the septa, pali, and columella of a brown colour, the rest being white. Locality, Mergui Archipelago. OF THE MERGUI ARCHIPELAGO. 5 PARACYATHUS INDICUS, sp. nov. (Plate I. figs. 7-9.) The corallum is short, has a very expanded base with a consider- able constriction above it: an elliptical calice, the long diameter of which is on a lower plane than the shorter and as long as the base is broad. Calice elliptical, deep, margin curved upwards at the sides, and a slight downward curve at the extremities. Septa numerous, unequal, in five cycles, all exsert at the margin, and most of them overhanging slightly. The fourth and fifth orders unite with the tertiaries not far from the columella, and the highest orders unite with the fourth and fifth not far from the margin. The edges of the primaries and secondaries are thin and boldly curved convexity towards the fossa, the tertiaries are less bowed, and the other orders have straighter or slightly wavy edges ; but all are boldly crenulated with paliform edges. The sides of the septa are spinulose. Pali small and in one lobe before the pri- maries and secondaries, and resembling an outer papilla of the columella before the tertiaries. The columella is deep, elongate, concave, and consists of many processes united and resembling the smaller pali. The coste are small, nearly equal, rounded, barely projecting, and sparsely and minutely granular. Length of calice 14 millim., breadth 10 millim., height 12 millim. The primaries and secondaries are exsert to the height of 2 millim. Locality, Mergui Archipelago. PARACYATHUS CHRULEUS, sp. nov. (Plate I. figs. 10-11.) The corallum is low with a broad base, a much constricted stem, and a large shallow elliptical calice with a slightly everted margin, and with marginal axes nearly in the same plane. Septa in incomplete five cycles, very unequal, the primaries, secondaries, and tertiaries being exsert; none project much into the widely open calice. The sides of the septa are roughly and largely papillose. The pali are variable in number, those before — the first orders are double, one high and narrow and rounded, *the other small or absent. The pali before the combined higher orders are usually in multiple series. Columella very large, con- cave, processes numerous and united, the outer not to be distin- guished from pali. Coste low, subequal, narrow, and distinctly granular. Height of corallum 8 millim.; length of calice 12 millim., breadth 9 millim. The colour of the septa, columella, and pali is blue; the cost usually dull white, some are brown. Locality, Mergui Archipelago. 6 PROF. P. M. DUNCAN ON THE MADREPORARIA PARACYATHUS MERGUIENSIS, Sp. nov. (Plate I. figs. 12-14.) The corallum has a broad expanded base and a narrower calice, the stem constricted, otherwise cylindrical, and taller than broad. The calice is elliptical, very deep, and the columella is small, con- cave, with small and crowded processes. The septa are in five incomplete cycles, slightly exsert, unequal, crowded, and project- ing into the calice ; spinulose at the sides. The pali are single, and often tall, before the secondaries and primaries, and are small and nodular; those before the tertiaries are numerous and tall, and some are like twisted open lamelle. The coste are large, subequal, broad, and marked with granules. Height of corallum 8°5 millim., breadth of calice 6°5 millim., length of calice 8 millim. The septa, pali, and columella are of an intense Prussian-blue colour. Locality, Mergui Archipelago. Subfamily TURBINOLID# REPTANTES, Dunc. (Revision of Genera §c., Journ. Linn. Soc., Zool. vol. xvii. p. 34). Genus Potycyatuts, Dune. op. cit. p. 34. Potycyatuus VERRILLI, sp. nov. (Plate I. figs. 15, 16.) The colony covers about 10 square inches, the corallites are variously spaced, rarely very close, small, cylindrical, short, and their coste pass over the basal structure, which is minutely granular. The calices are widely open, circular, or slightly wavy in marginal outline. Septa slightly exsert, unequal, sharply granular at the sides, extending like a circular zone inwards, and surrounding the narrow, deep, circular fossa; rarely with four cycles, usually with three and a few of the fourth order, or only three cycles. Coste faint on some corallites, well seen on others, much broader relatively than the septa, low, nearly equal, but those of the primaries and secondaries may project near to the margin; they traverse much or all the space between the coral- lites, or they may not pass far. Epitheca pellicular and granular. There are pali before all septa except those of the last cycle, or they may exist before all the septa in some calices with three cycles of septa; broadest before the secondaries. The pali reach well into the “zone” of septa. Columella small, deep, con- cave, papillose. Height of ordinary corallites 2-25 to 3 millim., width of calice 2 to 2°5 millim.; distance between corallites 2 to 4 millim. Locality, Mergui Archipelago, encrusting. OF THE MERGUI AROILIPELAGO. 7 PoLYCYATHUS DIFFICILIS, sp. nov. (Plate I. figs. 17, 18.) The colony covers considerable space and encrusts ; the coral- lites are short, cylindrical, crowded in places, distant in others, broadest at the calice. Calice circular in outline. Septain three cycles, the tertiaries uniting with the secondaries ; the prima- ries are the larger and are slightly exsert, and all are granular at the sides; they are unequal in size, and project into the calice, and have trifid spinules on the edges. Columella small, concave, and formed by little processes united at their bases. Pali small and short, often indistinct, small before the primaries and larger before the secondaries and nearer the calicular edge. The coste are large, broad, subequal, and reach over the basal structure more or less, distinct, close, and sometimes curved or bent suddenly, much broader than the septa. A granular epitheca. Much of the basal structure is non-costulate, but is granular. Height of corallites 2-3 millim., breadth of calices 2-3 millim. Locality, Mergui Archipelago. Family PoctnLopoRrip&, Dune. (Rev. p. 46). Genus Pocrtttopora, Lmk., pars. PocILLOPORA C#SPITOSA. Pocillopora czspitosa, Dana, U. S. Expl. Exped., Zooph. vol. vii. p. 525, pl. 49. figs. 5, 5a, 1846. Locality, King Island Bay. PocrILLOPORA FAVOSA. Pocillopora favosa, Ehrenberg, Abhandl. d. Akad. Berl, (1832) p. 351 1834. Locality, Sullivan Island. Family ASTR#ID &. Genus Mussa, Oken. Mussa CRISTATA. Madrepora cristata?, Esper, Pflanz. t. i. p. 150, Madr. p. 226, 1791. Mussa cristata, Ed. § H. Hist. Nat. des Corall. t. u. p. 335, 1857. Locality, Elphinstone Island, below low-water mark. Moussa FLEXUOSA. Mussa flexuosa, Ed. § H. Ann. des Sc. Nat. 3 sér. t. xi. p. 952, 1849. Locality, King Island Bay, 8 PROF. P. M. DUNCAN ON THE MADREPORARIA Mussa CORYMBOSA. Madrepora corymbosa, Forskal, An. in terr. Orient. p. 137, 1775. Mussa corymbosa, Dana, op. cit. p. 177. Locality, Elphinstone Island. Genus Evenyii1, Hd. f A. KUPHYLLIA STRIATA. Leptosmilia striata, Ed. § H. Ann. des Sc. Nat. 3 sér. t. x. p. 269, 1849. Euphyllia striata, Hd. § H. Hist. Nat. des Corall.t. i. p. 194, pl. D 2. fic. 1, 1857. Locality, King Island Bay. EUPHYLLIA RUGOSA. Euphyllia rugosa, Dana, op. cit. p. 166. Locality, King Island Bay. EUPHYLLIA PLICATA. Euphyllia plicata, Ed. § H. op. cit. p. 195. Locality, King Island Bay. Genus Mmanprina, Hd. & H. Subgenus Catorta, (genus) Hd. & H. Mmanprina (C@LORIA) DADALEA. Madrepora deedalea, Ellis & Solander, Hist. of Zooph. p. 163, pl. 46. figs. 1 & 2, 1786. Cceloria deedalea, Ed. & H. Pol. foss. des terr. paléoz. ete. p. 93, 1831. Locality, Mergui Archipelago. Mmanprina (Ca@torta) EsPErt. Astoria Esperi, Ed. § H. Ann. des Sc. Nat. 3 sév. t. xi. p. 298, 1849. Ceeloria Esperi, Ed. § H. Hist. Nat. des Corall. t. ui. p. 417. Locality, Mergui Archipelago. Manprina (C@LORIA) ASTREIFORMIS. Astoria astreiformis, Ed. § H. Ann. des Sc. Nat. 3 sé. t. xi. p. 299, 1849. Ceeloria astreiformis, Ed. § H. Hist. Nat. des Corall. t. ii. p. 417, 1857. Locality, King Island Bay. Mmanprina (C@LORIA) LABYRINTHIFORMIS. Madrepora labyrinthiformis (pars), Linn. Syst. Nat. ed. x. p. 194, 1758. Ceeloria labyrinthiformis, Ed. § H. op. cit. t. ii. p. 412, 1857. Locality, Sullivan Island. OF THE MERGUI ARCHIPELAGO. 9 Genus BrachyM#ANDRINA, Dune. op. cit. p. 90. BRACHYMEANDRINA PACHYCHILA. Platygyra labyrinthica, var. pachychila, Ehrenb. Abhand. Akad. zu Berlin, 1832, p. 323, 1834. Ceeloria pachychila, Klunz. Korallth. des Rothen Meeres, Bd. iii. p. 15, Taf. 1. fig. 6, 1879. Locality, Mergui Archipelago. Genus Sympnyiiia, Ld. & H. SYMPHYLLIA GRANDIS. Symphyllia grandis, Ed. § H. Ann. des Sc. Nat. 3 sér. t. xi. p. 255, 1849. Locality, Mergui Archipelago. SyMPHYLLIA RECTA. Mussa recta, Dana, Zooph. p. 186, pl. 8. fig. 11, 1846. Locality, Mergui Archipelago. SYMPHYLLIA (ISOPHYLLIA) ERYTHREA. Isophyllia erythrea, Klunz. op. cit. p. 10, Taf. i. fig. 10, & Taf. ix. fig. 9. Locality, Mergui Archipelago. Genus Hypnornora, Ed. & H. HYDNOPHORA MICROCONA. Monticularia microconus, Lamarck, Hist. Anim. s. Vert. t. ii. p. 251, 1816; 2 édit. p. 293. Hydnophora microconus, Ed. § H. Ann. des Sc. Nat. 3 sér. t. xi. p. 302, 1849. Locality, Sullivan Island. Genus Tripacopuyiita, Blainv. TRIDACOPHYLLIA LACTUCA. Madrepora lactuca, Pallas, Elench. Zooph. p. 281, 1766. Tridacophyllia lactuea, Dana, op. cit. p. 195. Locality, King Island Bay. Genus Favra, Oken. Favia ERRENBERGI, var. LATICOLLIS. Favia Ehrenbergi, var. laticollis, Klunz. op. cit. p. 29, Taf. iii. fig. 7. Locality, Sullivan Island. 10 PROF. P. M. DUNCAN ON THE MADREPORARIA Favia OXKENT. ' Fayia Okeni, Ed. & H. Hist. Nat. des Corall. t. ii. Be 430, 1857. Locality, King Island Bay. Favia RovssEavl. Parastrea Rousseaui, Ed. & H. Ann. des Sc. Nat. 3 sér. t. xii. p. 168, 1850. Favia Rousseaui, Ed. § H. Hist. Nat. des Corall. t. 11. p. 429, 1857. Locality, Mergui Archipelago. Favia TUBULIFERA. Favia tubulifera, Klunz. op. cit. p. 28, Taf. i. fig. 6, & Taf. x. fig. 2. Locality, King Island Bay. FAaviA CAVERNOSA. Madrepora cavernosa, Forskal, Desc. Anim. Sc. que in terr. orient. observ. p. 132, 1775. Locality, King Island Bay. Favia GEOFFROYI. Favia Geoffroyi, Val. MS., in Ed. & H. op. cit. t. 11. p. 433, 1857. Locality, King Island Bay. Genus Gontastrma, Hd. f H. GONIASTREA FAVUS. Madrepora favus, Forskal, op. cit. p. 132, 1775. Goniastrea favus, Klunz. op. cit. pt. il. p. 3d, Lake iv. fig. 4, & Taf. x. fig. 7. Locality, Mergui Archipelago. A variety. Locality, Mergui Archipelago. GoNIASTRHA RETIFORMIS. Astrea retiformis, Lamk. Hist. Anin. s. Vert. t. ii. p. 265, 1816; 2 édit. p. 415. Goniastrea retiformis, Ed. § H. Ann. des Sc. Nat. 3 sér. t. xii. p. 161, 1850; Klunz. op. cit. pt. ui. p. 36, Taf. iv. fig. 5. Locality, Mergui Archipelago. GontastrzA Bournont. Goniastrzea Bournoni Ed. § H. Ann. des Sc. Nat. 3 séx. t. xii. p. 162, 1850. Locality, Mergui Archipelago. OF THE MERGUI ARCHIPELAGO. ia GoNIASTRHA HALICORA. Astrzea halicora, Hemp. § Ehr. Abhandl. Akad. Berl. 1832, p. 321. Prionastreea halicora, Ed. § H. Hist. Nat. des Corall. t. i. p. 517. Goniastrea halicora, Klunz. op. cit. pt. iii. p. 33, Taf. iv. fig. ], & Taf. x. fig. 3a & b. Locality, King Island Bay. A variety. Locality, King Island Bay. GoNIASTRHA INCRUSTANS, sp. nov. (Plate I. figs. 19, 20.) The colony is large, swollen and gibbous above, and has a thin edge, where an epitheca of a basal nature is seen. Encrusting old corals and parts of dead individuals of the same species. Calices very variable in shape and size, generally irregularly hexagonal, often elongate, and some are more simple than hexa- gonal, with a large crown of pali. Shallow as a rule, but many are deep; united to the neighbouring corallites by sharp ridges at the surface or by decidedly broad ones ; in some parts there is a delicate line or furrow on the broad ridge over which the septa do not pass. Septa extremely variable in number, but the complete fifth cycle is not present. The distinction between the cycles is not possible, and the long and larger are separated by smaller and shorter septa ; hence the arrangement is alternate, and this is found in small calices as well as in large. The septa are rather crowded, alternately large and small, and project but slightly from the wall, are straight, and sharply and minutely granular at the free edge. The pali form a very large crown, and encircle a deep and small columellary space ; they are before nearly all the longer septa, and are often broader and higher than the septal ends, and are boldly arched and minutely granular. As the septal number of neighbouring calices is never the same, so the size of the crown of . pali varies greatly. In some large calices where there are forty-eight septa the pali are before the large twenty-four septa, and then it may occur that those opposite the tertiaries are smaller than the others and bend towards them. But this arrangement does not always occur. Size of the calices has not everything to do with the dimensions of the crown of pali, for neighbouring calices exist of the same size, and in one there are not so many septa as the size would appear to warrant and the pali are diminished in number. In some recently formed corallites the septa are slender and there are no pali; these occur near the margin of the 12 PROF. P. M. DUNCAN ON THE MADREPORARIA colony. Fissiparous division occurs, and it is evident that it is the usual method of increase, but gemmation from the basal epitheca seems to happen. Columella deeply seated and very small. Length of the colony 24 centim., breadth 14; height of the encrusting mass less than 10 millim. Diameter of calices from 3 millim. with forty septa, 5 millim. of the same septal number, 8 millim. with fifty-six septa. Locality, Mergui Archipelago. Genus Hertastrma, Hd. & H. Subgenus Unastrma, Hd. § H. HeLIAsTR#A (ULASTRHA) CRISPATA. Astrea crispata, Lamk. Hist. Anim. s. Vert. t. ii. p. 265, 1816; 2 édit. p. 416. Ulastrza crispata, Ed. & H. Ann. des Sc. Nat. 3 sér. t. x. pl. 9. fig. 4, et t. x. p. 116, 1850. Locality, Mergui Archipelago. Genus Puymastrma, Hd. & H. PHYMASTRHA IRREGULARIS. Phymastrea irregularis, Dunc. Proc. Zool. Soc. 1883, p. 406. Locality, King Island Bay. PHYMASTREA ASPERA. Phymastrea aspera, Quelch, Report on ‘Challenger’ Reef-building Corals, p. 105. Locality, King Island Bay. Genus SoLtenastrmA, Hd. & H., Amended, Dunc. Rev. Fam. § Gen. p. 107. Subgenus QuEtcuta. Solenastreans sometimes increasing by fissiparity. SoLENASTRHA (QUELCHIA) SPONGIFORMIs, sp. nov. (Plate I. figs. 21, 22.) The colony is tuberose, taller than broad, more or less sub- cylindrical, rounded above and narrower at the attached base. Calices numerous, circular, and slightly raised at the margin, separated by varying amounts of cellular coenenchyma, which is minutely and sharply spinulose, the spinules being short, slender, jagged, and with from one to four thorny endings. Calicular fossa deep and narrow. The septa are twenty in number, ten OF THE MERGUI ARCHIPELAGO. 13 large and ten very small, broadest at the margin and slender within, the larger exsert and the smaller very incised at the free inner edge, all granular at the sides. Coste larger than the septa, and rarely extending far from the calicular margin. Columella small and deeply seated, composed of a few trabecule. Endotheca scanty. Gemmation frequent, and from the ccenen- chyma, one part of a bud being close toa calice. Fissiparous calices occasional, large. Height of colony 45 millim., breadth 30 millim.; breadth of cealices 1°5 to 2 millim. Locality, Mergui Archipelago. Genus Prestastrma, Hd. J H. PLESIASTRHA INDURATA. Plesiastrzea indurata, Verrill, Proc. Essex Inst. ser. 2, v. p. 36, 1867. A variety. Locality, King Island Bay. Genus Ecutnopora, pars, Dana. ECHINOPORA ASPERA. Madrepora aspera, Ellis § Solander, Hist. of Zooph. p. 156, pl. 39, 1786. Echinopora aspera, Dana, U.S. Expl. Exped., Zooph., vol. vii. p. 281, 1846. Locality, King Island Bay. Genus Leprastrma, Hd. § H. LEPTASTREA HUMILIS, sp. nov. (Plate I. figs. 23, 24.) The colony is low, gibbous and encrusting, covering a consi- derable surface. The corallites are small and short, close, closely united near the base by the fused walls, but separate slightly above, so that the margins of the calices are close but not joined, there not being any coste in the interval. Calices variable in size and shape, rarely circular, widely open, and having a narrow and deep fossa. Septa in three cycles, with orders of the fourth; primaries the largest, entire above and dentated within; secon- daries decidedly less exsert than the primaries; the septa of the fourth and fifth orders small. Columella deeply seated, very small. Endotheca well developed. Increase by gemmation from the marginal calices of the colony. Height of corallites 9-10 millim:, breadth of calices 2-4 millim. Locality, Mergui Archipelago. 14 PROF. P. M. DUNCAN ON THE MADREPORARIA Genus GALAxEA, Oken. GALAXEA IRREGULARIS. Sarcinula irregularis, Ed. 6 H. Ann. des Sci. Nat. 3 sér. t. x. p. 316, 1848. Galaxea irregularis, Ed. § H. Pal. foss. des terr. paléoz. Sc. p. 71, 1851. Locality, Mergui Archipelago. Genus Prionastrm, Hd. f H. PRIONASTRHA ABDITA. Madrepora abdita, Hillis & Solander, op. cit. p. 319. Prionastrea abdita, Ed. § H. Ann. des Sc. Nat. 3 sér. t. xii. p. 128, 1850. Localities, King Island Bay and Sullivan Island. PRIONASTRHA VASTA. Prionastreea vasta, Klunz. Korallih. des Rothen Meeres, pt. ii. p. 38, Taf. iv. figs. 12 & 8 (var. superficialis), Taf. x. fig. 4 a & 6 (Durchschnitte). Locality, King Island Bay. PRIONASTRHA ROBUSTA. Astrea robusta, Dana, op. cit. p. 248, pl. 13, fig. 10. Prionastra robusta, Ed. & H. Hist. Nat. des Corall. t. ii. p. 525. Locality, Mergui Archipelago. Genus Meruuina, Ehr. MERULINA AMPLIATA. Madrepora ampliata, Ellis § Solander, op. cit. p. 157, pl. 41. figs. 1 & 2. Merulina ampliata, Ehr. Corall. des Roth. Meer. p. 104, 1834. Locality, Elphinstone Island. MERULINA RAMOSA. Merulina ramosa, Ehr. in Ed. § H. Ann. des Se. Nat. 3 sér. t. xv. p. 144, 1851. Locality, Elphinstone Island. Section MADREPORARIA FUNGIDA. Family PLESIOFUNGID&, Dune. Revision, p. 133. Genus SIDERASTRmHA, Blainv. SIDERASTRHA RADIANS. Madrepora radians, Pallas, Elench. Zooph. p. 322, 1766. Siderastrea galaxea, Ed. § H. Ann. des Sc. Nat. xii. p. 139, 1850. OF THE MERGUL ARCHIPELAGO. 15 Var. PULCHELLA. Astrea pulchella, Ed. § H. Hist. Nat. des Corall. i. p. 507. Locality, Mergui Archipelago. Family FUNGIDz. Genus Funata, Dana, Amended, Dune. Revis. p. 141. FUNGIA CRASSA. Fungia crassa, Dana, op. cit. p. 304, pl. 19. fig. 13. Locality, Elphinstone Island. FUNGIA DENTATA. Fungia dentata, Dana, op. cit. p. 293, pl. 18. fig. 7. Locality, Elphinstone Island. FUNGIA PATELLA. Madrepora patella, Ellis § Solander, op. cit. p. 148, tab. 28. figs. 1-4, 1786. Fungia patella, Ed. § H. Ann. des Sc. Nat. 3 sér. t. xv. p. 77, 1851. Locality, Elphinstone Island. FUNGIA GLANS. Fungia glans, Dana? Locality, Elphinstone Island. Subgenus Hattexnossa, (gen.) Hhr., Dunc. Revis. p. 142. Funera (HaLigLossa) ECHINATA. Madrepora echinata, Pallas, Elench. Zooph. p. 284, 1766. Haliglossa echinata, Klunz. op. cit. pt. iil. p. 67. Locality, Elphinstone Island. Genus Hatomitrra, Dana, Amended, Dunc. Journ. Linn. Soc., Zool. xiii. p. 155, 1883. Subgenus PopAaBacta. Hatomirra (PoDABACIA) CRUSTACEA. Podabacia crustacea, Ed. § H. Hist. Nat. des Corall. iii. p. 20, 1860. Locality, Elphinstone Island. Genus Cryprapacta, Hd. & A. CRYPTABACIA TALPINA. Fungia talpina, Lamk. Hist. Anim. s. Vert. p. 370. 16 _ PROF. P. M. DUNCAN ON THE MADREPORARIA Cryptabacia talpma, Ed. § H. Ann. des Sc. Nat. 3 sér. t. xv. p. 95, 1851. Locality, Elphinstone Island. Genus HrerporitHa, Hschscholiz. HERPOLITHA LIMAX. i Madrepora limax, Esper, Pflanz. t. i. Forts. 77, Madr. tab. \xiii., 1797. - Herpetolitha limax, Ed. § H. Ann. des Sc. Nat. 3 sér. t. xv. p. 94, 1851. Locality, Elphinstone Island. Family LopHOSERID®, Dune. Revis. p. 146. Genus Lornossris, Hd. § H. LOPHOSERIS CRISTATA. Madrepora cristata, Ellis § Solander, op. cit. p. 158, tab. xxxi. figs. 3-4, 1786. Lophoseris cristata, Ed. & H. Ann. des Sc. Nat. 3 sér. t. xv. p. 121, 1851. Locality, Mergui Island. LOPHOSERIS CACTUS. | Pavonia cactus, Hemp. & Ehr. Abhandl. d. Akad. Berl. (1832), p. 329, 1834. Lophoseris cactus, Ed. § H. Ann. des Sc. Nat. 3 sér. t. xv. p. 123, 1851. Locality, King Island Bay. Genus PacuyseEris, Hd. & H., Amended, Dunc. Revis. p. 162. PACHYSERIS SPECIOSA. Agaricia speciosa, Dana, U.S. Explor. Exped., Zooph. p. 337, pl. 21. fig. 7, 1847. Pachyseris speciosa, Ed. § H, Ann. des Sc. Nat. 3 sér. t. xv. p- 136, 1851. Locality, Mergui Archipelago. Genus Coscrnarma, Hd. f H., Amended, Dunc. Revis. p. 184. CoscINARHA MEANDRINA. Astrea meandrina, Ehr. Abhandl. d. Akad. Berl. 1832, p. 1834. Coscinareea mzeandrina, Ed. § H. Pal. foss. des terr. paléoz. §c, p. 144, 1851. Locality, Mergui Archipelago. OF THE MERGUI ARCHIPELAGO. 17 CoscINARHA MONILE. Madrepora monile, Forskal, op. cit. p. 133. Coscinarzea monile, Klunz. op. cit. pt. iii. p. 79, Taf. ix. fig. 4, and Taf. x. fig. 17 a & b (Durchschnitte). Locality, Mergui Archipelago. Family PLESIoPORITIDA, Dune. Revis. p- 165. Genus Mmanproseris (pars), Rousseau. M#aAnproseris Borre. Meandroseris Botte, Rousseau, Voy. au Péle sud de Dumont d’ Urville, Zool. t. v. p. 121, Zooph. pl. 28. fig. 1 (1854). Locality, Mergui Archipelago. Section MADREPORARIA PERFORATA, Ed. & H. Family EupsamMMiIpD 4, Dune. Revis. p. 172. Genus Batanopuytiia, S. Wood. BALANOPHYLLIA MERGUIENSIS, sp.nov. (Plate I. figs. 25, 26.) The corallum is small, short, rather higher than broad, nearly cylindrical, being slightly compressed. alice elliptical and larger than the base, and deep. Septa numerous and crowded, in incomplete five cycles. Primaries and secondaries equal, thin, plain at the margin of the calice and with ragged edges elsewhere and near the columella. The tertiaries have a tall, stout, serrated swelling near the columella, joined by the higher orders. These large projections form as it were a paliferous crown around the columella, and this is deeply seated, long and narrow, and trabeculate. Cost nearly equal, with a single row of short rounded granulations, often wavy, narrow, bifurcating, and not much projecting. Intercostal spaces minutely and regularly perforated. Epitheca rudimentary. Height of corallum 8-9 millim. ; breadth of calice 5°5 millim., length 7 millim. Locality, Mergui Archipelago. Genus Denpropnytiia, Hd. f& H. DENDROPHYLLIA COARCTATA, Sp. nov. (Plate I. figs. 27, 28.) The colony is moderately tall, with a broad base, and consists of corallites of various sizes and of different ages; parent coral- lite not usually detected. Some buds arise close to the base LINN. JOURN.—ZOOLOGY, VOL. XXI. 2 18 PROF. P. M. DUNCAN ON THE MADREPORARIA and others nearer the calicular margins of the corallites. Coral- lites turbinate, compressed. Calices elliptical, often much com- pressed, longer than broad, with a moderately stout margin. Septa slightly exsert and projecting but slightly from the wall towards the axis of the calice, thin, imperforate except close to the wall, and with plain edges; the smaller with ragged edges and often with projections on them near the columella. There are four complete cycles, and part of a fifth may exist. In the large calices the fifth is nearly complete and the primaries and secondaries are equal; the tertiaries are slender and do not project much from the wall, but they become large near the columella on account of the junction of the higher orders with them. The septa of the fourth and fifth orders reach halfway down the corallite and join the tertiaries, and the small cribriform septa of the fifth cycle join the fourth and fifth orders not far from the calice. Or this last junction may not take place. Columella deep, small, elongate, formed of lax trabecule, and these join the principal septa. Wall stout, cribriform, perforated very regularly. Coste variable, usually subequal, minutely granular, projecting slightly. The long and short axes of the margin of the calices are on different planes. Height 38 millim. ; breadth of free surface 20-25 millim., length of the free surface 85-45 millim.; length of calices 8-15 millim., breadth 8-12 millim.; depth of large calices 8-15 millim. Locality, Mergui Archipelago. Subgenus Canorsammia, (gen.) Hd. 6 H., Dunc. Revis. p.178. DENDROPHYLLIA (C@NOPSAMMIA) AFFINIS, sp. nov. (Plate I. figs. 29, 30.) The colony is low, more or less hemispherical, and encrusts. Corallites project slightly above the lax, highly porous cenen- chyma. Calices circular in outline, as deep as they are broad. Septa with three cycles, often incomplete, and rarely an order of the fourth; primaries are a little exsert, imperforate except near the wall, slightly granular, and larger than the secondaries ; both join the columella. The smaller tertiaries may bend towards and join the secondaries, but the opposite condition is quite as frequent, and the Eupsammine condition is often not seen. Columella deeply seated, small, and composed of two or three trabecule, or larger and of many trabecule. Coste OF THE MERGUI ARCHIPELAGO. 19 granular, numerous, equal, distinct down to the ccnenchyma. Intercostal spaces large and highly perforate. Coenenchyma finely spinulose and more or less perforated. There is an epitheca at the edge of the base of the coral, and it is dense. Height of corallites above the coonenchyma2—4 millim.; breadth of the calices 5-7 millim. Gemmation occurs from the corallite- walls. Locality, Mergui Archipelago. In some calices of Caenopsammia affinis the third cycle is complete and its septa are long and reach the columella in most half-systems; but occasionally there is an attempt as it were to bend towards the secondary, and there may be the rudiments of a fourth cycle. In another calice as large as the last the primaries are the only well-developed septa; and in some systems the secondaries are small, bent, and cribriform, and unite with the columella low down, and then there are just vestiges of rudimentary tertiaries. The columella in this calice is not one quarter the size of that of the other. Genus Astropsamnta, Verrill. ASTROPSAMMIA PEDERSONT. Astropsammia Pedersonii, Verrill, Proc. Boston Soc. of Nat. Hist. vol, xii. p. 392, 1869. Locality, Mergui Archipelago. Family MADREPORID 2 (pars), Ed. § H. Genus Maprepora, Linn. MabvREPORA GRACILIS. Madrepora gracilis, Ed. § H. Hist. Nat. des Corall. iii. p. 147, 1860. Locality, Sullivan Island. MApDREPORA VALIDA. Madrepora valida, Dana, op. cit. p. 461. Locality, Elphinstone Island. MapREPORA SURCULOSA. Madrepora surculosa, Dana, op. cit. p. 445, pl. 32. fig. 4. Locality, Owen Island. MapREPORA HEBES. Madrepora hebes, Dana, op. cit. p. 468, pl. 35. fig. 5. Locality, Sullivan Island. 20 PROF. P. M. DUNCAN ON THE MADREPORARIA MaADREPORA PYRAMIDALIS. Madrepora pyramidalis, K/unz. op. cit. pt. ii. p. 12, Taf.i. fig. 2, Taf. iv. fig. 6, Taf. ix. fig. 7. Locality, Sullivan Island. MADREPORA PAXILLIGERA. Madrepora paxilligera, Dana, op. cit. v. p. 452, pl. 34. fig. 1. Locality, Owen Island and Sullivan Island. MADREPORA CRIBRIPORA. Madrepora cribripora, Dana, op. cit. p. 470, pl. 31. figs. 1, 1 a, 18. Locality, Elphinstone Island. MaADREPORA SPICIFERA. Madrepora spicifera, Dana, op. cit. p. 442, pl. 33. figs. 4, 4a, 46, 5, et pl. 31. fig. 6, a, b, e. Locality, Sullivan Island. Genus TuRBINARIA, Oken. TURBINARIA CINERASCENS. Madrepora cinerascens, Ellis § Solander, op. cit. p. 157, pl. 43. Turbinaria cinerascens, Oken, Lehrb. der Naturgesch. Zool. t. i. p. 67. Locality, King Island Bay. TURBINARIA CRATER. Madrepora crater, Pallas, Elench. Zooph. p. 332. Turbinaria crater, Oken, Lehrb. der Naturgesch. Zool. t. i. p. 67. Locality, King Island Bay. Family Poritipa, Ed. & H. Genus Poritzs, Hd. f H. PoRITES CONGLOMERATA. Porites conglomerata, Quoy § Gaim. Voy. de l’Astrol. Zooph. p. 429, 1833. THE OPHIURIDE OF THE MERGUI ARCHIPELAGO. 85 On the Ophiuride of the Mergui Archipelago, collected for the Trustees of the Indian Museum, Calcutta, by Dr. John Anderson, F.R.S., Superintendent of the Museum. By Prof. P. Martin Duncan, M.B. Lond., F.R.S., F.L.S. {Read 3rd June, 1886.] (Puates VIII, IX., & XI. figs. 28-40.) Conrents :—I. Introduction. II. List of the Species. III. Descrip- tion of the Species. IV. Remarks on the Species. V. Description of the Plates. I. Introduction. THE species of Ophiuride which form the subject of this com- munication were handed over to me by Dr. Anderson for description and classification. The little fauna is rich in individuals, and some are of consi- derable dimensions. There are thirteen species, besides some young forms of the genus Ophioglypha, in the collection, and four of them have been recorded from other localities. The latter are, with one exception, well-known species; they are Ophio- lepis cineta, Mull. & Trosch., Ophiocoma scolopendrina, Luk. sp., Ophiocnemis marmorata, Lmk. sp., and Ophiothrix Martensi, Lyman. These forms are characteristic of the Indian Ocean and the western Pacific Islands. The first extends to the Philippines, the second ranges from the Cape of Good Hope to the Philip- pines and Fijis, the third has been found in Ceylon and in the Great Ocean, and the fourth is from the Philippines. None of the Korean species are present; and one Ophiothriz is closely allied to a species from the Nicobars. All the species are shallow-water dwellers; and some of the individuals appear to have suffered from a deficiency of carbonate of lime in their food. There are some remarkable forms amongst the collection, and especially the new species of Ophiolepis and the new genus Ophio- campsis, represented by one species, which is allied to Ophio- psammium and Ophiothrix. The species of Ophiothriz gave much trouble in their classification; and the structures of Ophiothrix variabilis have been of necessity carefully studied. Their de- scription forms the subject of a special communication, which follows this. 86 PROF. P. M. DUNCAN ON THE OPHIURIDE II. List of the Species described or noticed in this Communication. Order OPHIURIDA, J. Miller. Family Oruiocomips, Lyn. Family Orntoxeripa, Ln. Ophiocoma scolopendrina, Lmk., sp. Ophiolepis cincta, Mill. & Trosch. Family Orntoruricrpa, Lyn. nodosa, sp. nov. Ophiothrix Andersoni, sp. nov. Ophioglypha, Lyman, numerous merguiensis, sp. nov. young forms. —— Martensi, Lym. varlegatus, sp. nov. variabilis, sp. nov., and four Family Aupuiurips, Ljn. varieties. Ophiophragmus affinis, sp. nov. Ophiocampsis pellicula, gen. et sp. difficilis, sp. nov. noy. Ophiocnida sexradia, sp. nov. Ophiocnemis marmorata, Imk., sp. III. Description of the Species. Genus Ornrouepis, Will. 5 Trosch. OpnioLEPts crncra, Aull. § Trosch. Locality. King Island. OPHIOLEPIS NopDoSsA, sp. nov. (Plate VIII. figs. 1-3.) Disk large, much notched over the arms, covered with very small wide-apart radial shields and a thick skin ornamented with large knobs piaced symmetrically and surrounded by small irregular scales. Large projecting knobs in the interbrachial spaces. Below, the scaling is both large and small, and the smaller plates surround the larger; large scaling at the margin. Mouth-papille numerous, and with accessory papilla. A sup- plementary plate orally to the mouth-shield. Arms short and broad; upper arm-plate nodular; small accessory plates on either side of upper and lower arm-plates ; four to six very small spines along the arm. ‘T'wo tentacle-scales. Description of the Specimen.—Disk nearly as wide as the length of an arm, tumid above and at the margin between the arms, notched over them. Nodules five in centre, two in each interradial space, and five largest between the central group and the radial shields. Radial shields very small, naked, almond- shaped, widely separated by two nodules and intermediate scaling. Scales between the nodules varying in shape and size, never regular or in single series. At the margin, between the arms, the nodules are very large and five in number, and sepa- rated by a narrow scaling. Immediately below these are five OF THE MERGUI ARCHIPELAGO. 87 large and symmetrical plates; the rest of the plates diminish in size from the margin to the mouth-shields ; and there is a row of irregularly-shaped scales between them. Two generative slits, and the scale apparently divided into three parts. Mouth-shields small, ovoid, narrowest externally, and with a small accessory piece between the mouth-shield and the junc- tion of the side mouth-shields. Side mouth-shields each nearly as large as the mouth-shield, situated obliquely, and with the inner point of junction far internal to the accessory piece, tri- angular, and largest at the side, where they are in contact with the first lower arm-plate, the first side arm-plate, and the mouth- shield. Jaw-plate angles broad andlong. Mouth-papille mostly projecting downwards, irregular from the intercalation of accessory papille ; there are 13 in one angle, and 11 and 12 in the rest. There may or may not be a papilla below the teeth, which are stout and blunt, except the lowest, which is pointed. A long papilla, which is in contact with the side mouth-shield and also with the first arm-plate, is large and triangular, and might be called a tentacle-scale. The accessory pieces are small and resemble mouth-papille. First lower arm-plate small, triangular, pointed within. The next is very large and is broader than any other, broader than long, straight where in contact with the first plate, slightly convex externally, and with a re-entering curve on either side of the straight part ; incurved for the tentacle at the part of the side nearest the first plate, and more slantingly incurved further out for the side arm-plate. Beyond the disk the plates are as long as broad, slightly convex without and concave within, with re-entering curves on either side and a straight border for the side arm-plate. Far out they are separated by the side plates, and are triangular, the angle being towards the disk. Upper arm-plates small, short, and moderately broad, not extending across the arm, the usual space at the side being occu- pied by a triangular accessory plate which reaches the side arm- plate; the surface of the upper plate is a nodular broad ridge with a blunt pot at the median line. Side arm-plates large, tumid, but close to the arm, gradually having the accessory piece between them, and crossing the upper surface of the arm close to the tip. There are two close, flap-like tentacle-scales, and from four to six, usually four, very small spines placed close to the 88 PROF. P. M. DUNCAN ON THE OPHIURIDE arm. The tentacular openings are bounded, without, by a small, short, and increasingly broad accessory plate. Arms short, with a leathery skin at the disk-notches, capable of much horizontal motion, and broad and flat below, low at the sides, and more or less angular above from the presence of the nodular upper arm-plates. Colour in alcohol orange, with a little purple splashed on the radial shields, nearly white below. A remarkable cribriform structure exists in many parts; for instance, on the bases of the boss-like nodules of the disk, on the sides of the radial shields, on the flanks of the nodules between the shields, on the sides of the large bosses at the margin, on the upper flap of the side arm-plates, and on the upper arm-plate except the boss. The jaw-frames are slightly cribriform, and so are the side arm-plates, as seen from below, and here and there a few pores occur on the lower arm-plates. The cribriform character is pro- duced by a close, shallow, circular perforation, or rather pene- tration, of the calcareous structures. Diameter of disk 18 millim. Length of arm 17:5 millim., breadth of arm outside the disk 3 millim. Locality. Elphinstone Island. Genus OrHiociypHa, Lyman. Numerous young forms of indeterminable species. Locality. Elphinstone Island. Genus OpHiopHRragMus, Lyman. The next two forms to be considered have given some trouble in regard to their classificatory position; for whilst having the general aspect and some of the characters of the genus Amphiura, there are some of the internal, as well as external, structures present of the genus Ophiophragmus, Lym. Some of the in- ternal structures are, however, Amphiuran, and are not seen in the type of Ophiophragmus figured by Lyman, ‘ Challenger’ Report, Ophiuroidea, pl. xl. fig. 4. 1. The junction of the mouth-frames, superiorly and at the median line adorally to the first arm-bone, is stout and project- ing. The upper brachial rims of the contiguous halves, to use Lyman’s words, “form an elevated crescent embracing the outer end of the mouth-slit”; moreover, the interbrachial rims are in OF THE MERGUI ARCHIPELAGO. 89 the form of well-developed crests; they are rather close, and the intervening muscle is well developed. These are Ophiopbragman characters. But the width of the mouth-frames is greater, and the height of the interbrachial rims is less than in O. Wurde- mannt, Lym. Probably the very narrow mouth-shield determines the narrowness of the space between the interbrachial rims of the mouth-frames, as seen from above. 2. The first three arm-bones within the disk, as seen from above, after the removal of the roof of the disk, resemble those of Ophio- phragmus; but those further out resemble those of Amphiwra. 3. There is a peristomial plate, and the character is not Ophio- phragman, but it resembles that of Hemipholis. 4. The genital plate is long and slender, and simply knob- headed, and the generative scale is long and slender and longer than the plate. They resemble the corresponding structures in Amphiura wore than those of Ophiophragmus. 5. The radial shields are unusually broad for an Amphiuran, yet not more so than in some recognized species. 6. The ridge of scales at the margin of the disk, although slight, is Ophiophragman ; but it cannot be of any physiological importance. Probably the species should be classified with the genus Ophio- phragmus, although the Amphiuran alliance is evident. OPHIOPHRAGMUS AFFINIS, sp. nov. (Plate VIII. figs. 4-6.) The disk is circular in outline, except where slightly indented over the arms, and it israther tumid. The scaling is small above, but distinet, andis largest centrally and in the interradial spaces. Primary plates not very conspicuous. On the underside of the disk the scaling is smaller and overlapping. A ridge of minute scales at the interbrachial margins projecting. Radial shields twice as long as broad, pip-shaped, close and joined except near their inner ends, where a single scale intervenes: a projection on the outer angle. Mouth-shields small, spear-headed, blunt, angular orally, and with a stalk-hke process aborally, covered with a thin skin. Side mouth-shields small, covered. Jaws broad; four mouth-papille on each side—the outer on the side mouth-shield, the two following more or less united, and the innermost below the teeth, but sloping somewhat besides projecting inwards. Arms long, 5°5 times the diameter of the disk in length, slender, 90 PROF. P. M. DUNCAN ON THE OPHIURIDE filiform at the end, flat below, and convex above. Lower arm- plates very broad, broader than long, twice as broad as long for some distance beyond the disk, nearly quadrangular near the — disk, and with a point at the median line adorally, incurved aborally lower down, with an inward curve at the sides for the tentacular opening. A low, broad elevation runs along the median line of each lower arm-plate. Upper arm-plates large, much broader than long near the disk, slightly convex adorally from side to side; the aboral edge is the widest, and the adoral is boldly curved adorally. Further out the plates are elliptical and broader than long, but near the tip the length increases over the breadth. The side arm-plates are small flaps close to the arm, which soon encroach slightly between the upper and lower plates, and the separation of the upper arm-plates by them soon becomes considerable. Three short, cylindrical, pointed spines stick out widely from the arm and from each other, the middle one the longest and thickest. Two tentacle-scales over the large tentacular openings, broad and pointed—one is on the side arm-plate, and the other on the lower arm-plate. They reach far out in the arm, and the scale attached to the lower arm-plate becomes longer. Diameter of disk 4°5 millim. Length of arm 26 millim. Colour white and flesh-tinted. Localities. Elphinstone Island and King Island. One of the commonest species of the Ophiurida in the Archi- pelago is asmall, slender, long-armed form, which is usually found without atop to the disk, and, moreover, the middle of the upper arm-plates is wanting for some little distance beyond the disk. The genital plates and scales, the interbrachial parts, and the whole of the top of the disk are then absent. In two instances the disk has been preserved, and it is possible therefore to describe the species fully and to classify it. OPHIOPHRAGMUS DIFFICILIS, sp.nov. (Plate VIII. figs. 7-9.) The disk is small, flat, strongly pentangular, with a well-defined re-entering curve at the margin between the radial shields. Diameter 5 millim. Length of arm 70 millim. Disk covered with a minute overlapping scaling except on the radial shields. A large scaling at the margin. Radial shields long and narrow, but forming much of the disk, and close except midway; the ends OF THE MERGUI ARCHIPELAGO. SE project over the arm and are close; the outer sides overlapped by sealing. Genital plate slender and long, rod-like, articulated with the radial shield, and having a slight expansion at its inner _ part over the arm; it arches into the longer and equally slender genital scale. The aboral ends of the united genital plate and scale overhang the arm and nearly touch their neighbours at the median line. Generative openings large. Interbrachial spaces below with a plain skin, the only scaling being on the side of the genital slit and on a line with the oral end of the generative scale, and it consists of a close row. Mouth-shields longer than broad, broadly rounded without and narrower and more angular within. Side mouth-shields large, broad at the side of the arm, and long from side to side in front of the mouth-shield, only separated by the very small first arm- plate. Jaw-angles broad and short, with four mouth-papille on either side, of which one is stout and immediately below the true teeth, the next is small, and the following pair are frequently united. These eight papille, which are very constant, project downward. The arms are long, filiform, and slender, but they do not diminish much in breadth; they are rarely otherwise than straight, and usually three are in one direction, and all look like stiff wires rather than threads. Lower arm-plates: the first is very small, incurved orally, and convex at the edge without, touched on either side by a side mouth-shield ; the second is much larger, is quad- rangular, but longer than broad, broadest orally, and convex at the edge withcut. Beyond the disk the plates are much longer than broad, slightly broadest at the inner edge, which is convex, and with sides straight and slanting to the narrower outer edge, which is incurved. In mid arm the length preponderates over the breadth, and the breadth is greatest at the edge within, and this is convex, while the edge without has a decided incurve. At some distance from the disk the plates are not close, on account of the side arm-plates coming in. Upper arm-plates broadly triangular, point without, angles at the sides and without rounded off; oral edge broad and slightly eurved within. Usually with a small median ridge. The median part of the first six or eight upper arm-plates deficient. Side arm-plates large, projecting obliquely, meeting, not far from the disk, on the underside of the arm broadly, and thus 92 PROF. P. M. DUNCAN ON THE OPHIURID# separating the lower arm-plates there; meeting on the upper surface of the arm close to the disk by a narrow surface. The spines are on the exposed narrow edge of the plate, and are three in number except close to the disk, where there is a fourth. They are subequal, short, stout, cylindro-conical, striated, sharp, and glassy ; their length is not equal to that of the width of the upper arm-plate. The tentacle-scale is small and spinulose. Tentacles long and stout. The colour of the animal is either light, brown or white. With regard to the internal construction of the skeleton, it appears that the form of the upper part of the arm-bones resembles that seen in Amphiura, but there is an approach to the peculiar structure of the genus Ophiophragmus in the crescentie junction of the mouth-frames at the mouth-slits ; moreover, the interbrachial rims of the frames project and are not widely sepa- rated. There is no peristomial plate. The position assumed in the specimens by the genital plates and scales is very remarkable, but it may be due to post-mortem causes. The oral ends of the plates and scales, instead of being parallel with the side of the arm in continuation with the general direction of the rest of the structure, are in contact with the side arm-plates immediately below the position of the aboral ends of the radial shields. The plates and scales are thus nearly vertical and the end of a radial shield is foreed up to a much higher level than the top of the arm, and of course there is a considerable space between the upper surface of the arms and the underpart of the disk. Locality. King Island. Genus OpHiocnipa, Lyman. OPHIOCNIDA SEXRADIA, sp. nov. (Plate VIII. figs. 10, 11.) Disk small, tumid above and at the margin, irregularly hexa- -gonal, covered with a thick skin with numerous close, short, thorned stumps. No scales or radial shields are visible. A skin with a very delicate, small, overlapping scaling is in the interbrachial spaces below, and there are some stumps on it near the margin. Two large generative slits, which come as far inwards as the aboral process (genital scales) of the mouth-shield. Mouth-shields small, about as long as broad, lozenge-shaped with the angles rounded. Side mouth-shields small, short orally, and largest near the arms, usually not meeting orally, and touching the first and second OF THE MERGUI ARCHIPELAGO. 93 arm-plates. Jaw-angles triangular, broad and short, with a median perforation. Mouth-papille numerous, eight to an angle, not counting the tentacle-scale on either side. There is one also beneath the teeth, so that there may be from 9 to 11. Tentacles large. There are six long rather slender arms. First lower arm-plate small; second plate very much larger, longer than broad, broadest without, outer edge curved outwards, inner edge straight and slightly curved at the sides for the side mouth-shield. Beyond the disk the plates are longer and otherwise retain their outline, but the side arm-plate comes gradually under the arm and dimi- nishes the width of the inner edge. Sides incurved. The large, long, flap-like, curved tentacle-scale abuts against the side of the lower arm-plate. The length of the plates increases over the breadth towards the tip of the arm, and they are separated by the side arm-plates. The tentacle-scale becomes more pointed towards the end of the arm. Upper arm-plates large, heart- shaped, broadest aborally and curved there, narrower orally and roundedly angular there; sides convex. The side arm-plates come in at the half-arm. Side arm-plates large, flap-like, projecting somewhat near the disk and more flattened to the arm further out, so that the direction of the spines differs ; meeting above and below the arm slightly beyond its outer half. Four close, cylin- drical, conical, short, stout spines ; their length is less than that of an upper arm-plate and they are longest in mid arm. The upper spine is either the longest or it may be short, the next is the stoutest as a rule, and the others are shorter and more slender. Their surface is plain or minutely jagged. Arms six, high, flat above and below, and nodulated towards the tip. Diameter of disk 4 millim.; length of arm 18 millim. Colour light brown, without any spots. Locality. Owen Island. Genus OpHiocoma, Agass. OPHIOCOMA SCOLOPENDRINA, Lmk.,sp.; Mill. § Trosch., Syst. Aster. p. 101 (1842). Several specimens of this species are in the collection from Mergui; and as there are some interesting points about their varia- tions from the type and from one another, notice is taken of them. In the largest specimen, which has a disk 25 millim. across and LINN. JOURN.—ZOOLOGY, VOL. XXI. 8 94, PROF. P.M. DUNCAN ON THE OPHIURIDE arms 130 millim. in length, the upper, swollen, large, flat arm-spine is on every other side arm-plate, and near the end of the arm the upper spine is the longest and largest, but it is neither flat nor swollen. In one of the arms the normal repetition of a large flat spine occurs on every side arm-plate. The granulation of the disk is hemispherical, small, and not crowded ; the largest nodules are on the ends of the radial shields. The granulation is smaller below. The wide generative slits come inwards so as to be bounded oraily by the side mouth-shields, and these do not always meet orally. Two or three mouth-papille merge into a ridge, and the inner mouth-papille are not readily distinguished from the lower tooth-papiile. The mouth-shields project considerably along the median line into the jaw-angles. The first three lower arm-plates form a groove. The double tentacle-scale is seen near the disk, but not very far out inthe arm; there it is single, large, and flap-like. At the tip of the arm the lower arm-plates are very long. Ina smaller specimen (diameter of disk 22 millim., length of arm 120 millim.) the spines are shorter than in the form just noticed, the lower arm-plates are broadly elliptical in mid-arm, the skin coming well between them. Thereis no coalescence of the mouth- papille, and there are three on either side and one below the tooth-papille. The large tentacle-scale in contact with the side mouth-shield and first arm-plate may be counted besides as a mouth-papilla. In a small specimen (disk 9 millim. and arm 65 millim.) the granulation of the disk is crowded above and large at the margin. Underneath, the minute sealing, which is obscured by pigment in the large forms, is visible and the granulation does not extend en masse to the mouth-shields and only a few stray nodules occur thus far inwards. The mouth-papille are either confused with the lower tooth- papille or are not, or one may be on the jaw-angle external to the tooth-papille clump. Including the large tentacle-scale, there are four mouth-papille on either side. The side arm-plates come under the arm and are in contact near the disk, but not further out. The lower arm-plates are rather hatchet-shaped beyond the disk, but they become very long towards the tip. The upper arm-plates are widest without and convex there. The spines are miniatures of those of the large forms. Two tentacle-seales near the disk and one further out. OF THE MERGUI ARCHIPELAGO. 95 The variability is remarked by Mr. Lyman in his Report on the ‘ Challenger ’ Ophiuroidea, p. 170. Locality. Owen Island. Genus Orniorurix, Mull. § Trosch. OpuroTHRIx ANDERSONI, sp. nov. (Plate IX. figs. 12, 13; Plate XI. figs. 28-30.) | The disk is circular in outline, large and tumid. The radial shields are large and naked. Minute scales with slender 2- to 4.thorned stumps in the centre of the disk, -between the radial shields and the pairs of shields. A single series between the radial shields of a pair and four close rows in the interradial spaces. Scales overlap the radial shields somewhat. Similar small scales and stumps at the margin of the disk. Below, the disk is covered with minute scales bearing stouter stumps than those above and with five to eight long thorns to a stump. Mouth-shields small, much broader than long, more or less elliptical, but angular within and rounded without. Side mouth- shields small, largest at their sides, and meeting in front of the mouth-shields by a narrow edge. Jaw-angles short, very broad close to the side mouth-shields, with a small opening at the median line and large tentacular orifices. Tooth-papille and teeth, the former in an ovoid space, small and crowded inferiorly ; Jower ends of the ovoids very wide apart from those opposite, so as to produce a funnel-shaped mouth. Arms broad, arched, high and long, ten times the diameter of the disk in length. Lower arm-plates broad and flat; some, within the disk, are longer than broad, but the breadth gradually increases over the length; they are broadest aborally. The plates near the disk have the outer edge much curved, convexity towards the tip of the arm, and the edge within is slightly incurved. Further out in the arm the plates become longer than broad, and are slightly convex at both of the edges as well as curved out at the sides. A broad purple baud passes down the under arm, which has a white colour. ; The upper arm-plates are convex from side to side, much broader than long, short, broadest and curved at the aboral edge and narrower and incurved adorally ; sometimes the aboral edge has a slight incurve at the median line. The breadth diminishes in relation to the length towards the tip of the arm. The colour of the plates is a smalt-purple, and a narrow white band crosses each plate. The first plate has a few thorned stumps on it. gx 96 PROF. P. M. DUNCAN ON THE OPHIURID The side arm-plates are small and flap-like, especially on the lower surface of the arm. They contribute to the breadth of the arm, and do not meet until near to the tip of the arm. There is a small scale as a tentacle-spine. The number of spines varies in different parts of the arm; there are nine close to the disk and then seven, six, and five, which is the usual number over the greater part of the arm. A small glassy spine with side spinules is seen on a few plates near the disk, and it becomes a true hook with four fangs at the seventh arm-joint, and the points of the hooks, which are close to the tentacle-scale, look towards the disk. The other spines are glassy and usually compressed, so that their large lateral spinules are directed parallel with the arm. The upper spine, which is the longest and slenderest, is needle-shaped, sharp, and the spinulation is near the top and slight on the stem. The next spines diminish in length, are long, compressed, very spinulose near the top and less so on the stem. The spine next to the hook is very compressed, and has long and sharp spinules. Longest spine 3'5 millim. Breadth of disk 14 millim. ; length of arm 140 millim.; breadth of lower arm-plates near the disk 1 millim. Colour of disk above dark purple, darkest centrally and along the interradia and spaces between the radial shields of a pair, relieved with smalt and white in splashes and lines near the edges of the radial shields. Localities. King Island Bay, Elphinstone Island. OPHIOTHRIX MERGUIENSIS, sp. nov. (Plate IX. figs. 14, 15; Plate XI. fig. 31.) Disk nearly circular in marginal outline, covered with skin in which there are minute scales, each bearing a short three- thorned stump. Radial shields covered with a coarsely granular skin, also with a few trifid stumps; shields broadest at the margin and projecting over the arm, separated from the neigh- bouring pairs by a wide area covered with minute scales and bearing thorny stumps; a narrow line of the same structures between the shields of a pair. Disk tumid beneath and covered in the interbrachial spaces with crowded trifid stumps. Mouth-shields as broad as long, broadly curved without and angular within. Side mouth-shields small, triangular, meeting at a narrow point orally to the mouth- ‘shields, and not reaching aborally beyond the line of the mouth- shields. Jaw-angles wide and short, perforated along the median ON THE MERGUI ARCHIPELAGO. 97 line with immense tentacular openings; tooth-papille numerous and ina broad ellipse. Lower arm-plates beyond the disk flat and wide, nearly square or very slightly longer than broad, are-entering curve at the outer edge, and a slight slanting at the sides for theside arm-plates. Furtherout in the arm the plates are longer than broad and widest without. Upper arm-plates broader than long, curved within and without, the convexity directed aborally, sides slanting for the side arm-plates; these are large, broad below, and flap- like at the sides, and they add to the height of the arm, which is flat below and arched above. Tentacle-opening large, and the scale is very small; tentacles large, long, and very papillose. Six spines, the lowest being a hook, small and 3-pronged; it is not found upon the first four or five joints. The next spine is small, compressed and serrate; the third spine is longer and also compressed, but is longer and blunt at the top, but it is serrate. The fourth spine is very long, but oar-shaped near its blunt broad top, it is very serrate, and is four times the length of a lower arm-plate (fig. 31). The fifth, or uppermost, spine is usually shorter than the last men- tioned and its shape varies, it being often needle-ended. The spines in alcohol are dark coloured and opaque, and in balsam they are glassy with pigment-spots here and there. General colour of the disk and arms very dark red-brown. Diameter of disk 6 millim.; length of the arm 55 millim. or 1 to 9. Locality. Owen Island. OpuiotHrix Marrensi, Lyman, Bull. Mus. Comp. Zool. vol. ui. pt. 10, p. 284, pl. iv. figs. 9 & 10 (1874) ; and ‘ Challenger’ Ophi- uroidea, p. 221. This belongs to the group of Ophiothrices with arm-spines clubbed at the end and well-marked radial shields. Locality. Owen Island. OPpHIOTHRIX VARIEGATUS, sp. nov. (Plate IX. figs. 16, 17; Plate XI. figs. 37-39.) Disk tumid, projecting in the interradial parts of the margin, covered with a growth of small, slender, long-thorned stumps ; thorns one to four in number. Stumps smallest and shortest at the centre of the disk, and slightly larger and longer towards the margins. No scales visible except the very small granulated thorny radial shields. Radial shields with a V-shaped space between and this has thorny stumps, and there is a broader stumped area between the pairs. 98 PROF. P. M. DUNCAN ON THE OPHIURID® Beneath, no large scaling occurs, and the interbrachial spaces are covered with slender, long-thorned stumps which diminish in numbers towards the mouth-shields. Mouth-shields small, one third broader than long, either lozenge-shaped or more or less rounded aborally and angular orally, projecting on either side ; with a large adoral genital scale attached on either side to the median line aborally. Side mouth-shields small, triangular, and not meeting adorally to the mouth-shields. Jaw-angles short, broad, with a wide median opening ; tentacular opening considerable, and the tentacle long and papillose. Tooth-papille small, crowded, especially inferiorly, in a narrow blunt ovoid space. Teeth. Genital slits large and reaching mouth-shields; genital scale in contact with slender genital plate, broad, pointed orally and arched, shorter than the plate. First lower arm-plate small, second as long as broad, flat, re-enteringly curved adorally, with an aboral convexity. Sides slightly incurved. The sixth plate is broader than long, flat, almost rectangular, with a slight outward curve at the sides ; further out, the plates have the aboral margin incurved, and towards the tip of the arm the shape is preserved, but there is a projection from the adoral edge towards the next or adoral plate. Upper arm-plates broader than long, convex at the outer margin, and concave and overlapped adorally, broadest at the outer margin. Arms high in section and arched. Side arm- plates large and flap-like, adding much to the under arm. A tentacle-scale. Tentacles long,sharply papillose. Spines glassy, nine near the disk, then seven, and six, which is the usual number, not counting the hook which begins at the fifth joint. The three lowest spines next to the trifid hook are short and small, the next and the following are long, very broadly oar-shaped at the tip, serrate, and with a crowd of long terminal spinules, especially on one side (fig. 37) ; all are compressed. The uppermost spine is shorter than the next and is a needle. The longer spines are much longer than the breadth of an upper arm-plate. Diameter of disk 8 millim.; length of arm 50 millim., 1 to 6:25. Colour of disk above dark purple with light tints, the white stumps giving a frosted appearance. Upper arm-plates each banded with white along the aboral edge and with a longitudinal white stripe ; eround-tint a smalt-purple, and lines of it interfere with the continuity of the white mark at the edge of the plates. Under surtace of the disk white, with an occasional splash of purple in OF THE MERGUI ARCHIPELAGO. 99 the interbrachial areas and on the mouth-shields. Lower arm- plates white, with a small patch or line of purple on either side of the median line. Every four or five plates with more colour than the others, giving a banded appearance to the naked eye. Locality. Elphinstone Island. OPHIOTHRIX VARIABILIS, sp. nov. (Plate IX. figs. 18, 19; Plate XI. figs. 32-36.) The disk is either circular or slightly pentagonal in outline, large, tumid above, covered with a skin (sometimes crumpling when dry) with very small scales, each bearing a short, stout, cylindrical, but slightly tapering stump having a crown of very small thorns, three to six(usually four) in number. About six rows of these scales with stumps in the interradial areas, and a crowd in the centre of the disk and at the margin in the interradia. Between the radial shields three rows of stumped scales. Radial shields large, longer than broad, projecting much over the arm, naked, granular, and with a few very low rounded knobs, especially towards the outer end. Below, the disk has a skin in the interbrachial spaces extending to the adoral genital plates, which are attached to the mouth- shields aborally, covered with minute scales and rather crowded with slenderer stumps than above, and with one thorn only; they diminish in numbers towards the mouth-shield. Genital plate in contact with the underpart of the radial shield aborally, and also articulating with a large, broad, wavy- edged genital scale. Mouth-shields small, broader than long, somewhat angular adorally or trilobed there. Side mouth-shields small, largest at the outer sides, narrow, and separated adorally to the mouth-shield, and not extending beyond the level of the long diameter of the mouth-shield aborally, Jaw-angles short, broad, separated by a considerable space, with a large tentacular area. Jaw-plate large, projecting slightly downwards, with 26 or more tooth-papille, the two highest being like a divided tooth, the rest large and long, except those placed near the lower margin of the plate, which is rather truncated. Teeth four. Lower arm-plates narrow and grooved within the disk, square a little further out, then longer than broad, the length gradually increasing towards the tip of the arm. At a short distance from the disk they are slightly incurved at the aboral edge and curved, convexity adorally; the sides nearly straight or slightly incurved, 100 PROF. P. M. DUNCAN ON THE OPHIURIDE broadest near the adoral edge; either connected by skin or not, and then very closely placed. Upper arm-plates arched from side to side slightly, broad, broader than long considerably, short, broadest without and curved at the aboral edge, near the disk, or slightly trilobed. Inner edge nearly straight or curved when the plates, as they often do, become elliptical; sometimes the sides are narrow and rounded off. Here and there a plate is split, but this condition may not occurin some arms. Side arm-plates flap-like, broad below, and not reaching over the upper arm until very far out. A small jagged tentacle-scale; tentacles large and long, crowded with whorls of papille. Spines, when the ectoderm is removed, glassy with large bases, hollow. At the emergence of the arms from the disk there are from seven to nine spines; further out there are six and usually five spines, the lowest being a double- or triple-fanged hook, with some minute spinules on the reverse side, which commences about the 12th joint or earlier, and then it assumes a more spiny form. ‘The next spine is small, short, slightly compressed and very slightly spinulose; the next is longer and stouter, blunt at the top, compressed and oar-shaped at the end, where the spinules are small and crowded ; serration but slight on the edges of the compressed spine, and foramina numerous. The second spine from above is the largest, longest and broadest at the end, minutely spinulose at the top, and slightly so for some distance down the shaft and then slightly ser- rate; perforations or foramina in several irregular rows. The blunt broad-tipped spines with their comparatively small spinules are distinctive. The first (upper) spine may be a small one and resemble the others, or it may be longer and a plain hollow needle. Length of arms 12-14 times the diameter of the disk, which has a diameter of 13°5 millim. Colour of the disk dull purple, rather blue in tint, with a red tinge at the centre; radial shields lighter and with white background, splashed broadly with purple, low stumps and the others also whitish. Beneath, the disk is white with slight purple stains on the mouth-shields ; interbrachial skin dark. Upper arm-plates purple or slate-colour, every fourth or fifth plate of a darker colour, and hence a banded appearance is given. Rarely a narrow stripe of the same colour, but of a darker tint. Lower arm-plates white within the disk, or with faint purple splashes, further out with a purple border more or less entire, with lines and dots of the same colour on a white ground. In- OF THE MERGUI ARCHIPELAGO. 101 tensity of colour varies in different individuals, and usually there is a banded appearance from the colour being lighter on con- secutive plates. The spines are often slightly splashed with light purple. Upper arm surface midway is 2 millim. across, and the length of the longest spine is a millimetre more. Localities. Elphinstone Island, King Island, Owen Island. Variety 1. Same dimensions as the type, hooks at the 10th jot. Upper arm-plates near the disk with the median aboral projection, sometimes a white line along part of the length in some plates. Variety 2. General splitting of the upper arm-plates, near the disk, in some arms; upper arm-plates entire far out. Variety 8. No splitting of the upper arm-plates, stumps extending in a close multitude below to the mouth-shield. Variety 4. Stumps on the first upper arm-plate. Genus OPHIOCAMPSIS, gen. nov. Disk and large close radial shields covered with skin carrying afew thorned stumps. Ends of radial shields and the long knobs of the genital plates on the top of the arm ; genital scale shorter, broad and large, with a curved border. Below, the disk has a plain skin carrying large, separate, irregular scales each with a thorny stump, crowded and large at the tumid interbrachial space and ceasing near the mouth-shield. Teeth, tooth-papille, no mouth-papille, and no tentacle-scales to the arms. Tentacles large, long, and papillose, coming out from the lower part of the arm. No upper arm-plates. A minutely squamous skin covers the broad, arched upper surface of the arm, and part of the sides of the arm and also the bases of the projecting flap-iike side arm- plates. Spines long, slender, spinulose, glassy, seven to five in number, the lowest being a hook. Lower arm-plates narrow orally and aborally, widest in the midst, and with a projection at the sides. Arms about ten times the length of the diameter of the disk, rounded above and at the sides and rather flat below, can assume a vertical bending. Arm-bones with large umbo and without a median articulating peg. OPHIOCAMPSIS PELLICULA, sp. nov. (Plate IX. figs. 20, 21; Plate XI. fig. 40.) The disk is pentagonal, the scales at the margin are stout, 102 PROF. P. M. DUNCAN ON THE OPHIURID® small, and white. The mouth-shields are broader than long, almost semicircular in their oral curve and more angular without. Side mouth-shields large at the side and narrow, and not always meeting orally. Jaw-angles short, much separated aborally, and having large tentacular openings and very large papillose ten- tacles. Teeth three in number. The tooth-papille are in a short oval, and the jaw-plate is very distinct. About ten to twelve rather large tooth-papillz surround a line of from five to seven small papille, and the highest papille are like a true tooth split down the middle, and are therefore two in number. Strong second genital scales in contact with the aboral edge of the mouth- shields. Lower arm-plates feeble and thin, separated by some skin, longer than broad, narrow and slightly ineurved orally and aborally, aud broadest in their middle part near the disk ; but further out the greatest breadth is near the aboral edge. A projection from each side, often bifurcate, causes the above-mentioned breadth and separates the consecutive tentacle-openings. Side arm-plates large, composing most of the arm, flap-like and very projecting ; tentacle-openings close to the lower arm-plates, and opening below and not at the side of thearm. Seveu glassy, slender, and hollow spines near the disk and far out, near the end five spines occur. The lowest spine, at a short distance from the disk, is a com- pressed, glassy, four- or five-pronged hook. The next three spines are on the under surface of the arm, and are longer than the hook, compressed and spinulose on both sides ; the next spine is long, blunt, compressed, and has spinules near the top, some being hooked and a few on the shaft. Upper spine a needle either long or short, hollow. Longest spines longer than the breadth of the upper arm, this is 2 millim., and the spimes may be 2'5 millim. The minutely squamous skin of the upper arm 1s coloured with wide bands of light and dark purple dots. Arm- bones formed to a certain extent after the type of Ophiothriz, but presenting a tall umbo and no median peg*. No upper arm- plates, and there is some nodulation far out in the arm at the joints. Colour of the disk brown, with a dot or two of purple at the ends of the radial shields and on the mouth-shields, lower scaling of disk opaque white. Diameter of disk 7 to 8 millim. ; length of arm 60 to 80 millim. Locality. King Island. * See p. 117 in the next communication. OF THE MERGUI ARCHIPELAGO. 103 Genus Opnrocnemis, Mill. §& Trosch., Syst. Aster. 1842, p. 87; Lyman, ‘ Challenger’ Report, p. 228. -OpuHIocNEMIS MaRMORATA, Link., sp., Mill. § Trosch. op. cit. p. 87. The genus Ophiocnemis was insufficiently diagnosed by Muller and Troschel, and the amended definition of Lyman appears to be excellent with a doubtful exception. The lower part of the interbrachia is quite naked according to the first-mentioned authors, and scaled according to Lyman. In a specimen of O. marmorata from the Mergui Archipelago the skin is certainly naked and plain. The anatomy of the arms given by Lyman is as remarkable as correct, and the specimen I have examined has the peculiar characters given on Lyman’s plate xlit. fig. 15. There is no drawing of Ophiocnemis marmorata, Mill. and Trosch., and their definition is very short. I have therefore considered the diagnosis and allowed for the variation of such forms, and venture to suggest some few alterations. The nodular stumps on the skin between the radial shields are not on visible scales, and they crowd the interbrachial margin, some being on the outer edge of the radial shields. They also crowd in the centre of the disk. Skin plain below. Generative scale large, broad, and arched below where free. A forked genital process on the aboral side of the mouth-shield. Side mouth-shields placed orally to the long diameter (from side to side) of the mouth-shields. First lower arm-plate very small. Beyond the disk the lower arm-plates are broader than long, in- curved orally and aborally, longest at the sides, and slightly incurved there. They increase in length towards the tip. Upper arm-plates much broader than long, at least four times as broad as long, arched and semi-keeled near the end of the arm, edges within and without either slightly curved or straight. Tentacular opening well at the side of the arm in mid-arm; a very small tentacle-scale on the edge of the side arm-plate. Usually four spines, small, eylindro-conical, not sharp, striated, and not hollow, only less dense in the centre, banded with colour; dull white, opaque, and microscopically spinulose. The first becomes a glassy bifid hook at mid-arm; the fourth varies in size, and the third from the lower arm is the largest. Diameter of disk 18 millim. ; length of arm 70 millim. Colour in alcohol generally brownish green with splashes of white, and dots, lines, and splashes of dark 104 PROF. P. M. DUNCAN ON THE OPHIURIDA green. Radial shields with white spots and lines. An indefinite ringing on the arms above. Locality. Mergui. The species has been found at Ceylon, Zanzibar, and N. Australia (?). A young form (diameter of disk 5 millim., arms 15 millim.) has the nodules on the skin of the disk well developed in the interradial areas, and there are stumps at the edge of the interbrachium where the skin below commences. There is some minute scaling at the centre of the disk, and the nodules are wellseen. The upper arm-plate is arched from side to side, but the length is greater than the breadth. The hooks commence near the disk. Localities. Elphinstone Island and Sullivan Island, 4 fathoms ; King Island. IV. Remarks on the Species. The presence of Ophiolepis cincta was to be expected on account of the great range of the species, and the specimens show all the well-known characters of the beautiful form. The other species of Ophiolepis, O. nodosa, is new, and is a very remarkable and distinct form. Unfortunately only one spe- cimen was found, but it was well preserved. Accessory scales and plates are in excess in this nodule-covered, bloated-looking species, for there is an unusual plate placed orally to the mouth- shields, and, besides extra mouth-papille, there is an accessory plate extending from the side arm-plates to the lower arm-plates transversely, and separating the consecutive tentacle-openings. This last character is seen in that extraordinary form Astrophiura permira, Sladen, as well as in Ophiolepis elegans, Lyman. The great nodules on the upper arm-plates and the cribriform texture of many, but not all, of the plates are very remarkable. Unfortunately the specimens of Ophioglypha are all too young for specific determination. The Amphiwra-like forms, whose marginal rim of scales and internal construction have caused them to be relegated to the genus Ophiophragmus, Lym., are very interesting. Many of the specimens are found without their upper disks and genital scales and plates, so that the upper surface of the mouth-shields and interbrachial rims besides the upper part of the jaws and teeth are exposed. Even some of the specimens which have the disk preserved appear to have had some diminution in its size, for one or two of the upper arm- plates close to the edge of the disk as it now exists are wanting. They appear to be deficient in consequence of the disk once having been larger. ‘The position of the genital plates and scales, which OF THE MERGUI ARCHIPELAGO. 105 has been noticed in describing the species, is most suggestive, and it is quite possible that the almost vertical direction, instead of the usual horizontal one, assumed by the plates and scales may have been necessary whilst the ovarian sac was filled with ova. Knowing how frequently Ophiurans die after parting with their ova, and how they sometimes suffer from defective amounts of carbonate of lime, I think that it will be worth while for the future to pay attention to the position of the genital plates and scales of Ophiurans which are living under unusual as well as under normal conditions. The anatomical details show that the characters of - Ophiophragmus and Amphiura can be combined; and it is very pro- bable that future research will place the genera closer together, or even decide that the first-named must become a subgenus of the latter. The importance of the differences of the internal con- struction of the mouth-frames mentioned and excellently illus- trated by Lyman (op. cit., ‘ Challenger’ Report, pl. xl. fig. 4) may not be so great as is now considered, especially in view of the structure of the particular organs in Ophiothrix variabilis, nob., which will be considered in the next communication. The new Ophiocnida with six arms, four arm-spines, and numerous mouth-papille is unfortunately founded upon a solitary specimen. Now that attention has been directed to this species, there is a possibility of larger specimens being obtained; it would be interesting to know whether the sixth limb is always retained. The Ophiothrices are numerous in individuals, and there are some very interesting forms amongst them. Almost all have long arms, Stumpy, thorned disks, and purple or sombre tints, and with some of the glassy spines on the arm broad at the top, oar-shaped, hollow, and compressed. In most of the species hooks are seen very near to the disk. In the majority the tentacles are large, long, and covered with whorls of papiile. There is one species which has given much trouble in classification, for not ouly are there four fairly marked varieties, but the type has considerable external resemblances to O. galatea, Ltk., whilst the internal structures present shapes which remove the forms from the type chosen by Lyman in illustration of the anatomy of the mouth- frames and arms within the disk, namely O. guinguemaculata, Mill. & Trosch. (¢ Challenger ’ Report, pl. xlii. fig. 5). The natnre of these structural differences will be noticed in the followig communication. The species Ophiocampsis pellicula, which can bend its arm in a vertical downward plane 106 THE OPHIURID® OF THE MERGUI ARCHIPELAGO. and which has no upper arm-plates, being covered on the upper arm with a minutely squamous skin, has very interesting arm- bones ; they will be considered and described in the succeeding pages. There is nothing to be added to the knowledge already published regarding the common Ophiocoma scolopendrina ; but I have added some notes concerning Ophiocnemis marmorata. DESCRIPTION OF THE PLATES. Puate VIII. Fig. 1. Ophiolepis nodosa, sp. nov. Upper surface, nat. size. 2. Part of the under surface of disk and arm, magnified. 3. Upper arm in part, magnified. 4. Ophiophragmus affinis, sp. nov. Upper view, magnified. 5. Part of disk below, magnified. 6. Upper surface of arm and mouth-frame within disk, magnified. 7. Ophiophragmus difficilis, sp. nov. Upper view, magnified. 8. Arm and mouth-frames from above, magnified. 9. Disk from below, magnified. 0. Ophiocnida sexradia, sp. nov. From above. 1 1 11. Part of under surface, magnified. Puate IX. 12. Ophiothria Andersoni, sp. nov. Upper view. 13. Part of under surface, magnified. 14. Ophiothrix merguiensis, sp. nov. Upper surface. 15. Part of the under surface, magnified. 16. Ophiothrix variegatus, sp. nov. Upper surface. 17. Part of the lower surface, magnified. 18. Ophiothria variabilis, sp. nov. Upper surface. 19. Part of the lower surface, magnified. 20. Ophiocampsis pellicula, sp. nov. Upper surface. 21. Under surface, magnified. Puats XI. (For description of the other figures (21-27) on this Plate, see p. 120.) 28. Spine of Ophiothrix Andersoni, magnified. 29. Hook, magnified. 30. Disk-stumps, magnified. 31. Spine of Ophiothrix merguiensis, magnified. 32. Spine of Ophiothrix variabilis, magnified. 33. Section of spine, magnified. 34. Small spine, magnified. 35. Disk-stumps, magnified. 36. Hook, magnified. 37. Spines of Ophiothrix Andersoni, magnified. 38. Hook, magnified. 39. Disk-stump, magnified. 40. Spine of Ophiocampsis pellicula, magnified. ON THE ANATOMY OF OPHIOTHRIX VARIABILIS, ETC. 107 On some Parts of the Anatomy of Ophiothrix variabilis, Dunc., and Ophiocampsis pellicula, Dunc., based on materials furnished by the Trustees of the Indian Museum, Calcutta. By Prof. P. Marrry Duncan, M.B. Lond., F.R.S., F.LS. [Read 3rd June, 1886.] (Puates X. & XI. figs. 21-27.) Contents.—I. Distinctions between Ophiothrix variabilis and Lyman’s type, O. quinquemaculata, Mill. & Trosch.—II. Mouth-frames; Jaw- plates; Teeth and Tooth-papille ; Muscles.—III. Radial Shields ; Genital Plates, Scales, and Muscles. —IV. Structure of the Arm-bones.—V. Special and general Remarks upon the Muscles.—VI. The Arm-bones of Ophio- campsis.—VI1. Description of Plates. I. Distinctions between Ophiothbrix variabilis, Dunc., and Lyman’s type, O. quinquemaculata, Mill. § Trosch. Tue structures of the upper surface of the arms within the disk, the genital plates and scales, the mouth-frames and the dental ap- paratus, which are seen after clearing out the inside of the disk, are exceedingly interesting in Ophiothrix variabilis (Plate X. fig. 1), and itis evident that they differ somewhat from those of the species O. quinguemaculata, Mill. & Trosch., which was chosen by Lyman as his type of Ophiothriz (see Lyman’s excellent figures, ‘ Chal- lenger’ Report, pl. xli. figs. 5-8). In O. variabilis there are six arm-bones between the conjoined mouth-frames and the nodular heads of the genital plates, whilst in Lyman’s type there are only four. In this type the upper parts of the first and second arm-bones are not very wide, but the corresponding parts of the first and second arm-bones of the Mergui form are wide; more- over, when the arms are straight the genital plates of the new form only reach inwards to the level of the second, or the interval between the second and third arm-bones, and not to the first arm-bone as in Lyman’s type. When the arm is bent sideways and fixed so, after becoming dry, the genital plate of the inwardly curved side of the arm of course reaches further adorally in O. variabilis. The length of the genital plates of both forms is much the same, but the greater number of arm-bones in O. varia- bilis, placed adorally to the outer and more or less fixed part of the plates, permits of greater sideways-bending movements of the arms. The shape of the upper parts of the arm-bones is very similar in both species ; perhaps the first plate is the larger in the 108 PROF. P. M. DUNCAN ON THE Mergui form, fig. 1, and it is Ophiothrician. The shape of the ~ genital plates and scales is slightly different. There is a peri- stomial plate in Lyman’s type, but not in O. variabilis. II. Mouth-frames, and Muscles; Jaw-plates ; Teeth and Tooth- papille, and their Muscles. The aboral edge of the conjoined mouth-frames, seen from above, is broad, and their union is by a stout, upward projecting, long nodule (Pl. X. fig. 1). The edges of the mouth-frames on either side of the mouth-slit are upwards projecting and crescentic in their outline; but the arch formed at the mouth- slit is imperfect, there being a small outer indentation at the median line which gives, with the outlines of the brachial edges of the mouth-frames, a trefoil shape to the brachial extension of the mouth. The incurving close to the junction of the mouth- frames at the median line of the brachial region is small. The width of the brachial area of the region of the mouth is limited by the comparatively radial direction of the jaws, and this direction evidently has some connection with the size of the space between the interbrachial edges of the mouth-frames im each interbrachial space. These opposed edges are long from within outwards, and slightly curved, and they are united by the fibres of the interradialis aboralis muscle. The mouth-frames much resemble those of Ophiophragmus as figured by Lyman in the ‘Challenger’ Report, plate xl. fig. 4. It is evident that the distance between the interbrachial edges, and therefore between adjacent mouth-frames, can be increased or diminished by the action of the muscular fibres, and the dis- tance doves vary in the dead specimen. When the edges are far apart, the obliquity of the jaws from the radial direction is greater than when the edges are closer; when that is the case, the direction of the jaws is more radial. The jaws are rather long, and there is the usual well-marked depression for the vessels and nerves. Tt will be noticed in the description of the underpart of the disk of the species (p.99)that the side mouth-shields are not united together orally to the mouth-shields, and that a skin intervenes ; moreover the separation along the median line of every jaw-angle is considerable. Hence there is a space which extends from the neighbourhood of the jaw-plate outwards between the side mouth- shields to the adoral edge of the mouth-shield. The skin of this ANATOMY OF OPIITOTHRIX VARIABILIS, ETC. 109 space is overlain, in the proper position of the animal, by a very thin muscular layer belonging to the interradialis aboralis, and the fibres are attached to the sides of the slit between the jaws, between the separated side mouth-shields, and between these last and the adoral edge of the mouth-shield. Considering these lower and superficial muscular fibres as acting in combination with the stouter and higher ones of the interradialis, it follows that contraction or expansion of the in- terbrachial spaces can occur, aborally, to the jaws. The contrac- tion, or the opposite condition, would increase or diminish, as the case might be, the radial direction of the jaws in relation to the jaw-plate, and would push this last inwards or the reverse. The movement of the jaws on the jaw-plate, however slight it might be, would influence the muscles which traverse the jaw-plate and are fixed on the outer or basal part of the teeth (Pl. X. fig. 3), as well as those which unite the approximated adoral ends of the mouth-frames—that is to say, the interradiales adorales superiores and inferiores. Probably expansion or relaxation of the interbrachial muscles would produce an opposite condition of the tooth-muscles. During expansion, on account of the increased obliquity of the jaws in relation to the jaw-plates, the mouth-opening would slightly enlarge and the muscles of the teeth would be tightened, and the teeth would assume the horizontal position. With con- traction there would be diminution of the space around the mouth, narrowing of the interbrachial areas, and relaxation of the tooth- muscles, accompanied by diminution of the size of the mouth. The possible nature of these movements may be gleaned from the following details of the jaw-plates, teeth, and muscles. The jaw-plate (torus angularis) is tall, broad and thin (fig. 2), and it projects slightly beyond the line of the sides of the jaws as well as above them and considerably below. It is a very distinct structure in this species, and it is broadest and most projecting inferiorly and rounded there, thence it slopes at the sides up- wards and gradually diminishes in breadth as far as the spot where the true teeth commence. The upper part of the plate which gives attachment to the teeth is not as broad as the inferior portion, but it is rounded off above where it is free. The oral surface of the plate is covered on the lower half by the 20 or 21 tooth-papille, and the upper half carries the four teeth. When the papille and teeth are removed, a number of rather LINN. JOURN.— ZOOLOGY, VOL. xXI. 9 LON PROF. P. M. DUNCAN ON THE regularly placed, elongate or circular, low projections become visible on the broad inferior portion of the plate; and on the upper part four vertical double rows of foramina. The double rows are separated by low horizontal ridges, and a median low ridge is placed vertically along the median line so as to separate the foramina into two lateralseries. The foramina are large and pass quite through the jaw-plate (figs. 2 & 3). The slightly expanded bases of the tooth-papille (fig. 4) cover the low projections, but the base of a tooth covers two of the horizontally placed foramina besides some of the surface of the ridges just above and below them (figs. 2, 3,6). The outer, or rather the side, tooth-papille are usually with elongate bases, and are placed on correspondingly shaped projections which are more or less oblique, and the papille which are along the median line of the plate are upon wider apart and circular low knobs. The papille (fig. 4) have their bases hollowed out so as to fit the projections, and connective tissue unites them with the plate around the edges of the projections. The highest papille are two in number, and resemble a true tooth divided along the median line and with an incurved free edge (fig. 5). But there are really two papille, and their bases are wide and elliptical in shape; moreover each has a pair of depressions in the base, and the union with the jaw-plate is by connective tissue only along a wide space (fig. 2). No muscular structures are found connected with the tooth-papille. | The four teeth are long, broad and thick at the base. They are composed of opaque carbonate of lime except at their free, sharp, yet broad, edge, where the mineral is semitransparent (fig. 6). On separating the teeth from the jaw-plate, it will be observed that their bases are elliptical and broad as well as hollowed-out. There is a double hollowing, and each hollow corresponds with a foramen in the jaw-plate (fig. 2). The upper and lower edges of the bases rest on the-ridges between the pairs of foramina. A small muscle passes out of each foramen and is inserted at the hollow of the base of a tooth, so that a tooth has two muscles, one on each side of the median line, and the direction of the muscles is rather oblique (figs. 3 (¢), 7). It may be noticed in some specimens that the side rows of tooth-papille are close to their neighbours of the next plates, and that on turning the animal on its back a very decided funnel- ANATOMY OF OPHIOTHRIX VARIABILIS, ETC. Hell shaped space exists Jeading to the two large papille which come next to the true teeth. It is evident that whilst the two papille just noticed can come in contact by their free edges with those of the opposite jaw-plates, none of the other papille can ever touch their opposite and similar structures. The tooth-papille do not therefore form any part of what has been inelegantly termed a “ chewing-apparatus.” On removing the jaw-plate from the mouth-frames the adoral surfaces of the jaws are seen side by side (fig. 8). Hach jaw sur- face is tall from below upwards, narrow from side to side, hollow along the median line inferiorly, and with four irregular depres- sions in the upper part. The four depressions correspond to the four foramina of one side of the jaw-plate, and the long hollow with the aboral surface of the jaw-plate on one side of the median line. The depressions give attachment to the muscles which pass through the foramina of the plate and are attached to the bases of the teeth (fig. 3). The long hollow below is for connective tissue which unites the converging jaw-ends and also the jaw-plates, and the groove of the hollow is completed by the approximation of the jaws. But there are about seven minute hollows or pits on the interradial side of each jaw, close to the projecting part which is in contact with the jaw-plate, and as many minute grooves pass from them over the edge and reach the Jong hollow. They appear to have no connection with the seven side tooth-papille, and they give attachment to muscular fibres (interradiales adorales inferiores) and connective tissue which bind the side of the jaw-plate to the jaw. It is possible that slight sliding movements of the jaw-plate upon the jaw-ends are thus rendered possible. It is evident that the duty of the muscles (inter- radiales adorales superiores) which pass through the foramina is to make the teeth stick out from the jaw-plate perpendicularly to it, and allow them to move slightly upwards or downwards at their free edge during the period when contraction does not occur. Chewing is, however, not possible, but the process of filtering occurs. Ill. The Radial Shields, Genaial Plates, Scales, and Muscles. The aboral end of the radial shield is rather narrow, is slightly separated from that of the other shield, and projects over an aboral ridge of the genital plate, and both are placed well over the 112 PROF. P. M. DUNCAN ON THE upper surface of the arm. On turning the radial shield up and separating it from the head of the genital plate, the following structures are seen (Pl. X. fig. 9). Close to the aboral edge is a short curved, transverse space which gives attachment to a rather broad, thin muscle (7), which passes downwards and is inserted into a corresponding space on the aboral and upper end of the genital plate (fig. 11,7). This extensor muscle passes aborally to a downward projection of the radial shield, and also to the globose head of the genital plate, and itis covered with thin skin (figs. 10, 11). Adorally to this space, on the under surface of the radial shield, is a downward projection resembling a slightly flattened hemisphere. Its lower, slightly flattened, and more or less curved surface articulates with the globiform head of the genital plate below (figs. 11, 18). Situated adorally to the projection on the under surface of the radial shield, and separated from it by a narrow transverse space, is a fan-shaped muscular attachment (fig. 9, am), the arch of the space being placed orally, and the chord of the are being transverse and bounding the narrow transverse space for the perihzmal canal adorally. The muscular marking is large and the fibres pass downwards and slightly aborally, form a stout little mass, and again expand aid are inserted into an expansion on the upper surface of a genital plate (figs. 9, 11, 13,am). This adductor muscle is very distinct, and is evidently capable of considerable extension during the contraction of the extensor, and of corresponding contraction when in positive action. There is a very thin slip of fibres, which seems to be muscular, passing from the outer edge of the radial shield below, and on a line with the origin of the adductor, to the radial-shield side of the broad genital scale (fig. 12, m). On removing the radial shield and looking downwards upon the upper surface of the arm, the genital plate is seen with the scale attached to the side remote from the arm. The genital plate is moderately long, longer than the scale (gs), but much narrower (figs. 12-15). It has a head not very unlike that of a human thigh- bone, continuous with a shaft by a broad neck, and at the interbra- chial side of the neck is a nodular surface which hasa little gibbosity for the articulation of the genital scale (figs. 18-15). Aborally to the nodular part, and extending beyond and below the head, is an expansion which ends aborally in the ridge already noticed as giving insertion to the extensor muscle (figs. 11, 12,15). Situated orally to the head on the upper surface of the genital plate is a ANATOMY OF OPHIOTHRIX VARIABILIS, ETC. 113 raised, irregularly triangular surface (fig. 13), corresponding in size to the fan-shaped muscular impression on the underpart of the radial shield (figs. 9,11). It is for the insertion of the adduc- tor muscle (am). Orally to this muscular insertion the genital plate narrows, is sharply rounded, and ends in a blunt point. A transverse section of the genital plate made orally tothe triangular surface is not circular in outline, although the plate seems to be cylindrical when seen from above ; it is more or less a bent curve in outline (fig. 15), and the outer surface, which looks towards the genital slit, is rounded and large, whilst the inner surface, which is in contact with the side of the arm, is not so large and is concave. Seen from below, the genital plate shows a furrow and the pro- jection at the side of the raised part for the insertion of the adductor, a rather narrow rod-like oral end, and a decided enlargement aborally, the aboral edge being below the insertion of the retractor (fig. 14). A side view shows foramina close to the neck, the globose head, the projecting aboral ridge, the nodule for articulation with the scale, and a foramen on the shaft (fig. 15). The genital scale (fig. 13) is long, wide, irregularly triangular, and boldly curved at its free interbrachial edge. The process for the junction or, rather, articulation with the genital plate is small, and has a slight concavity on its side towards the genital plate’s convex projection (or there may be an indefinite nodule). The articulation is by an indefinite arrangement not worthy of the name of ball-and-socket, but belonging to that category. The free brachial edge of the genital scale, which extends from the projection to the oral end of the scale, is nearly straight, long,andthin. This edge bounds the genital slit on the interbrachial side. There is some part of the edge of the scale free, but most of the upper surface is covered by the derm of the disk and is only seen after dissection. The specimen which showed these details has a trace of a slip, apparently muscular (fig. 13), which arises on the genital plate close to the neck, and from the trochanter-like side projection close to the head ; it passes between the raised surface for the adductor and the projection for articulation with the genital scale and is in- serted along the brachial edge of the scale just orally to the projection for articulation. The slip is very thin, and crosses over the outer end of the genital slit to reach the edge of the genital scale. 114, PROF. P. M. DUNCAN ON THE It is perfectly evident that the genital plate may have its position altered by the arm being depressed or elevated as much as is possible, and that the plate may be parallel with the arm, or may form a wide angle with it. The genital plate being on the side, and over the arm, may have the adductor relaxed so as to allow the radial plate and the dome of the disk to rise. It appears that under these circumstances the relative positions of the plate and scale alter, and that there must be a con- siderable movement of the scale on the pivot of the brachial projection. A few small overlapping scales are placed on the interradial edge of the genital slits between the oral termination of the genital scale and a process which is in contact with the aboral edge of the mouth-shield. These processes appear, on a super- ficial examination, to be parts of the mouth-shields passing outwards in the interradial spaces, and limiting, orally, the derm of the underpart of the disk. iyman has shown that they are really only closely attached to the mouth-shields with con- nective tissue, and maceration separates them. Hach of these processes is double and each touches its fellow at the median line; they are broadly attached to the aboral edge of the mouth- shield and are collar-shaped. At the median line aborally their edges diverge, sloping outward and then towards the arm, and reaching the genital slit. The derm is attached to the edges of these processes, which are properly genital scales, instead of to the aboral edge of the mouth-shields. IV. The Structure of the Arm-bones. These are formed generally after the type of the Ophiothricide, as described and figured in Lyman’s ‘ Challenger’ Report on the Ophiuroidea (pl. xli. figs. 5-8). There are, however, some points of difference. On the aboral surface of an arm-bone (PI. X. fig. 16) the cavity for the recep- tion of the umbo of the opposed bone is large, and below it is a prominent ridge which passes downwards, in the median line, to the peg. The projection in the median line may be narrow or considerably swollen ; and in either case the peg at the lower end is broad, projects aborally, and has a transparent, long and rather narrow articulating surface on each flank (PI. X. figs. 16,17; Pl. XI. figs. 21,22). The surfaces project so much as to give the appearance of two lateral pegs ; but that is not the case, ANATOMY OF OPHIO!HRIX VARIABILIS, ETC. 115 for there is but one, and it is concave at its lower part between the lateral articulating surfaces. Indeed, the breadth of the peg is very striking, as is also its amount of aboral projection. The expansion on either side of the ridge is considerable; and in some bones there is a swelling almost knob-like at the outer side of the usual socket for the knob of the next bone (Pl. X. figs. 16,17, k). The adoral surface of'a bone, corresponding to the aboral surface just noticed, has a broad, bluntly triangular pro- jecting umbo (w) beneath the slot-shaped surface of the apophysis (Pl. X. figs. 18,19). Below the umbo is a considerable depression for the median ridge of the opposed aboral surface, and the side continuation and its enlargements. The knobs (£) are large and project, and the cavity between them, and which merges below into the inferior notch, and which is for the reception of the broad peg, is rather large. The inferior notch is tall and wide. The apophysis is bent forwards above and is convex below. The upper muscle-fields of both surfaces are large, that of the aboral predominating, and the lower fields are, as is usual, small and oblique. V. Special and General Remarks upon the Muscles. Some of the muscles of Ophiothria variabilis have already been noticed in the description of the specimens, but it is necessary to consider others and to refer slightly to all. It is evident that the muscular development and distribution is not similar in all Ophiuride. Simroth has given the muscles of Ophiactis virens his careful attention, and his descriptions are very valuable (“ Anat. und Schiz. der Ophiactis virens, Sars,” Zeitschr. f. wiss. Zool. Bd. xxvii. p. 417, 1876). The muscles of the teeth (‘ interradiales adorales superiores ”), according to Simroth’s type, arise from the upper part of the adoral edge of the adjoining mouth-frames external to the jaw- plate or torus. There is one muscle to a tooth, and it may have a double insertion into the base of the tooth, there being two horizontal foramina in the jaw-plate at the base of the tooth, or a single one, the double foramen then being absent and repre- sented by a slit. In Ophiothrix variabilis, however, there are four and sometimes five depressions, diminishing in size from above downwards, in the substance of the adoral vertical edge of each mouth-frame (Pl. X. fig. 8); and consequently, when the two mouth-frames are com- bined, there is a double series of cavities placed side by side. A 116 PROF. P. M. DUNCAN ON THE muscle arises iu each of the depressions (fig. 8, c), and the fibres pass adorally through the foramen in the jaw-plate, which is in- ternal to them, atid are attached to one side of the hollowed-out base of a tooth (figs. 3,6, 7). The muscles are radial in direction, and there are two of them to each tooth, and eight in all. They are evidently the interradiales adorales superiores; and their action, by becoming tense and contracting, would be to fix the teeth tightly on the jaw-plate, so that they could project hori- zontally. On the other hand, as the muscles become lax, the bases of the teeth would be less tightly in contact with the jaw-plate, and some movement, up and down, of the free edge of the teeth would be possible. A muscle attaches the outside edges of the jaw-plate, on the brachial as well as the interbrachial sides, to the vertical processes (jaws) or adoral ends of the mouth-frames in the lower half; it arises from the oblique grooves near the edge, and is inserted on the edge of the jaw-plate. There are, according to Simroth, muscles between the vertical broad groove, formed by the union of the adoral surfaces of the jaws (fig. 8), and the aboral surface of the jaw-plate, and it is possible that they exist in Ophiothrix variabilis, but I have not verified the fact; at the same time there is connective tissue in the vertical groove uniting the conjoined skeletal parts. The “ interradiales aborales”’ (Pl. X. fig. 1, mz) are the largest and most important muscles of the mouth-frame regions ; the fibres are not radial in direction, but conform in direction to the circle formed by the adjacent mouth-frames. The fibres arise on the interradial flank of one, and are inserted into the flank of the opposite mouth-frame, that is, on the other side of the inter- brachial space. The greater part of the flanks is covered, and the fibres extend below to between the unjoined edges of the side mouth-shields, and touch the adoral edge of the mouth-shield at the median line. I have not found any muscular fibres in the space between the brachial flanks of the mouth-frames, such as the “‘ radiales ” of Simroth, although their existence is evident in Ophiactis. It is not necessary to do more than mention the existence of the adductor and retractor muscles of the genital plate and radial shield, since they have already been described. They are not mentioned by Simroth as occurring in his type. Lyman gives some excellent drawings of the adductores, but does not mention the retractor, which is, however, very visible in some ANATOMY OF OPHIOTHRIX VARIABILIS, ETC. 1H hd forms. Ludwig appears to be the only describer of retractores, of which he gives a very diagrammatic view. The little slips of fibres, possibly muscular, which connect the genital scale with the genital plate and the radial shield are formed of very delicate fibres which differ materially from those of the adductores for instance, but neither set is striated. It will be interesting to seek these unimportant slips in other species of Ophiothriz. (I have not found them in the British species.) The muscles of the upper and lower fields of the arm-tones are large, and are readily seen in broken-across joints. Vhere is a good deal of connective tissue, more or less fibrous, extending from the adoral to the aboral surfaces of opposed bones; and it is attached at the edges of the median projection and of the lateral continuation of the aboral surface, and to the edges of the umbo and median edges of the muscle-fields in the adoral surface. Besides this tissue two sets of muscles are visible in well- preserved specimens. One set is a single stout fibre on either side of the ridge leading down to the peg, and it arises above and a little external to the socket for the knob of the adoral bone (Pl. X. fig. 16, m). Its direction is almost from within outwards, and it is attached to the side of the depression below the umbo. The other set of muscles arise from the sides of the convex aboral surface of the apophysis, and they pass on either side to be attached to the edges of the upper muscle-field on the side of the adoral surface. The fibres are numerous, and there appear to be two sets of them, one being higher up than the other (Pl. XI. figs. 25, 26, 27). They appear to be necessary in order to restrain the lateral dislocation of the apophysis. They occur in all the Mergui Ophiothrices. VI. The Arm-bones of Ophiocampsis pellicula, Dunc. The absence of upper arm-plates and the ability of the arms to curl downwards would imply that the arm-bones could not be made exactly upon the Ophiothrician type. The opposed surfaces of the arm-bones are remarkable; and the first thing that strikes the eye is the enormous upper muscle-area on the aboral surface of the arm-bones (Pl. XI. fig. 23). The lower area is decidedly small, and the tentacle-opening is large near the disk and smaller further out. The next point to be observed is the upper and aborally projecting apophysis, which is like that of Ophiothriz, LINN. JOURN.—ZOOLOGY, VOL. XXI. 10 118 PROF. P. M. DUNCAN ON THE but possibly more inclined than is usual in that genus. The hollow for the reception of the umbo of the opposed arm-bone is deep and long from above downwards, and it occupies all the median line as far down as the upper edge of the notch of the’ inferior canal. There isno “peg.” On either side of the hollow for the umbo is a raised, rounded ridge extending from the apophysis downwards and on either side to reach the outer part of the upper edge of the lower muscle-area. On each rounded ridge is a nodule situated far above the notch for the lower canal (Pl. XI. fig: 23), so that a nodule occurs on either side of the median hollow for the umbo, and it is placed above the origin of the downward projecting roots of the canal-notch. The nodules are slightly elongate and project aborally, and are articulating surfaces. Beyond the nodules, on the side remote from the median line, are slight depressions. The lower canal is large, and the edges of the lower muscle- area are raised. ; On the corresponding adoral surface of an arm-bone (fig. 24), the upper process, or slot for the reception of the apophysis of the adorally placed bone, is large. Below isa long umbo, rounded, broad and projecting in the upper part, narrow and with a median projecting narrow ridge midway, and tumid, broad and projecting at the lowest part, which is at the upper edge of the comparatively small lower canal. This long umbo is therefore most tumid, largest, and most projecting at its upper and lower extremities, and is narrow and less projecting midway. There are no knobs on this surface, and the only approach to any such articulating process is a pair of indefinite enlargements where the upper edge of the lower muscle-area unites with the descending raised ridge of the sides of the lower canal. But the depressions for the nodules of the opposed aboral surface of the — next bone are seen on the sides of the umbo close above its lower enlargement. The absence of a peg or its analogue, the length of the hollow for the umbo, and the presence of a pair of nodules characterize this species in reference te the aboral surface of the arm-bone. On the other hand, the long umbo and the defective knobs of the adoral surface are just as peculiar *. The large size of the slot and the obliquity of the apophysis * The description is taken from joints near the disk; much modification occurs far out in the arm. ANATOMY OF OPHIOTHRIX VARIABILIS, ETC. 119 would enable great downward bending as well as lateral move- ment to occur; the long umbo and the corresponding socket would allow of a much greater amount of movement than is usual in Ophiothrix for instance, and the nodules on the aboral side would keep the umbo from slipping out. Fig. 1. aH oO 10. 11. 12. 13. 14. 15. DESCRIPTION OF THE PLATES. Puate X. The upper part of the arm, four of the six arm-bones, mouth-frames, jaws, and teeth of Ophiothrix variabilis, nob. Magnified and partly diagrammatic. g, genital plate; a, top of arm-bones; m/f, mouth- frame; 7, jaw; m2, interradialis aboralis muscle of one side of the mouth-{rames, . Jaw-plate, magnified, adoral surface. Foramina for the muscles, pro- jections for the bases of the tooth-papille. . Side view of a longitudinal section made, radially, through teeth, jaw- plate, and jaw. j, jaw; 7p, jaw-plate; c, depressions in the adoral surface of the jaw for the mterradiales adorales muscles, which may be seen passing through the section of the foramina in the jaw-plate to the bases of the teeth, 7 Diagrammatic and magnified. . Side and basal view of a large tooth-papilla. Magnified. . Lower surface of the uppermost tooth-papille. . Upper view of a tooth and of its base. Magnified. . The two upper foramina of a jaw-plate, showing muscle-slips coming out, to ke inserted in the base of a tooth, one on each side, magnified. . Adoral view of combined jaws: c, depressions for the muscles. Below are the vertical ridges on either side of the central groove. . Under surface of the radial shield, magnified, showing the tuberosity, ¢, the ridge, r, for the retractor, and the remains of the adductor, am. Magnified. Aboral end of the radial shield and genital plate: 7, ridge for retractor ; r*, ridge for the same onithe genital plate ; g, head of genital plate, in contact above with the tuberosity of the radial shield; the fibres of the retractor are indicated. Magnified. Side view of radial shield and genital plate. Same letiers as before. Magnified. Side view of the aboral end of the radial shieid and genital plate, showing the small muscular slip, m, to the genital scale, which is not figured. Magnified. Upperside of genital plate and shield: gs, genital scale; ms, muscle- slip from genital plate to shield ; am, adductor muscle on its raised attachment. Magnified. Under view of the genital plate, magnified. Genital plate, side view towards the genital scale: r*, ridge; p, nodule for articulation with the scale. Magnified. 120 ON THE ANATOMY OF OPHIOTHRIX VARIABILIS, ETC. Fig. 15*, Transverse section through the genital plate, magnified. 16. The central part of the aboral surface of an arm-bone of Ophiothrix : variabilis not far from the disk, magnified. The apophysis has a, tri- angular depression at its reot for the umbo of the next bone ; below is the median ridge ending in a bread double-faced peg. On either side of the ridge is a slender muscle, m, and at the side of the muscle remote from the median line the indefinite swelling, /. 17. The same view of an aboral surface, further outin the arm; the median ridge is nodular and broad above ; the peg is double-faced and broad. The position of the muscle is on the edge of the sockets on the side of the median ridge. Magnified. 18. ‘ne adoral surface of the arm-bone opposed to fig. 17: u, the umbo, with a descending short part and a wide upper expansion; #, the knobs; between them is the arched hollow for the double-faced broad peg of the opposed bone. Magnified. 19. An adoral surface nearer the disk, and corresponding nearly with fig. 16: s, the upper,part of the apophysis, with a slot or groove for the reception of the aborally placed apophysis ; w, the large broad umbo, with a hollow below, and the knobs are placed on theside of the hollow for the peg. Magnified. 20. A view of the same from above obliquely downwards, showing the pro- jecting umbo and knobs. The hollow below the umbo is not seen on account of the foreshortening. Magnified. Puate XI. 21. Ophiothrix variabilis, The double-faced peg, magnified. 22. The peg projecting, side view, magnified. 23. Arm-bone of Ophiocampsis pellicula, aboral surface near the disk : ud, the depression along the median line for the long umbo of the adoral surface of the next bone. The knobs are large, and the transverse ridges between the muscle-fields are well developed. Magnified. Diagrammatic. 24. An adoral surface: u, the long umbo, with a projecting convex part ‘ above the lower notch; depressions for the knobs of the opposed surface on each side of the median umbo, just above the transverse inter-muscle-field ridges. Magnified. Diagrammatic. 25. Part of the aboral surface of an arm-bone of Ophiothrix variegatus, magnified, showing muscles attached to the sides of the apophysis, and passing transversely so as to be attached to the inner edge of the upper muscle-field. Magnified. 26. Muscle-fibres attached to the inner edge of the upper notch upon the upper muscle-field, magnified. 27. The apophysis, seen from above obliquely, showing the two layers of muscular fibres on the sides of its convex surface. Magnified. (For description of figures 28-40 see page 106.) ON POLYZOA FROM THE MERGUI ARCHIPELAGO. 121 On the Polyzoa and Hydroida of the Mergui Archipelago col- lected for the Trustees of the Indian Museum, Calcutta, by Dr. J. Anverson, F.R.S., Superintendent of the Museum. By the Rev. Toomas Hincxs, B.A., F.B.S. (Communicated by Dr. Jounw Anverson, F.R.S., F.L.S.) [Read 20th January, 1887.] (Puate XII.) Dr. AnpEerson has placed in my hands for examination the Hydroida and Polyzoa which were obtained in the course of his investigations in the Mergui Archipelago. I have already (Annals and Mag. Nat. Hist. for May 1884) given some account of the Polyzoa, and described and figured several new forms. A list of these, with a diagnosis of each, is included in the present report. A small quantity of material has since been forwarded to me, which has yielded one or two interesting species hitherto un- deseribed, and it also enables me to extend the range of some well-known forms. Seven additional species have been noticed, which, with the fourteen already recorded, make a total of 21 species of Polvzoa from the Burmese waters. Six species of Hydroida have been recognized, of which two appear to be undescribed. The new material is insignificant in amount, and its chief interest centres in a fine mass of Wellia oculata, Busk (fortunately preserved in spirit), which proves to be rich in minute forms both of Polyzoa and Hydroida. The following is a list of all the species observed which are not included in my former paper. Class POLYZOA. Suborder CHEILOSTOMATA. Family CeLnaRiip2z. Netra, Bush. Nexis ocunata, Busk. A very large specimen of this species occurs, composed of many clustering shoots, and attached to a seaweed by a dense matted mass of delicate interlacing fibres. [Torres Strait; Victoria; Gulf of Florida; coast of Arracan ; Trincomalee; off Bahia; off Heard Island. Bathymetrical range. 10 to 550 fathoms Challenger’ Report). ] LINN. JOURN.— ZOOLOGY, VOL. XXI. EL 1122 REV. T. HINCKS ON POLYZOA Family BrceLLaRmp 2. Bueutepra, Verrill. Zoarium erect, composed of single series of zocecia, each of them rising from the upper portion of the dorsal surface of the one below it ; branches given off from the sides of the cells. Zoecia elongate, clavate, much attenuated below; aperture occupying a large proportion of the front. Avicularia articulated and capitate. BUGULELLA CLAVATA, n. sp. [ Woodcut. | Zoccia large, elongate, subtruncate at the top, ovate above, tapering off below the aperture; aperture elongate-oval, occu- pying about two thirds of the length of the cell, destitute of spines, with a membranous covering; orifice semicircular, at the very top of the aperture; a rather small articulated avicularium on each side, at the summit of the zoccium. Occium (?). Hab. On Nellia oculata, Busk. I am only able to give a very imperfect account of this species. Two or three small specimens occurred, and several camera-lucida sketches were taken from them. But before I had the opportu- nity of making a careful study of the characters, the specimens were unfortunately lost. As several sketches were made, all Bugulella clavata, greatly enlarged. agreeing substantially, there can be no doubt about the leading cha- racters ; and I hope the brief diagnosis given above, in conjunction FROM THE MERGUI ARCHIPELAGO. 123 with the woodcut, may be sufficient for identification should the species occur again. The specimens were small and immature, and did not enable me to determine with certainty the habit of growth, but it seemed to be eminently simple. In one or two cases a cell was present on each side of one of the zocecia in a main shoot (see Woodcut), which was probably the commencement of a branch. The zoccium is clavate in figure, elongate-ovate above, and produced below the aperture into a peduncular extension. It is impossible to determine the systematic position of this form with certainty in the absence of a fuller diagnosis, but it will rank amongst the Bicellariide, and probably in the genus Bugulella of Verrill. Family SrEGANOPORELLIDS. THALAMOPORELLA, Hincks *. THALAMOPORELLA Smirtit, Hincks. Syn. Steganoporella Smittii, 7d. History Brit. Mar. Polyzoa, p- 178, plate xxiv. figs. 5, 6. Hab. On stone, forming a large spreading crust. [Coast of Cornwall. | The Mergui Thalamoporella is undoubtedly identical with the Cornish species. It also closely resembles T. Rozdert, Audouin, form indica, mihi; the two forms only differ in the structure of the avicularium. In 7. Smitti the mandible is elongate and spatulate ; the margin of the beak is elevated on each side in the centre, and bends inwards at this point over the cavity, constrict- ing the aperture and reducing it to a narrow passage. In 7. Rozieri, form indica, the avicularium is comparatively short, rather broad and of about equal width throughout, and rounded above. The essential structure of the mandible is the same in both forms. It is composed of two distinct portions—a central piece which is slender, somewhat incurved on each side a little above the base, subacuminate at the upper extremity, and com- posed of solid chitinous material; this central portion is sur- rounded by a membranaceous extension or edging, which fills up the space between it and the stony framework of the beak. * IT have proposed this genus for the section of Smitt’s Steganoporella of which Thalamoporella Rozieri, Audouin, sp.,"may be taken as the type. “ Cri- tical Notes on the Polyzoa,” Ann. & Mag. Nat. Hist. for February 1887. ie 124 REV. T. HINCKS ON POLYZOA In all the other elements of structure the two forms agree; and I am inclined to think that 7’. Smtti: (notwithstanding the very distinctive character of the appendage) should rank amongst the varietal forms grouped about the 7. Rozieri of Audouin*. The calcareous bar across the cavity of the beak immediately below the mandible, which is a very usual element of avicularian structure, is wanting in 7. Smittic (as in other cases), and the mandible is simply articulated to a denticular process on each side. The avicularium (which replaces a cell) is developed on a distinct area, extending for some distance below the mandibular portion of the structure. Family Myriozoipz (part.), Smite. ScHIZOPORELLA, Hincks. ScHIZOPORELLA SPONGITES, Smitt, var. (Plate XII. figs. 7&8.) Zoecia disposed in lines, moderately convex (sutures shallow), subquadrangular or ovate, destitute of raised boundary-lines ; surface reticulate; orifice arched above, the lower margin occu- pied by a rather deep sinus, broad at the opening and tapering off to a rounded point, a small notch at each side, where the sinus commences; usually a slightly raised border encircling the orifice, which is carried across the front of the cell a little below the sinus ; peristome unarmed : a small avicularium, with pointed mandible directed upwards, placed obliquely close to one side of the orifice, suberect (occasionally one on each side) ; commonly a similar avicularium towards the base of the cell, pointing down- wards. Large spatulate avicularza, replacing a cell, distributed over the zoarium, frequent—the mandible much enlarged to- wards the upper extremity. Owcia ample, covering entirely the front of the cell above them, and encroaching on those at each side, prominent, rounded, rather broader than high, narrowing towards the front, with a very small orifice; surface reticulate. Hab. Forming a spreading crust, white and silvery, on stone. [Coast of Florida; Mazatlan. | This form, I believe, is rightly referred to Schizoporella spon- * “Contributions, &c.—II. Foreign Membraniporina (continued),” Ann. & Mag. Nat. Hist. 5th ser. vol. vi. p. 380, plate xvi. fig. 1 (1880). In this paper I have described the form indica as haying a slender pointed mandible, but this description only applies to the more solid central portion of it. FROM TIE MERGUI ARCHIPELAGO. 125 gites, Smitt* and Manzoni, though in several points it differs from the description and figure which these authors have given us. The celis of the latter are more decidedly rectangular, and are separated by conspicuous raised lines. The ocecium, though of large size and rounded above, as in the present form, is of great breadth and subtruncate in front (see Smitt’s figure 161); whereas that of the Mergui variety narrows off towards the oral extremity, which presents a rounded contour. ‘There is also a striking dissimilarity in the structure of the oral sinus, which in the Mergui variety is small and slit-like, slightly en- larged below, and occupies the centre of the lower margin, which is perfectly straight. The same difference, however, and perhaps inamore marked degree, is met with in the case of Schizoporella unicornis, and it can hardly be taken in itself to indicate a specific distinction. In the normal 8. spongites the zoarium is composed of several layers of cells placed one upon the other, and in the upper stratum at least the zocecia are very irregularly disposed; they are turned in all directions, and without definite plan. In the only specimen of the present form (a finely deve- loped one) which I have examined, the zoarium consists of a single layer of cells, and the latter are arranged with much regu- larity in lines. These differences, however, may depend upon age. ‘The large scattered avicularia differ somewhat in shape in the two forms, that of the Mergui variety being broadly spatulate. Family SELENAaRIIDE, Busk. Cuputaria, Lamouroux. ° CuPULARIA UMBELLATA, Defrancey. (Smitt; Manzoni.) A considerable number of specimens occur in Dr. Andergon’s collection of a species of Cupularia, which I believe to be identi- cal with the above. In its perfect condition the front of the cells is covered with a semiopaque membranous investment, which carries the orifice and opercular valve. Ina specimen from which this * ‘Floridan Bryozoa,’ part i. p. 42, pl. viii. figs. 161-163. Smitt identifies his Floridan species with Hschara spongites of Pallas and Moll, but this identi- fication must, I think, be accounted doubtful. Moll’s figure seems to represent aform of S. wnicornis, Johnston, which is at once distinguishable from S. spon- gites by the characters of the ocecium and the presence of the large spatulate avicularia. t+ This form clearly belongs to the Steganoporellidan series, and must be transferred to it. 126 REV. T. HINCKS ON POLYZOA outer wall (ectocyst) has been removed, the cells in the centre of the colony, and in a zone extending for a short distance round it, are furnished with an internal calcareous lamina, more or less complete and perforated—in some cases closing in the cavity of the cell entirely, and with a line of punctures round the margin. The cells in the outer zone of the colony (towards the margin), occupying about two thirds of the disk, show no trace of a lamina. The inner margin of the cells is minutely but strongly granu- lated, the dividing line between them thin and smooth, and the aperture irregular-oblong, occasionally oval. Both Smitt and Manzoni figure a calcareous lamina with a single line of rather large pores round the edge, and at the upper extremity a semi- circular opening (opesia of Jullien), distinct from the true orifice in the membranous outer wall. This condition I have not been able to observe, owing to the presence of the ectocyst in almost all the specimens. The cells in the centre of one of the colonies, to which I have just referred as possessing a lamina which completely fills in the cavity, and is altogether destitute of an opening (opesia), are no doubt abnormally deve- loped. In every colony the centre is occupied by the primary zocecium, which is oval in shape, and is surrounded by a belt of seven or eight cells which are disposed radiately about it. These are partially developed, and are destitute of an oral valve, although furnished with the membranous front wall. Probably in this region of the zoarium the internal calcareous lamina also is abnormal. The dorsal surface presents a very different appearance, according to the degree in which calcification has taken place. In young states the centre is occupied by a fragment of stone or coral (?), the base on which the colony was originally planted. This disappears after a time and its place is occupied by a central depression’ or hollow. The large vibracular cells, which project round the margin of the colony, are traversed by a smooth, keel-like raised line, on each side of which small granules are ranged. The divisions between the zocecia show distinctly on the inferior surface of the disk, which is more or less covered with minute granules. In the youngest states these are very feebly developed. In older colo- nies the dorsal surface is covered with elongate, radiating areas, separated by grooved, bifurcating lines, on which the granules are disposed longitudinally. As calcification proceeds a large part of the surface becomes coarsely granulous, while at the same time FROM THE MERGUI ARCHIPELAGO. 2 a smooth and thickened border forms round the marginal region, which is occupied by the vibracular cells. This crust gradually extends until it covers a large proportion of the disk, patches only of the strongly granulated surface appearing here and there. Suborder CTENOSTOMATA. Family Busxipx, Hincks. Busxtra, Alder. BUSsKIA SETIGERA, n. sp. (Plate XII. figs. 9-138.) Stem creeping, slender, jointed at intervals; short, opposite branches given off at the joints, usually bearing zocecia, the main lines of the stem anastomosing (?). Zowcia perfectly transparent and smooth, enlarged and rounded below, narrowing towards the upper extremity (somewhat flask-shaped), attached to the stem by a small basal process, the portion of the cell immediately above the lower extremity decumbent and adherent, the rest suberect ; the ventral side occupied by a large aperture, closed in by amem- branous wall, which extends from near the bottom to the top of the cell; orifice terminal ; four slender set of considerable length, each springing from an expanded base, placed on the margin of the oral extremity of the cell* ; one or two short tubular adhe- rent fibres given off from the side of the basal portion of the zoecium. Polypide small, and of very simple structure ; the ten- tacular sheath with its pencil of sete, when fully extended, of great length; the setz, before expanding, loosely twisted sub- spirally. Hab. On the stems of Wellia oculata, Busk, over which it creeps in profusion. The occurrence of a second species of Buskia has a positive interest, as throwing further light on a peculiar type of structure. Hitherto the genus has been represented by Buskia nitens, Alder, a smaller form than the present, which is not uncommon on the English coasts and ranges from the Mediterranean to the extreme north (Davis Strait, Barents Sea, White Sea) and to the Queen Charlotte Islands in the North Pacific. B. setzgera is compara- * In one or two of the figures (e. g. Plate XII. figs. 9 & 10) the spines are re- presented as taking their origin at some distance below the top of the chitinous portion of the zocecium ; they are really situated on the margin. 128 REV. T. HINCKS ON POLYZOA tively large, and from the suberect habit of the cell, the ventral aperture, extending from the bottom (or nearly so) to the top, is more apparent and more readily studied (Plate XII. fig. 9). The solid or chitimous portion of the zocecium forms a kind of carapace closed in below by a membranous wall. The polypide stretches along the upper portion of the cell immediately beneath the chitinous shell and issues at the top of the oral area. The structure, so far as it can be determined in spirit-specimens, is extremely simple; there seems to be no trace of a gizzard. In the setose portion of the tentacular sheath there is an interesting peculiarity. The sete before expanding, instead of being packed together so as to form a straight pencil, are seen to be subspirally arranged, some tending to one side, some to the other, and bear some resemblance to loosely twisted strands in a cord. As the tentacular corona moves upward and presses upon the base of the operculum, the sete disentangle themselves and expand into the usual funnel-shaped figure. The sete with the reversible portion of the sheath from which they rise equal the cell in length. The four setose appendages placed round the upper portion of the cell-margin form a very conspicuous and striking feature. When the polypide is exserted, they are thrown back and stand out from the cell; when it withdraws they are brought together and project at the summit. The tubular adherent processes given off from the lower part of the cell correspond to the spines round the base of the zoccium in B.nitens. The cells are developed in large numbers on the creeping stem, and the growth is luxuriant. Family Cytinpra@cripa. Cyiinpracium, Hincks. CYLINDR®@CIUM GIGANTEUM, Bush. I can detect no difference between the Mergui form and our British species. Hab. On Nellia oculata, Busk. [English coast; Adriatic; Bay of Naples; Queen Charlotte Islands, North Pacific. | FROM THE MERGUI ARCHIPELAGO. 129 SPECIES OF Potyzoa FROM MERGUI ALREADY RECORDED *. Family CELLULARIIDA. ScrupoceLtaria, Van Beneden. ScRUPOCELLARIA DIADEMA, Busk. (Plate XII. fig. 6.) The Mergui form agrees, on the whole, with figure 3 (plate Xxviil.) in the B. M. Catalogue, and with the figure of 8. ciliata, Audouin (=S. diadema, according to Busk), in the ‘ Challenger ’ Report (plate xi. fig.5); but there are differences between them which are worth noting. In the Mergui specimens the lowest spine on each side, when mature, is bifid at the extremity, and I have little doubt that where the spines are perfect this will be found to be a constant feature. The characteristic form of the scutum is shown in fig. 3 of the B.M. Catalogue, and, so far as I have seen, there is little variability in shape, except such as is dependent on the degree of development. The regular rounded outline represented in the ‘ Challenger’ figure is certainly not met with in Mergui examples. The scutum has a rather long, suberect pedicel; the shield is triangular, depressed in the centre, the sides very much elevated, running out into a strong dentate projection, the anterior margin also dentate. The an- terior avicularia are commonly large and more or less elevated, with an elongated mandible pointing obliquely downwards ; sometimes a smaller form occurs. I have seen no approach to the tall columnar form which is represented in figure 1 of the B. M. Catalogue. In the ‘Challenger’ Report Mr. Busk has referred S. diadema to Audouin’s Crista ciliata; but the identifi- cation is purely conjectural, and can only serve, as it seems to me, to perplex the student. To take a single point, the scutum of Crisia ciliata as delineated by Savigny, which is very definite and peculiar in character, is quite unlike that of S. diadema. Family BiceLLariipZ. Beant, Johnston. BEANIA MIRABILIS, Johnston. * “ Contributions towards a General History of the Marine Polyzoa.—XII. Polyzoa from India (Coast of Burmah).” Ann. & Mag. Nat. Hist. 5th ser. vol. xii, pp. 556-3862, pl. xiii. (1884). 130 REV. T. HINCKS ON POLYZOA Family MeEMBRANIPORIDR. Memepranipora, De Blainville. - MeEMBRANIPORA FAVUS, Hincks*. “ Zocecia oval, or hexagonal, or suborbicular (presenting many irregularities both in form and arrangement), of considerable depth, closely packed together, surrounded by a narrow brown line, which forms a kind of keel on the top of the cell-wall ; inner surface of the margin granular; aperture occupying the whole front of the cell, closed in by a delicate membrane ; numerous small cells of various shapes (sometimes quadrate, with an orbi- cular aperture) interspersed amongst the larger ones. Avicularia none. “ Zoarium forming a rather thick crust, and (especially in the absence of the membranous front wall) closely resembling a honeycomb.” MEMBRANIPORA MARGINELLA, Hinckst. “ Zoecia rather small, quincuncially arranged, ovate or pyri- form, sometimes pointed below, with a rather thick, unarmed, minutely granular margin; aperture occupying about two thirds of the front and closed in by membrane, contracted above and expanded and rounded below ; a small oval aviculariwm, borne on the margin of the zocecia, usually placed on the side, near the top. Occasionally cells with a very large oral operculum of a dark horn-colour, occupying nearly half the aperture, and in- closed by a thin raised border (? avicularian or reproductive).” Family StEGANOPORELLIDZ. STEGANOPORELLA, Smitt. STEGANOPORELLA MAGNILABRIS, Bush. Hab. Spreading over stone. SmirtrPorRa, J. Jullien. SMITTIPORA ABYSSICOLA, Smitt. * Ann. & Mag. Nat. Hist. ser. 5, vol. xiii. p. 357, pl. xiii. fig. 2 (1884). + Ibid. p. 358, pl. xiii. fig. 1 (1884). FROM THE MERGUI ARCHIPELAGO. 131 Family MicrororELiip2. Microporretia, Hincks. MIcROPORELLA VIOLACEA, Johnston, form PLAGIOPORA, Busk. [Escnara Furcensis, Busk. Provisionally placed in this family. | Family Myrtozorpm (part.), Smite. ScHIZOPORELLA, Hincks. SCHIZOPORELLA BIAPERTA, D/ichelin. Family Escuarips (part.), Smite. Leprauia, Johnston (part.). LEPRALIA ROBUSTA, Hincks *. “Zoecia very large, ovate, quincuncial, flattish, separated by a rather deep furrow, which is occupied by a line of large punc- tures ; surface uneven, rather coarsely granulose, usually a small depression in the centre; orifice large, much taller than wide, arched and expanded above, somewhat contracted below, con- stricted a short distance above the inferior margin, which curves outwards ; on each side of the orifice (or sometimes on one side only) a much elongated subspatulate aviculariwm, which origi- nates some way below the orifice and slants obliquely up- wards to a little above the top of it; mandible long, blunt and slightly expanded at the extremity, and directed upwards. Oecium rounded, somewhat prominent, moderate in size, surface roughened.” PoRELLA, Gray. PoRELLA MALLEOLUS, Hincks tf. “Zoecia rectangular, disposed in linear series, depressed, sepa- rated by delicate raised lines ; surface covered with small punc- tures and nodulous ridges ; a line of larger foramina round the sides; orifice arched and expanded above, much contracted below, the margin about the centre projecting inward on each side, * Ann. & Mag. Nat. Hist. ser. 5, vol. xiii. p. 360, pl. xiii. fig. 4 (1884). t Ibid. p. 361, pl. xiii. fig. 5 (1884). yl 132 REV. T. HINCKS ON HYDROIDA lower lip slightly curved (nearly straight); within it an avicula- rium with a hammer-shaped mandible. Occasionally an avicula- rium at one side, which takes its origin some way down the cell and slopes upward to the top of the orifice; mandible elongate, slightly expanded at the base, slender above it, and pointed at the extremity, directed upwards. Ocaciwm(?). “Zoariwm incrusting, whitish, of very delicate material.” Smirtia, Hincks. SMITTIA TRISPINOSA, Johnston, vars.* Family CELLEPORIDA. CELLEPORA, Fabricius (part.). CELLEPORA, ? n. sp. Identical with C. brunnea (provisional name) of my “ Report on the Polyzoa of Queen Charlotte Islands ’’+. Suborder CYCLOSTOMATA. Family Lichenopvorip”. LicuEnopora, Defrance. Licoenopora Nova-ZraLanvia, Bush. HY DROIDA. The foliowing species of Hydroida occur amongst Dr. Ander- son’s dredgings :— Suborder Turcarnora, Hincks. Family CaMPANULARIIDS. Osetia, Péron J§ Lesueur. OBELIA ANDERSONI, n. sp. (Plate XII. figs. 2-4.) Stem straightish, slightly angulated at the origin of the pedicels * Ann. & Mag. Nat. Hist. ser. 5, vol. xiii. p. 361, pl. xiii, figs. 6 & 7 (1884). t ‘Geological and Natural History Sarvey of Canada,’ Ottawa, 1884. {| Reprinted from the Ann. & Mag. Nat. Hist. for 1888 and 1884.] FROM THE MERGUI ARCHIPELAGO. 133 which support the calycles, and annulated above them. Hydrothece alternate, borne on short pedicels ringed throughout (about 7-8 rings), narrow, contracted at the base, from which point the wall slopes outward for a short distance, so that the lower extremity of the calycle is funnel-shaped, the upper three fourths subcylin- drical (expanding very slightly towards the orifice); the rim cut into 10-16 narrow, rather tall, blunt denticles. Gonothece springing from the main stem near the base of the pedicels, borne on short ringed stalks, narrow at the base, expanding upwards, truncate at the top. Gonozootds medusi- form. Hab. On WNellia oculata, Busk. The peculiar form of the lower portion of the calycle is charac- teristic. P OBELIA BIFURCA, n. sp. (Plate XII. fig. 1.) Stem simple, straightish, annulated above the pedicels. AHydro- thece alternate, of large size, tall, contracted below, expanding gradually towards the oral extremity, at which point they are about three times as wide as at the base, borne on short stalks, annulated throughout and not tapering; the rim cut into about a dozen (?) broad, bicuspid denticles. Gonothece(?). Hab. On Nellia oculata. In the absence of the reproductive zooids this species is re- ferred provisionally to the genus Obelia. In some respects it is allied to O. bicuspidata, Clarke, obtained off Thimble Islands, coast of New England ; but the latter seems to be smaller and of much more delicate habit, the calycles are very slender and lineated longitudinally (8-10 distinct lines extending from the top almost to the base), the pedicels are comparatively long and are represented as tapering upwards, and the stem is compound. CampanuLaria, Lamarck (part.). CaMPANULARIA RARIDENTATA, Alder. (Plate XII. fig. 5.) Hab. On Nellia oculata. [Great Britain. | So far as the calycle is concerned, the Mergui form is not distinguishable from Alder’s species. The reproductive capsules were not observed. 134 ON HYDROIDA FROM THE MERGUI ARCHIPELAGO, ~ Family PLuMULARIIDE. AGLAOPHENIA, Lamourouc. Subgenus Lyrocarpia, Kirchenpauer. AGLAOPHENIA CRISPATA, Kirchenpauer. [Java; Formosa. | Subgenus MacrorayncHa, Kirchenpauer. AGLAOPHENTA URENS, Kirchenpauer. Hab. Coral-bed. [Javasea; Batang; Brisbane; ? Singapore, var. | The following remark by Capt. Werner, who obtained this species in the Java sea, is given by Kirchenpauer*:—“ Diese Pflanze fand ich beim Baden auf der Insel Onrust, in der Java See. Sie war an einen Stein angewachsen, und brannte beim Beruhren wie Brennesseln, konnte also wohl ein Urtica navalis sein.” Dr. Anderson also mentions its remarkable stinging properties. The specimen from Mergui is about a foot in length. Family SERTULARIIDE. Ipta, Lamourouc. Ipta Pristis, Lamourous. Several specimens occur amongst the dredgings. I have met with no notice of this interesting form but the original descrip- tion of it by Lamouroux. It is clearly entitled to generic rank, though the diagnosis given by this author is quite inadequate. Prof. Allman informs me that the species occurs amongst the ‘Challenger’ dredgings, and will be described and figured in the forthcoming part of his monograph on the Hydroida. The gono- thee are not noticed by Lamouroux; they occur in some abund- ance on the Mergui specimens. They are borne on the main stem, and are urn-shaped, rounded below, expanding very slightly upwards, and narrowing at the top into a short tubular, neck- like orifice. They are prettily ribbed longitudinally, and supported on a short peduncle. [Australian seas. | * ‘Ueber die Hydroidenfamilie Plumularide, einzelne Gruppen derselben, und ihre Fruchtbehalten.” Hamburg, 1872. ON A NEW SPECIES OF BRACHYONYCHUS FROM MERGUI. 135 DESCRIPTION OF PLATE XII. Fig. 1. ? Obelia bifurea, n. sp. 2 & 3. Obelia Andersoni, n. sp. Calycles, magnified. 4. Gonotheca, 5. Campanularia raridentata, Alder. 6. Serupocellaria diadema, Busk. 7. Schizoporella spongites, Smitt, var. n. 8. Ocecium. 9-12. Buskia setigera, n. sp. 13. The opercular sete, showing the sub- Spiral arrangement. On a new Species of Brachyonychus from the Mergui Archi- pelago. By Henry Watrer Bares, F.R.S., F.LS. [Read 2nd December, 1886. ] Family Carapipa#, subfam. Panag mina. Bracuyonycutus ANDERSONI, 0. sp. Allied to the Siamese species, B. levipennis, Chaudoir, from which it differs by its smaller size, its rather less rounded elytra, and the fine punctuation of the base, as well as of the ninth and external half of the eighth (lateral) interstices. Convex; thorax hexagonal, with the lateral angles rounded, sides explanate but not reflexed ; elytra relatively short, ovate, more broadly ovate than in the well-known Hudema angulatum, F., striate-punctate, with nearly plane interstices (rather more convex on the sides), very finely alutaceous and impunctate, except at the base and sides. The epistome is faintly rugose, the forehead coarsely in- tricate-rugose, without trace of punctures; the thorax closely confluent-punctulate, more distantly punctured on the broadly flattened margins. The elytra have each two transverse red spots or fascia ; the anterior extending from the third stria to the lateral margin, and composed of elongate spots which are shorter on the fifth and seventh interstices ; the posterior, much more dentate, extending from the third to the eighth stria, and composed of spots which project alternately in front and behind. The prosternum, metathoracic episterna, and sides of the basal ventral segments are sparsely and rather coarsely punctured. Length 25 millim. The species is intermediate between Brachyonychus levipennis and B. sublevis Chaudoir, both known only from Siam and Cochin China. The genus contains only one other described species, B. hwmeratus, which is also from Cochin China, Loe. Elphinstone Island. 136 DR. JOHN ANDERSON ON BIRDS List of Birds, chiefly from the Mergui Archipelago, collected _ for the Trustees of the Indian Museum, Calcutta. By Joun Awnverson, M.D., LL.D., F.RB.S., F.L.S. [Read 17th June, 1886. ] THE following list of Birds chiefly records the distribution, in some of the more outlying islands of the Mergu Archipelago, of a few of the species enumerated by Messrs. Hume and Davison from the neighbouring mainland of Tenasserim. It appears from the list of localities appended to the ‘ Birds of Tenasserim,’ and from the text of the work itself, that Mr. Davi- son’s researches in the Archipelago were confined to the islands of Kolan and Patoe (Pataw), and to some of the small islands in the immediate neighbourhood of Mergzi; and it is stated that the island of Kolan* is 25 miles south of Mergui, whilst Patoe or Patoi is described as “ forming as it were the S.W. pier of Mergui harbour.” On the other hand, Mr. Davison made a pre- liminary reconnaissance of the avifauna of that enormous and difficult tract of country known as the province of Tenasserim, which extends from the Pah-choung in the north to the Pakchan in the south, an area 625 miles in length and over 70 miles in breadthr. The following list is therefore published merely as a small supplementary contribution, if I may be permitted so to call it, to Mr. Davison’s hereculean labours in the Province; seeing it somewhat extends our knowledge of the distribution of some of the species in the northern portion of the Archipelago, a region to which his labours were very partially directed. The islands to which my attention was chiefly confined were King Island, Elphinstone Island, and Sullivan Island. In the first 87 days, in the second 14 days, and in the third 9 days were all I could devote to bird-collecting. In King Island and Eiphin- stone Island I had to entrust the work to a Karen, as the other numerous duties to which I had to attend fully occupied my time, and because the Museum collectors I had brought with me from * Tn the chart of the northern part of the Mergui Archipelago, published in 1875 by the Hydrographic Office of the Admiralty, the only island called Kolan lies 5 miles directly to the west of the town of Mergui; while in the map ofthe southern portion of the Archipelago no island of that name is to be found ; but there are in both charts many unnamed islands. + ‘Stray Feathers,’ vol. vi. p. u. FROM THE MERGUI ARCHIPELAGO, 3 7 Calcutta had proved thoroughly incapable and so timid that they would not enter the forest. Such a course had this great disad- vantage, that it necessarily restricted my enumeration of the birds obtained to the limit of a mere list with localities. The birds were identified in India before they were brought to this country; but in order to ensure accuracy it was desirable that they should be gone over by one thoroughly familiar with the subject, who would correct any errors of identification, and be able also to direct attention to any birds presenting features worthy of remark. I esteem myself fortunate in having secured for these ends the services of Major Wardlaw Ramsay, who possesses an intimate acquaintance with the birds of Tenas- serim. I have indicated the few observations he has recorded by appending his name to them. In the collection only one bird, Butreron Cappelli, appears as an addition to the fauna of Tenasserim; but at the same time the distribution of some of the species recorded in Messrs. Hume and Davison’s ‘ Birds of Tenasserim’ has been extended. While pointing out these few instances, I have not thought it necessary to repeat the distribution of species already fully recorded by these authors. Having been present in the islands only for the very short periods already mentioned, the list gives no information regarding the migrations of species beyond recording the presence of well- known migratory birds. Considering, however, the very different climatic conditions which prevail in the islands during the two monsoons, it is probable that the birds which frequent the smaller and more exposed islets and islands during the north- east monsoon congregate on the larger and more sheltered islands until the strength of the storms of the south-west mon- soon is past,—if they are not in many instances driven for shelter to the mainland. Davison records that Halcyon chloris in December kept entirely to the sea-coast and banks of the creeks ; but that in June, after the rains had commenced, it became very numerous about the gardens and even in the town of Mergui itself *. Judging from my observations in the localities I have mentioned (and I may state that I crossed King Island and Elphinstone 2 Op: cit ps 18: LINN. JOURN.—ZOOLOGY, VOL. XXI. 12 138 DR. JOHN ANDERSON ON BIRDS Island, and ascended the highest point, 1500 feet, of Sullivan - Island), my impression is that bird-life is less richly represented than on the mainland; but of course this can only be accurately ascertained by a thorough investigation of the islands. This list, if it serves as a beginning to this end, will have fulfilled its purpose. The islands, with the exception of a very limited portion of King Island, where there are a few scattered Burmese and Karen settlers, are uninhabited except by the sea-gipsies, the Selungs, who spend the greater part of the year on the sea in their boats, in which they eat and sleep while not fishing, or hunting with their dogs for pigs in the forest. During the south-west monsoon they betake themselves to sheltered bays, where they erect miserable temporary dwelling-places on stakes driven into the sands immediately above high-water mark. The absence of recular villages, the existence of strong and dangerous currents between the islands, and the presence of sunken rocks not yet indicated in the charts, make the Mergui Archipelago a difficult region to investigate. Moreover, during the south-west monsoon navigation among the islands towards the sea is almost imprac- ticable to sailing vessels, so that unless steam were used, or the observer settled down in one of the groups for the season, observations would have to be confined to the north-east mon- soon, when the sea is generally calm and the breezes moderate. With regard to the first locality, King Island, or Padaw* as known to the Burmese, it is situated about 10 miles due west of the town of Mergui. The island is 24 miles in length by 10 miles in breadth; it is hilly throughout, and its highest point, which lies nearest its southern end, the ridge running north and south, is 2123 feet high, but to the north and throughout the range there are other heights but little below 2000 feet. It is covered with a dense forest infested with tigers, pigs, and mouse-deer; and on the very summits of the highest peaks areto be found trees attain- ing nearly 200 feet in height. Apparently more streams water the eastern than the western side, and at their mouths, and, mdeed, all along the sea-margin on this aspect of the island, are exten- sive Mangrove-forests, succeeded by undulating and hilly ground, on which are occasionally to be seen an orchard of Mangosteens, — Dorians Areca-nuts, and Cucoa-nut Palms. On the western side, * Tat, 12° 18’ to 12° 42’ N. FROM THE MERGUI ARCHIPELAGO. 139 which is exposed to the full force of the sea-breezes, and the slope of which is more steep, there are fewer Mangrove-swamps, and° in place of orchards there are temporary fishing-stations. At Yimiki, in the centre of the island, towards the north, there are a few clearings made by Karens, Burmese, and some advanced Selungs; but the attempts at cultivation are insignificant con- sidering the size of the island, which retains its character as a great primeval forest. Elphinstone Island* is the most seaward member of a group of beautiful islands lying to the south-west of King Island, and known to the Selungs as the Doang group. The three other principal islands of the group are Ross, Grant, and MacLeod Islands. Elphinstone Island is distant about 30 miles in a straight line from the town of Mergui. It is of irregular form, being cut up by numerous bays, and its highest point, which has not yet been measured, is visible 10 to 11 leagues at sea. The island is about 10 miles long and 8 in its extreme breadth; there is only one high peak, the rest of the island consisting of low hills, and the peak presents this peculiarity as compared with the other hills I have seen in the Archipelago, that a considerable area of its eastern aspect seems to be free of trees and to be rocky ; but all the remainder of the island is covered with forest. No tigers are found in the Doang group, but pigs and mouse-deer are numerous. Sullivan Island ¢ is considerably to the south of King Island, as it lies 17 miles off the mainland and more or less parallel to it. It is a long and narrow island, being only 5 to 6 miles broad in its widest part, its average width not being more than 3 mniles. It is traversed throughout its length by a ridge of hills rising to 1523 feet. It is also covered by a dense forest com- paratively clear of undergrowth on some parts of the hill-slopes, and so dense overhead as to exclude the direct rays of the sun; the trees not unfrequently attaining to an altitude of 250 feet. In this island I first met with Casuarina equisetifolia growing wild along its western shore associated with Cycas Rumphii, two outlying members of the Austro-Malayan subregion. * Lat. 12° 16! to 12° 26' N. t Lat. 10° 41' 30” to 10° 59’ 30” N. 2s 140 DR. JOHN ANDERSON ON BIRDS Gerocrcuta crrrina (Lath.), Oates, Birds of British Burmah, iavoleyingy. 3: a. &, Elphinstone Island, Ist; 6. ¢, 4th; and ¢. 2, 5th March, 1882. d. Owen Island, 3rd Jan. 1882. This bird is probably distributed over all the islands of the Archipelago of any size, with the exception of the more seaward chain of islands, which extends from Cabosa southwards to the Great Western Torres group. I observed it in the Elphinstone group andin Sullivan Island, almost the northern and southern extremes of the Archipelago. Monricota cyanus (Linn.), Oates, op. cit. vol. i. p. 11. a. 3, Nga Islet, King Island, 11th Feb. 1882. 6. 2, Crow Islet, 27th Feb. 1882. c¢. 9, Zediwon, Mergui, 23rd Dec. 1881. d. 3 (variety), Mergui, 23rd March, 1882. “The specimen, d, belongs to the intermediate form which Mr. Seebohm has called WM. cyanus solitaria, Cat. Birds Brit. Mus. vol. v. p. 818.” (Wardlaw Ramsay.) A rocky islet, about 50 yards in length, 30 in width, and probably not more than 25 feet high, lies four miles to the west of King Island, the largest island in the Archipelago, and three miles to the south of Maingy Island, which rises to 2000 feet in height. This little islet consists chiefly of a mass of bare rock, but on a flattened portion of its summit were a few stunted scragey shrubs and a profusion of long grass. A miniature cliff overhangs a little cave, with a muddy and sandy shelving shore, on which struggle some dwarfed mangrove-trees, while in a tiny gorge, down which trickles some fresh water, grows an abundance of ferns. On this sequestered spot I found Monticola cyanus associated with the following birds: Corvus macrorhynchus, Hal- cyon chloris, Hypothornis azurea, and Anthreptes malaccensis, some of which had built their nests and were breeding. CopsYcHUS SAULARIS (Linn.), Oates, op. cit. vol. 1. p. 20. a. Thaing, King Island, 1st Feb. 1882. 6. 3, Elphinstone Island, 3rd March, 1882. CITTOCINCLA MACRURA (Gm.), Oates, op. cit. vol. 1. p. 22. a. 3, Elphinstone Island, 7th March, 1882. 6. 3, Yimiki, King Island, 24th Feb. 1882. ce, d. Thaing, King Island, 31st Jan. 1882. e. do, Mereui, 23rd March, 1882. MixorNIs RUBRICAPILLUS (Zick.), Oates, op. cit. vol. i. p. 50. a, 6b, c. Sullivan Island, 9th Jan. 1882. d. Thaing, King FROM THE MERGUE ARCH{[PELAGO. T4L Island, 24th Jan. 1882. e. ¢, Elphinstone Island, 13th March, 1882. Mr. W. Davison*, in his invaluable notes on the Birds of Tenasserim, says that this bird is very abundant throughout the Province as far south as 18° N. lat. I, however, found it to be common in Sullivan Island, which lies between lat. 10° 42’ and 10° 59’ 50" N. _ Turpinus Assorrs (B/.), Oates, op. cit. vol. 1. p. 53. a. Sullivan Island, 12th Jan. 1882. 6,c. Thaing, King Island, 31st Jan. 1882. PELLORNEUM SUBOCHRACEUM, Swinhoe, Oates, op. cit. vol. 1. p. 66. a. Thaing, King Island, 23rd Jan. 1882. 6. ¢, Elphinstone Island, 14th March, 1882. “These specimens are remarkable for the rusty hue of their plumage; otherwise they are identical with Tenasserim speci- mens.” (Wardlaw Ramsay.) PHYLLOSCOPUs BOREALIS (Blas.), Oates, op. cit. vol.i. p. 77. a. 9, Yimiki, King Island, 24th Feb. 1882. Surorra surorta (Forst.), Oates, op. cit. vol. i. p. 107. a. Sullivan Island, 12th Jan. 1882. 6. Mergui, 14th Dec. 1881. Mr. Davison found this bird generally distributed throughout the province as far south as Mergui, but he dves not appear to have found it to the south of that town. ° ORTHOTOMUS ATRIGULARIS, Temm., Oates, op. cit. vol. 1. p. 109. a. Thaing, King Island, 24th Jan. 1882. Sirra FRoNTALIS, Horsf., Oates, op. cit. vol. 1. p. 134. a. 3, Elphinstone Island, 5th; 6, ¢. ¢, 6th March, 1882. Herpornis xaNTHoLEucA (Hodgs.), Oates, op. cit. vol. 1. p. 151. a. Sullivan Island, 18th Jan. 1882. CALOBATES MELANOPE (Pail.), Oates, op. cit. vol. i. p. 159. a. 2, Elphinstone Island, 13tb March, 1882. * ‘Stray Feathers,’ vol. vi. p. 266. 142 DR. JOHN ANDERSON ON BIRDS LIMoNIDROMUS INDICUS (Gim.), Oates, op. cit. vol. 1. p. 164. a. &, Elphinstone Island, 14th; 6. 2, 13th March, 1882. To.E viripEscens, Bl., Oates, op. cit. vol.i. p. 177. a. King Island. Micropus MELANOCEPHALUS (Gim.), Oates, op. cit. vol. 1. p. 181. a. Minthantoung, Mergui, 22nd Dec. 1881. 6. 36, Mergui, 27th Dec. 1881. CRINIGER GUTTURALIS (Bp.), Oates, op. cit. vol. i. p. 185. a. Thaing, King Island, 24th Jan. 1882. 6. ¢, Yimiki, King Island. TRACHYCOMUS OCHROCEPHALUS (Gm.), Oates, op. cit. vol. 1. p. 188. a. 6, Zediwon, Mergui, 23rd Dec. 1881. Pycnonotus anauis (Horsf.), Oates, op. cit. vol. 1. p. 191. a. 3, Mergui, 23rd; 6. 9, 26th March, 1882. Pycnonotts Finuaysoni, Strickl., Oates, op. cit. vol. i. p. 193. a. 9, Elphinstone Island, Ist; 6. 9, 2nd March, 1882. e. Thaing, King Island, 12th Feb. 1882. d. 3, Mergui, 23rd March, 1882. e. ¢, Minthantoung, Mergui, 22nd Dee. 1881. Orocomesa sacosa (Linn.), Oates, op. ett. vol. i. p. 198. a. 6,6. 2, Mergui, 19th March, 1882. c,d. 3 9, Mergui, 27th Dec. 1881. OvocoMPsa FLAVIVENTRIS (Tick.), Oates, op. cit. vol.1. p. 199. a, 6. 2, Minthantoung, Mergui, 22nd Dec. 1881. AEGITHINA TIPHIA (Linn.), Oates, op. cit. vol. 1. p. 202. a,b. 3, Mergui, 23rd March, 1882. ¢ 9, Minthantoung, Mergui, 22nd Dec. 1881. /Ernoruyncuus Larresnayit (Hartl.), Oates, op. cit. vol. i. p. 204. a. 6, Minthantoung, Mergui, 22nd Dec. 1881. “Tn the yellow colour of the ear-coverts and margins of the wing-coverts this specimen approaches 4%. xanthotis, Sharpe.” (Wardlaw Ramsay.) CHLOROPSIS CHLOROCEPHALA (Wald.), Oates, op. cit. vol. i. p- 208. FROM THE MERGUI ARCHIPELAGO. 143 a. Sullivan Island, 9th; 6, ¢. 11th Jan. 1882. d. g, Elphin- stone Island, 1st March, 1882. Irena PueLLA (Lath.), Oates, op. cit. vol. 1. p. 209. a. 3,6. 2, Elphinstone Island, 4th; c. g, 9th; d. 2, Ist March, 1882. e.¢, Yimiki, King Island, 24th Feb. 1882. f. 9, Zediwon, Mergui, 23rd Dee. 1881. OrroLts 1npicus, Jerd., Oates, op. eit. vol. ii. p. 211. a. 3, Elphinstone Island, 9th; 6.9, 18th March, 1882. c¢.6, King Island, 15th; d. g, 18th Feb. 1882. e. 9, Mergui, 23rd March, 1882. Bucwanea atra (Herm.), Oates, op. cit. vol. i. p. 218. a. Sullivan Island, 9th Jan. 1882. 6. 2, Mergui, 20th; c¢. ¢, 23rd March, 1832. d. Zediwon, Mergui, 23rd Dec. 1881. BucHanGa Lonatcaupata (A. Hay), Oates, op. cit. vol. 1. p- 220. a. 3, Mergui, 19th March, 1882. BucHanGga LEUCOGENYS, Wald., Oates, op. cit. vol. i. p. 222. a. 6, Ngaor Fish Islet, King Island Bay, 18th Feb. 1882. 6.9, Elphinstone Island, 13th March, 1882. DissEMURUS PARADISEUS (Linn.), Oates, op. cit. vol. i. p. 225. a. 2, Elphinstone Island, 4th; 6, ¢. g, 5th; d,e. ¢ 2, 9th March, 1882. “The intermediate race with a moderate crest.” (Wardlaw Ramsay.) Prricrocorts cinEREus, Lafres., Oates, op. cit. vol. i. p. 241. a. 6, Elphinstone Island, 13th March, 1882. Mr. Oates first met with this species at Kyeikpadien, near Pegu, in the cold weather, where he also in the same season ob- tained P. cantonensis, and he mentions that Mr. Davison also procured this species at various places in the Malay Peninsula. PERICROCOTUS PEREGRINUS (Linn.), Oates, op. cit. vol.1. p. 245. a. 6, Elphinstone Island, Ist Feb. 1882. 6, ¢. 6 2, Elphin- stone Island, Ist; d. 2,¢.9, 5th March, 1882. f. ¢, Thaing, King Island, 31st Jan. 1882. g. ¢, Ihapo, King Island, 28rd Jan. 1882. The prevalence of this Minivet im these islands seems to verify Mr. Dayison’s observation that it isa frequenter of the sea-coast. 144, DR. JOHN ANDERSON ON BIRDS Muscirrea erisoua (B1.), Oates, op. cit. vol. i. p. 257. a. 6,6. 9, Elphinstone Island, 5th March, 1882. In the “ Birds of Tenasserim”’* it is remarked that this is a rare visitant to the Province, and that if common anywhere it is only so in the islands of the Mergui Archipelago. Mr. Davison procured it fifty-two miles north-west of Moulmein and at Kolan Tsland, twenty-five miles south of Mergui. HyporHyMis AZUREA (Bodd.), Oates, op. cit. vol. 1. p. 265. a, 6. Sullivan Island, 12th; ¢. 9th Jan. 1882. d. g, Elphin- stone Island, 4th; e. ¢, 9th March, 1882. f. 2, Yimiki, King Island, 24th Feb. 1882. g. Thapo, King Island, 25th Jan. 1882. h. Thaing, King Island, 24th Jan. 1882. 7. Zediwon, Mergui, 23rd Dec. 1881. I observed this bird on the small rocky islet previously men- tioned under Monticola cyanus. It is common in King, Elphin- stone, and Sullivan Islands. RaIPIDURA JAVANICA (Sparrm.), Oates, op. cit. vol. i. p. 267. a. 6, Mergui, 23rd March, 1882. HEMICHELIDON sIBrRica (Gim.), Oates, op. cit. vol. i. p. 275. a. Thaing, King Island, 21st Jan. 1882. 6. Thaing, King Island, lst Feb. 1882. ALSEONAX LATIROSTRIS (Rafl.), Oates, op. cit. vol. 1. p. 277. a. Thaing, King Island, 24th; 6. 31st Jan. 1882. c. 9, Nga, King Island Bay, 9th Feb. 1882.. d. 2, Minthantoung, Mergui, 22nd Dec. 1881. SIPHIA RUBECULOIDES (Vig.), Oates, op. cit. vol. 1. p. 287. a. Thaing, King Island, 31st Jan. 1882. 5. Minthantoung, Mergui, 22nd Dee. 1881. “ Tn this specimen (8) the rufous extends in a narrow line almost to the chin.” (Wardlaw Ramsay.) Hirunpo rustica, Linn., Outes, op. cit. vol. 1. p. 302. a. Minthantoung, Mergui, Jan. 1882. 6. ¢, Mergui, 24th March, 1882. HyYPuroLeris sAvVANICA (Sparrm.), Oates, op. cit. vol. 1. p. 308. a. 9, Mergui, 2Uth Feb. 1882. 6. 2, Elphinstone Island, 13th Feb. 1882. c Nga Islet, King Island, 14th Feb. 1882. * Op. cit. p. 206. FROM THE MERGUL ARCHIPELAGO. 145 Mr. Davison met with a few examples of this species at Mergui in June, but they are not numerous, and he believed that they were then migrating. He never observed them in any other part of Tenasserim; but Mr. Theobald states that he found this species breeding at Tenasserim in April, and Mr. Oates seems disposed to regard it as a resident species. AETHOPYGA CARA, Hume, Oates, op. cit. vol. 1. p. 316. a, 6. 3, Sullivan Island, 9th; c. 9, 11th Jan. 1882. d. g, Zimiki, King Island, 24th Feb. 1882. Mr. Davison * observed this bird only as far south as the town of Tenasserim ; but I found it not at all uncommon at Sullivan Island, among shrubs close to a beach which was fringed by Casuarina equisetifolia, Forsk. Cryyyris Hassenrr (Zemm.), Oates, op. cit. vol. i. p. 818. a. 9, Sullivan Island, 9th; 6, c. ¢,11th Jan. 1882. d. 9,, Thaing, King Island, 31st Jan. 1882. This species I found associated with the previous Sun-bird in the same locality in Sullivan Island. Both were equally common. CINNYRIS FLAMMAXILEARIS (B1.), Oates, op. cit. vol. i. p. 320. a, b. Sullivan Island, 9th Jan.1882. c. 3, Elphinstone Island, 5th; d. 6, 9th March, 1882. From the same locality in Sullivan Island as the two foregoing Sj ecies. ANTHREPTES MALACCENSIS (Scop.), Oates, op. cit. vol. 1. p. 324. a. 6, Sullivan Island, lst Jan. 1882. 6. 3, ¢. 9, d. 3, Thaing, King Island, 24th Jan. 1882, 1st Feb. 1882. e. 3, Thapo, King Island, 25th Jan. 1882. f£ 9, Nga Islet, King Island Bay, 9th; g.h. 5, ¢- 2, 11th Feb. 1882. &. 3,1. 2, Crow Islet, 27th Feb. 1882. m. 9, Elphinstone Island, 7th March, 1882. The presence of this Sun-bird on the little rocky island men- tioned in the beginning of this list, and also in King Island, Elphinstone Island, and Sullivan Island, indicates its wide distri- bution among the islands of the Archipelago. In King Island I found it generally on old clearings in the neighbourhood of the villages of Thaing and Thapo, at the head of King Island Bay, and on Nga Island. * ‘Stray Feathers,’ vol. vi. p. 179. 146 DR. JOHN ANDERSON ON BIRDS ANTHREPTES SINGALENSIS (Jemm.), Oates, op. cit. vol. 1. p. 326. a. 2, Yimiki, King Island, 24th Feb. 1882. On clearings in the forest in the centre of the island. DiczUM cRUENTATUM (Linn.), Oates, op. cit. vol. 1. p. 332. a. Thaing, King Island, 1st Feb. 1882. 06. 9, Elphinstone Island, 4th; ¢ 9, 5th March,1882. d. Mergui, 27th Dee. 1881. DiczUM TRIGONOSTIGMA (Scop.), Oates, op. cit. vol. 1. p. 336. a. 6, Elphinstone Island, 4th; b,c. ¢ Q, 5th March, 1882. d. Thapo, King Island, 25th Jan. 1882. e. King Island, 16th Feb. 1882. PassER MonTANUS (Linn.), Oates, op. cit. vol. i. p. 348. a,b. 5, Mergui, 23rd March, 1882. AMADINA acuricauDA (Hodgs.), Oates, op. cit. vol. 1. p. 364. a,b. 2, Yimiki, King Island, 24th Feb. 1882. On clearings in the centre of the island. STURNOPASTOR SUPERCILIARIS, B/., Oates, op. cit. vol. 1. p: 378. a. Mergui, 20th; 6. 6, 19th; c, 2, 29th March, 1882. ACRIDOTHERES Fuscus (Zemm.), Oates, op. cit. vol. i. p. 380. a. 3, Mergui, 9th; b, 9, 20th; c. 2, 23rd March, 1882. CALORNIS CHALYBEA (Horsf.), Oates, op. cit. vol. 1. p. 390. a. 6, Elphinstone Island, 5th Feb. 1882; b. 2, 2nd; ¢, 6, Ath; d, S,€. 6, f. 6,9. 2h. 27 Sth; 7. 23 Teche Meme 1882; k. 3, 8rd July, 1882. J. ¢, Thaing, King Island, 31st Jan. 1882. This bird is very common along the margins of the forest at the head of the great bay on the south-eastern side of Elphin- stone Island, and I observed a large colony on a rocky islet on the western side of Sullivan Island, where it was breeding in recesses in the rocks, finding cover among some small shrubs on the summit of the islet. GRACULA JAVANENSIS (Osbeck), Oates, op. cit. vol. 1. p. 398. a, b. Sullivan Island, 12th; ¢. 9, 12th; d. 13th Jan. 1882. e. 2, f. 2, Elphinstone Island, 9th March, 1882. g. Thaing, King Island, 27th Jan. 1882. This species was not uncommon at Sullivan Island, and its FROM THE MERGUI ARCHIPELAGO. 147 favourite resort was the tops of the highest trees in the forest. Its noisy calls became a familiar sound just before sundown. Corvus MAcRoRHyNCcHUS, Wagler, Oates, op. cit. vol. i. p. 397. a. 3, Yimiki, King Island, 24th Feb. 1882. This Crow appears to be generally distributed throughout the islands, and, as already mentioned, I found a pair even breeding on a small rocky islet. There were four young ones in the nest. Corvus INSOLENS, Hume, Oates, op. cit. vol.i. p. 399. a. 9, Mergui, 20th; 6. 6, 19th March, 1882. CRYPSIRHINA VARIANS (Lath.), Oates, op. cit. vol. i. p. 404. a,b. 2, Mergui, 23rd March, 1882. CYMBORHYNCHUS MACRORHYNCHUS (Gm.), Oates, op. cit. vol. i. p. 428. a,b. 3,¢,d. 3, Mergui, 28rd March, 1882. e. o,f. 2, Zedi- won, Mergui, 23rd Dec. 1881. Among shrubs in dense shade on the outskirts of a mangrove- swamp. Cortocatia Lincu1, Horsf. § Moore, Oates, op. cit. vol. ii. Dp. LO: a. 9, Yimiki, King Island, 24th Feb. 1882. Blyth* has recorded this bird from the Mergui Archipelago. Mr. Davison says it does not occur on Mergui Island itself nor in any of the small islands near it. LyYNCORNIS CERVINICEPS, Gould, Oates, op. cit. vol. ii. p. 22. a. Elphinstone Island, 3rd March, 1882. ALOPHONERPES PULVERULENTUS (Zemm.), Oates, op. cit. vol. ii. p- 29. a. 2, Elphinstone Island, 13th March, 1882. HEMICERCUS CANENTE (Less.), Oates, op. cit. vol. ii. p. 80. a,b. 2, Elphinstone Island, 9th March, 1882. Picus canicapruuus, Bl., Oates, op. cit. vol. ii. p. 36. a. 2, Elphinstone Island, 9th; 6. 2, 13th March, 1882. * Journ. As. Soc. Beng. pt. ii. (extra no.) vol. xliii. 1875, p. 85, 148 DR. JOUN ANDERSON ON BIRDS GECINUS ViRIDANUS (BI.), Oates, op. cit. vol. 11. p. 48. a. 3, Yimiki, King Island, 24th Feb. 1882. 6. Mergui, 23rd March, 1882. CHRYSOCOLAPTES STRICTUS (Horsf.), Oates, op. cit. vol. 11. p. 5°. a. 2, Yimiki, King Island, 29th Feb. 1882. b,c. g,d. 2, Elphinstone Island, 9th; e. 2, 13th March, 1882. MeuirropHacus LescuEnavxtt (Vieill.), Oates, op. ert. vol. ii. p- 68. a. Thaing, King Island, 24th Jan. 1882; 6. 9, 24th Feb. 1881 ; c. 6, 22nd Dec. 1881. Evrystomus orrenratis (Linn.), Oates, op. cit. vol. ii. p. 70. a. 6, Yimki, King Island, 24th Feb. 1882. ALCEDO BENGALENSIS, Gm., Oates, op. cit. vol. ii. p. 72. a. 2, King Island Bay, 17th Feb. 1882. 6. ¢, Elphinstone Island, 5th; c. 2, 9th; d. §, 138th March, 1882. PELARGOPSIS AMAUROPTERA (Pears.), Oates, op. cit. vol.ii. p. 78. a. 3d, Elphinstone Island, 13th March, 1882. 6. ¢, Yimiki, King Island, 24th Feb. 1882. Haucyon piteata (Bodd.), Oates, op. cit. vol. i. p. 83. a. Thaing, King Island, 31st Jan. 1882. Ha.cyron cHuoris (Bodd.), Oates, op. cit. vol. ii. p. 85. a. 2, Elphinstone Island, lst; 6. 9, 9th March, 1882. ¢. ¢, d. 9, King Island Bay, 17th Feb. 1882. e. 36, f. 2,9. 9, Crow Islet, 27th Feb. 1882. This is the most prevalent Kingfisher among the northerm islands. In February it was found breeding on Crow Islet. DIcHOCEROS BICORNIS (Linn.), Oates, op. cit. vol. ii. p. 87. a. Thaing, King Island, 31st Jan. 1882. 6. Elphinstone Island, 13th March, 1882. This species is doubtless distributed thoughout the Archipelago, but is relatively rare compared with Rhytidoceros subruficollis. ANTHRACOCEROS ALBIROSTRIS (Shaw), Oates, op.cit. vol. ii. p. 90. a. Thaing, King Island, 30th Jan. 1882. 6, ¢. 6 9, King Island, 8th Feb. 1882. d. $, Elphinstone Island, 7th; e. 2, 13th March, 1882. RHYTIDOCEROS SUBRUFICOLLIS (B1.), Oates, op. cit. vol. ii. p. 91. a. d,b. g,c¢. 6,d. S, King Island, 29th Jan. 1882. e. 9, FROM THE MERGUI ARCHIPELAGO. 149 6th; f. 2, 8th Feb. 1882. g. 9, Yimiki, King Island, 24th Feb. 1882. This Hornbill occurs in great numbers in islands of the Archi- pelago, especially in those towards the north. On the mainland, however, south of Tavoy, Davison records that he only obtained a single straggler, while to the north of Tavoy as far as Moul- mein the species was common. In the morning and evening large flocks were being constantly seen at great heights flying long distances, and crossing the sea from island to island, their approach being heralded by the loud croaking noise so characteristic of their flight generally, associated with a peculiar harsh call, which, when the birds hustled each other, whether in sport or anger I knew not, became converted into a noise resembling the bark of a dog. It isa very wary bird, and keeps to the tops of the highest trees. A Karen brought to me at King Island, on the 8th March, a female bird and her egg, both of which be had removed from a hole in a large tree which he had recklessly felled, with the assist- ance of some other Karens, for the sole purpose of obtaining these objects, in the hope that I would purchase them. Along with the bird and egg he also brought a part of the nest itself, which was made up of a resin which is common in these islands and of a substance which he described asa gum. The pure white egg had a somewhat leathery shell deficient in lime. Harvpactes oresxtos (Zemm.), Oates, op. cit. vol. ii. p. 100. a. Thaing, King Island, Ist Feb. 1882. 6. ¢, Zimiki, King Island, 24th Feb. 1882. In clearings surrounded by forest. Cucuus striatus, Drap., Oates, op. cit. vol. ii. p. 105. a. 2, Elphinstone Island, 9th March, 1882. HIEROCOCCYX SPARVERIOIDES (Vig.), Oates, op. cit. vol. il. p. 108. a. 6, Elphinstone Island, 9th March, 1882. Mr. Davison met with this Cuckoo only as far south as Amherst. Hinrococorx nanus, Hume, Oates, op. cit. vol. 11. p. 110. a. 2, Elphinstone Island, 5th; 6. 6th March, 1882. Mr. Davison discovered this species at Bankasoon in the extreme south of the province of Tenasserim, but afterwards found it “in 150 DR. JOHN ANDERSON ON BIRDS . April in the forests at the base of Nwalabo, and between that place and Tavoy ” *. CAcoMANTIS THRENODES, Owb. et Hein., Oates, op. cit. vol. ii. pe: a. 6, Mergui, 23rd March, 1882. SuRNICULUS LUGUBRIS (Horsf.), Oates, op. cit. vol. uu. p. 112. a. Thaing, King Island, 24th Jan. 1882. 6. 3, Elphinstone Island, 9th March, 1882. RuorvopytTeEs Tristrs (Less.), Oates, op. cit. vol. 1. p. 121. a. 3, 6. 9, Yimiki, King Island, 24th Feb. 1882. ec. 2, Elphinstone Island, Ist; d. ¢, 14th March, 1882. e. Minthan- toung, Mergui, 22nd Dee. 1881. CENTROCOCCYX INTERMEDIUS, Hume, Oates, op. cit. vol. u. p. 126. a. 2, Yimiki, King Island, 24th Feb. 1882. 0. 2, Elphinstone Island, 9th; ¢. 2, 14th March, 1882. XANTHOLEMA H#MACEPHALA (Muill.), Oates, op. cit. vol. ii. p. 1386. a. 3, Yimiki, King Island, 24th Feb. 1882. PaLHorNIS Fascratus (Mill.), Oates, op. cit. vol. 11. p. 143. a. Thaing, King Island, 31st Jan. 1882. 6. 3, King Island Bay, 19th Feb. 1882. LorIcULUS VERNALIS (Sparrm.), Oates, op. cit. vol. ii. p. 146. a. 6,6. 6, Thaing, King Island, 2nd Feb. 1882. KETUPA JAVANENSIS, Less., Oates, op. cit. vol. 11. p. 149. a. 2, Elphinstone Island, 138th March, 1882. 6. King Island, 19th Feb. 1882. Scors pennatus, Hodgs., Oates, op. cit. vol. 11. p. 154. a. &, Nga Islet, King Island Bay, 18th Feb. 1882. “ This belongs to the race named S. stictonotus by Sharpe, Cat. Birds Brit. Mus. vol. 1. p. 54." (Wardlaw Ramsay.) Scors Lempist (Horsf.), Oates, op. cit. vol. 11. p. 156. A young bird, probably of this species. Ninox scututata (Raffi.), Oates, op. cit. vol. 11. p. 159. a. 9, Elphinstone Island, 7th March, 1882. * «Stray Feathers,’ vol. vi. pp. 157, 502. FROM THE MERGUI ARCHIPELAGO. Sst ASTUR TRIvIRGATUS (Temm.), Oates, op. cit. vol. ii. p. 177. a. Thaing, King Island, 1st Feb. 1882. Burastur inpicus (Gm.), Oates, op. cit. vol. ii. p. 197. a. 3, Mergui, 23rd March, 1882. Hattastur rnpus (Bodd.), Oates, op. cit. vol. ii. p. 201. a. 6, King Island, 24th Feb. 1882. 6. Q juv., King Island Bay, 11th Feb. 1882. PeRNIS PTILORHYNCHUS (Zemm.), Oates, op. cit. vol. ii. p. 207. a. 3, Elphinstone Island, 14th March, 1882. This rare bird was recorded many years ago by Blyth * from Mergui, and more recently by Hume and Davison from Moulmein and Amherst. Baza LoPHOTES (Cwwv.), Oates, op. cit. vol. ii. p. 208. a. 3, Elphinstone Island, Ist March, 1882. ARDEA SUMATRANA, Raffl., Oates, op. cit. vol. ii. p. 244. a. 2, King Island Bay, 19th Feb. 1882. I only observed this large Heron on one occasion, when the extensive mud-flats in King Island Bay were exposed at spring- tide, on which occasion they were visited by about half a dozen of these birds. Heropias Garzerra (Linn.), Oates, op. cit. vol. ii. p. 248. a. Nga Islet, King Island Bay, 18th Feb. 1882. DEMIEGRETTA SACRA (Gin.), Oates, op. cit. vol. ii. p. 250. a. 3, Sullivan Island, 6th Jan.1882. 6. 3, King Island, 17th Feb. 1882. c. ¢, King Island Bay, 20th; d,e. ¢ 2, 26th Feb. 1882. Common throughout the islands and much frequenting the mud-flats at King Island Bay. BuroriDEs JAVANICA (Horsf.), Oates, op. cit. vol. ii. p. 254. a. 2, 6. Imm., Elphinstone Island, lst; ¢. g, 7th March, 1882. Atsocomus Punicets, Tick., Oates, op. cit. vol. 1. p. 289. a,b. 35, Nga Islet, King Island Bay, 18th Feb. 1882. Nea Islet is a small well-wooded island about a quarter of a mile long and 80 feet high, situated at the head of King Island Bay, with some other and similar islands close beside it. These * Trans. As. Soc. Beng. yol. xxi. p. 436, 152 DR. JOHN ANDERSON ON BIRDS islands, besides supporting a small population of their own, were visited by many birds from the main island (King Island) during their daily wanderings in search of food, and this Pigeon was among those visitors. It ranges from Tonghov through Pegu to Tenasserim, and in the latter province Davison observed it near Mergui. Turtur TIGRINUS (Lemm.), Oates, op. cit. vol. 11. p. 290. a. Juv., Thapo, King Island, 23rd Jan. 1882. 6. Thaing, King Island, 31st Jan. 1882. e¢. 3g, Yimiki, 24th Feb. 1882. CHALCOPHAPS INDICA (Linn.), Oates, op. cit. vol. il. p. 297. a. 3, Elphinstone Island, 4th; 6. ¢, 5th March, 1882. CarpoPHaGa ZNEA (Linn.), Oates, op. cit. vol. 11. p. 301. a. Thaing, King Island, 31st Jan. 1882. 6. 9, Elphinstone Island, 9th; ¢, d. ¢, 18th March, 1882. I observed a large Imperial Pigeon in Sullivan Island, but as it was extremely wary, and frequented only the tops of the highest trees in the densest parts of the forest, I did not sueceed in obtaining any examples. It may probably be C. inswlaris from the Nicobar Islands, a species which Oates has suggested may oceur in the Archipelago. TRERON NIPALENSIS (Hodgs.), Oates, op. cit. vol. 1. p. 306. a. 3, Elphinstone Island, 5th March, 1882. OsMOTRERON BIctINcTA (Jerd.), Oates, op. cit. vol. 11. p. 808. a. 6, Elphinstone Island, 9th; 6. ¢, 13th March, 1882. OsMOTRERON VERNANS (Linn.), Oates, op. cit. vol. 11. p. 809. a. Yimiki, King Island, 24th Feb. 1882. 6. 3, Elphinstone Island, 9th March, 1882. This Pigeon has been found on the mainland from Mergui south to Malewoon. Burreron Cappretri1.—Treron Cappelli (Lemm.), Salvad. Ann. Mus. Civ. Genov. vol. v. p. 285 (1874). a. 6, Elphinstone Island, 138th March, 1882. “The occurrence of this species is interesting. So far as I know, there is no record of its having been obtained so far north before.” (Wardlaw Ramsay.) TURNIX PLUMBIPES (Hodgs.), Oates, op. cit. vol. 11. p. 337. a. 9, Mergui, 23rd March, 1882. 4 FROM THE MERGUI ARCHIPELAGO. 153 GALLICREX CINEREUS (G'm.), Oates, op. cit. vol. ii. p. 849. a. 3, Mergui, 19th March, 1882. Davison only observed this species as far south as the mouth of the Tavoy estuary. Popica PERSONATA (Gray), Oates, op. cit. vol. ii. p. 353. a. 3, Elphinstone Island, 13th March, 1882. This rare bird, which was originally described from a Malacca specimen, has been found by Davison at Bankasoon, Mergui, and Amherst. AieraLitis GEorFroyi (Wagl.), Oates, op. cit. vol. ii. p. 366. a. 9, Elphinstone Island, 5th March, 1882. Mr. Davison never met with this bird in Tenasserim, but Mr. Hume’s collectors obtained it 52 miles N.W. of Moulmein, and Dr. Armstrong at Amherst. ANGIALITIS MONGOLICUS (Pall.), Oates, op. cit. vol. ii. p. 368. a,b. 9, Elphinstone Island, 5th March, 1882. ANGIALITIS CANTIANA (Lath.), Oates, op. cit. vol. ii. p. 368. a. 2, Elphinstone Island, 8th March 1882. 6*. LoBIVANELLUS ATRONUCHALIS (Bl.), Oates, op. cit. vol. ii. p. 374. a. 3,6. 2, Yimiki, King Island, 24th Feb. 1882, STREPSILAS INTERPRES (Linn.), Oates, op. cit. vol. ii. p. 376. a. 3, Guna or Fish Islet, King Island Bay, 4th; 6. ¢, 9th Feb. 1882. This bird does not appear in Hume and Davison’s list. GALLINAGO C@LESTIS (Frenzel), Oates, op. cit. vol. ii. p. 381. ay: Trinea Minvra (Leisl.), Oates, op. cit. vol. ii. p. 389. a,b. 9, Mergui, 23rd March, 1882. TRINGOIDES HYPOLEUCUS (Linn.), Oates, op. cit. vol. ii. p. 899. a. 9, King Island, 17th Feb. 1882. * Label lost. + With no information. LINN. JOURN.—-ZOOLOGY, VOL. XXI. 13 154: DR. P. P. C. HOEK ON DICHELASPIS PELLUCIDA. On Dichelaspis pellucida, Darwin, from the scales of an Hydro- phid obtained at Mergui. By Dr. P. P. C. Horx, Member Royal Academy of Science of the Netherlands, Leiden. (Communicated by Dr. J. AnpERson, F.R.S., F.L.S.) [Read 17th February, 1887. | (Prats XIII.) Dr. ANDERSON collected many specimens of this species from an Hydrophid obtained among the fishing-stakes at Mergui. They were attached to the scales of the snake, and were so numerous as to give a rough appearance to the entire body. On an average the Cirriped measured about 9 millim. in length, So far as my knowledge goes, this species has not been observed since Darwin published his description * from specimens obtained in the Indian Ocean, which were also attached to a sea-snake, and for which he was indebted to the kindness of Mr. Busk. Although I believe there can be no question as to the identity of Darwin’s D. pellucida and the specimens from the Mergui Archipelago, I may be permitted to point out such small differ- ences as I have been able to observe. The shape of the valves closely resembles Darwin’s description and figures. The basal segment of the scutum is much narrower than the occludent segment, and about half as long. The tergum (fig. 2) has the form of a battle-axe ; its handle, however, is not narrower than the occludent segment of the scuta (as Darwin says it is), but considerably thicker, or about as thick. The oecludent segment of the scutum forms with the handle of the battle-axe an angle (fig. 2, a, b,c) of more than 45°. The carina agrees perfectly with Darwin’s description, and so does the peduncle, of which Darwin says, “its narrowness and trans- parency are its only remarkable characters.” The size of the specimens from Mergui considerably exceeds the dimensions given by Darwin. In the specimens he studied the capitulum measured 0°15 of an inch in length, which is about 3°8 millim. The Mergui specimen figured (fig. 1) has a capitulum 5°3 millim. long, while another measures even 6°2 millim. On the contrary, the peduncle is only about once and a half as long as the capitulum. Most probably these differences in size, as well as those very inconsiderable ones in the valves which I have * Monograph of the Cirripedia, vol. i. p. 125, pl. ii. fig. 7. DR. P. P. GC. HOFK ON DICHELASPIS PELLUCIDA. 155 pointed out as existing between Darwin’s specimens and those from Mergui, are due to difference inage. A specimen I dissected was furnished with ovigerous lamelle. In figure 3 I have given a representation of the penis of this species. Whereas the probosciformed organ, except in certain species of Scalpellum, is very long, the present species has a very thick and short penis, its tip being pointed and somewhat hooked. Darwin does not describe the penis of this nor of any other species of the genus. DESCRIPTION OF PLATE XIII. Fig. 1. Dichelaspis pellucida, Darwin, side view: x 14 diam. 2. View of a part of the capitulum, to show A & B, the terga, C & D, the occludent segments of the scuta, and a, 0, c, the angle the occludent segment of the scutum forms with the handle of the battle-axe-shaped tergum: X30 diam. 3. Representation of the penis: x30 diam. is ed ee DO Pitigle: aie SHELLS OF MERGUI AND ITS ARCHIPELAGO. 155 pointed out as existing between Darwin’s specimens and those from Mergui, are due to difference inage. A specimen I dissected was furnished with ovigerous lamelle. In figure 3 I have given a representation of the penis of this species. Whereas the probosciformed organ, except in certain species of Scalpellum, is very long, the present species has a very thick and short penis, its tip being pointed and somewhat hooked. Darwin does not describe the penis of this nor of any other species of the genus. DESCRIPTION OF PLATE XIII. Fig. 1. Dichelaspis pellucida, Darwin, side view: x 14 diam. Fig. 2. View of a pari of the capitulum, to show A & B, the terga, C & D, the occludent segments of the scuta, and a, 0, c, the angle the oceludent segment of the scutum forms with the handle of the battle-axe-shaped tergum: X 30 diam. Fig. 3. Representation of the penis: x 30 diam. List of the Shells of Mergui and its Archipelago, collected for the Trustees of the Indian Museum, Calcutta, by Dr. John Anderson, F.R.S., Superintendent of the Museum. By Prof. Epvuarp von Martens, M.D., C.M.Z.S8.; of the University of Berlin. (Communicated by Dr. Joun Anpersoy, F.R.S., F.L.S.) [Read 17th June, 1886.] (Pirates XIV.-XVI.) IntTRoDUCTORY REMARKS. Tur following is a list of the species of Mollusca collected by Dr. John Anderson at Mergui and some of the islands of the Tenasserim coast. The species have been determined chiefly by comparison with the shells in the Zoological Museum of the Uni- versity of Berlin, and by consulting the leading illustrative works of this department of science, the figures of which are here cited, so far as they have been compared with the objects themselves, and may help to secure the determination. Concerning the land and freshwater Mollusca, I have derived very valuable information from Hanley and Theobald’s ‘Conchologia Indica,’ and from G. Nevill’s ‘Hand-list of the Mollusca of the Indian Museum,’ vols. i. (1878) and ii. (1884); also from the paper by A. Gould in LINN. JOURN.— ZOOLOGY, VOL. XXI. 14 156 PROF. E. VON MARTENS ON THE SHELLS the ‘Boston Journal of Natural History,’ vol. iv. 1844, which is the first treatise on the land-shells of that country. Besides Reeve’s ‘ Conchologia Iconica,’ several conchological publications by R. A. Philippi have been very useful to me in determining the marine shells, as this author mentions and describes various shells col- lected by his brother, Theodor Philippi, at Mergui, about the year 1846. Descriptions and figures are only given in the few cases of new or very little-known species. In several other cases some remarks are added concerning the more striking and easily observable differences of the species, chiefly if several nearly allied species are mentioned; they are not intended, however, to give a sufficient description, but only to help the memory of the conchologist in the discrimination of those species. Dr. Anderson noted on the spot the conditions under which many of the species occurred ; and his notes I have given verbatim. These are very valuable, as they afford an idea of the circumstances under which the animals live, which are of great importance owing to the influence the surroundings of a species exercise in modifying the general external appearance of the shell, a consi- sideration which is as yet not sufficiently known and appreciated in foreign shells. Many of Dr. Anderson’s statements, contained in his notes, coimcide with my own observations made during a stay of about two years in the Malayan Archipelago. Chiefly on this account, I have arranged the list into several parts, sepa- rating the land-, freshwater-, and sea-shells, and have even attempted to make a peculiar division for those which live in manegrove-swamps and at the mouths of rivers, as we there find intermingled at the same spot air- and water-breathing mollusca and species of genera which are generally admitted as marine with others of a more fluviatile character. I am well aware that this division of submarine Mollusca cannot be strictly limited either from the marine or from the fluviatile forms ; but it may, nevertheless, be useful to emphasize them in this way, as, otherwise, even the distinction between marine and fluviatile occurrence remains doubtful and arbitrary for some species. I have also tried to add, for distinction’s sake zm italies, a sketch of the geographical distribution of the single species, by naming the chief localities in which they have hitherto been found; many of these statements are taken from the collec- tions in the Berlin Museum, the rest from the more reliable conchological authors. If hitherto the “habitat” of the species OF MERGUI AND ITS ARCHIPELAGO. 157 was unknown (or at least not stated in the standard conchological works), the sign f is added. By this the reader will arrive easily at the following conclusions :— A. Terrestrial Mollusca: the greater number of the species are either confined to the Tenasserim coast or range only into the next adjacent countries, as Pegu, Arakan, or the Malayan Penin- sula. Only the small-sized Stenogyra gracilis is spread through- out continental India and the Malayan Archipelago. B, C. Fluviatile and Submarine Mollusca: most of them are wider spread, chiefly in the direction of Siam and the Malayan Archipelago, and are also found in Bengal; but only few range much further to the west. D. Marine Mollusca: a very considerable number of species range westwards to the shores of Eastern Africa, even into the Red Sea, and eastwards to the Polynesian islands, several south- wards to Natal and to the subtropical parts of Australia, and northwards to China and Southern Japan. Only one (Natica unifasciata) is stated with tolerable certainty to live also on the west coast of America; and very few (Octopus rugosus, Lima squamosa, and Pholas striata) are known also as inhabitants of the Atlantic ; among these are some which are liable to be spread by currents and drift-wood. Several Oriental species, however, are represented in the West Indies by species so nearly allied, that even the specific discrimimation remains doubtful (Littorina scabra, L. intermedia, and L. angulifera, Planaxis pyramidalis and P. sulcatus, and Asaphis deflorata). List of Shells collected at Mergui and its Archipelago. A. TERRESTRIAL MOLLUSCA. OPERCULATA. 1. CycnopHorts avRantiacus, Schumacher. (Plate XIV. figs. 1-6, and Plate XV. figs. 1-6.) A number of rather large-sized specimens of Cyclophorus have been collected, which are very near to one another, but exhibit some differences in the elevation of the spire, the width of the umbilicus, and the colours of the peristome. They form a nearly continuous chain from the flat widely-umbilicated C. pernobilis, Gould, to the more turbinated narrowly-umbilicated C. malayanus, Reeve; so much so that I dare not venture to 14* 158 PROF. E. VON MARTENS ON THE SHELLS break up this chain into several distinct species, but shall enume- rate the different forms as varieties, and quote for each the corre- sponding figures in published conchological works. The following characters are common to all these forms :— (1) A prominent, somewhat mammillate apex with moderately deep sutures and moderately vaulted, worn, reddish-brown surface of the upper whorls. (2) Faint spiral strie, sometimes almost imperceptible, and rather coarse, often wrinkle-like lines of growth on the last two whorls. (8) The periphery of the shell is slightly keeled at the beginning of the last whorl; this angularity either remains throughout to the aperture, or vanishes altogether in the larger part of the last whorl. (4) The upper surface of the last two whorls is densely marked with chestnut-brown, more or less dark, only there is a very narrow pale or whitish bandlet just above the periphery; the lower surface of the last whorl is nearly continuously dark brown near the periphery, then the brown is broken up into several narrow bandlets separated by a whitish underground, and the sides of the umbilicus are whitish, with or without brown bandlets. (5) The peristome thickened, reflected, and in most of the» specimens distinctly double; its colour varies from pure yellow to pale scarlet. The aperture is somewhat more broad than high. (a) typicus: depressus, umbilico perlato, subangulato; sub- carinatus, subtus maxima ex parte albus, peristomate intense aurantiaco. Diameter major teste 55-60, altitudo 33-86, aperture (incluso peristomate) diameter 28-31, altitudo 27-30 millim. (PI. XIV. figs. 1, 2.) Chemnitz, Conchylien- Cabinet, vol. ix. figs. 1064, 1065, copied in the new edition by Kiister and Pfeiffer, Cyclostoma, pl. 4. figs. 8,9. Type of Annularia aurantiaca, Schumacher, 1817. The figures are drawn from a specimen found on Salang Island by Capt. John Weber, and preserved in the Zoological Museum of Berlin, for comparison’s sake, as specimens of this extreme form have not been found in the localities explored by Dr. Ander- son. The locality of the original specimen, described by Chem- nitz, cannot be ascertained. Nevill, Hand-list, i. p. 266, mentions it from Moulmein and Pequ. OF MERGUI AND ITS ARCHIPELAGO. 159 (6) pernobilis : maximus, subdepressus, umbilico paulum arctiore, subangulato ; subcarinatus, peristomate rufo-aurantiaco. Diam. maj. 69, alt. 47; apert. diam. 39, alt. 35 millim. (Pl. XIV. figs. 3, 4.) Cyclostoma pernobile, Gould, Boston Journ. of Nat. Hist. 1844, iv. p- 458, pl. 24. fig. 11, copied in Pfeiffer & Kiister, Cyclost. pl. 3. fig. 15. —Cyclophorus aurantiacus, Reeve, Conch. Icon. vol. xii. pl. i. fig. 3. King Island. Gould’s specimens are from Tavoy. (4b) Paulo minor. Diam. maj. 60, alt. 40; apert. diam. 31-34, alt. 80 millim. (Pl. XIV. figs. 5, 6.) King Island. Numerous distinct dark spiral bandlets on the lower face, and even within the umbilicus, are to be seen in the figure given by Gould and in the smaller specimens from King Island; they are scarcely perceptible in the larger specimens from King Island. (ec) Nevilli: magnus, subturbinatus, umbilico arctiore, rotun- datus, periomphalio fusco-fasciolato, peristomate aurantio. Diam. maj. 55-58, alt. 37-41; apert. diam. 30-833, alt. 29-31 millim. (Pl. XV. figs. 1, 2.) Cyclostoma aurantiacum, Pfeiffer & Kiister,Cyclostoma, pl. 23. figs. 4, 5. —Cyclophorus pernobilis, Nevill, Hand-list, i. p. 266 (specimens given to the Berlin Museum); Theobald § Hanley, Conchologia Indica, pl. 1. fig. 7. Sullivan Island. Salang Island (Weber). (d) Reever: mediocris, subturbinatus, umbilico multo arctiore, infra fasciolatus, apertura subcirculari, peristomate aurantio. Diam. maj. 52, alt. 37; apert. diam. 28, alt. 27 millim. (Pl. XV. figs. 3, 4.) Cyclophorus speciosus (Philippi), Reeve, Conch. Icon. xiii. pl. i. fig. 4.— C. malayanus (Benson), Theobald & Hanley, Conch. Ind. pl. 28. fig. 4. Mergui; King Island, Sullivan Island. (dd) minor. Elphinstone Island. (e) Andersoni: minor, subturbinatus, umbilico sat arcto, sub- angulatus, apertura subcirculari, peristomate rubescente. Diam. maj. 44-48, alt. 31-86; apert. diam. 24-27, alt. 23-25 millim. (Pl. XV. figs. 5, 6.) Cyclophorus malayanus (Benson), Reeve, Conch. Icon. xiii. pl. i. fig. 2. Much like C. sublevigatus, Blanford, in the ‘ Conchologia Indica,’ pl. 37. fig. 4. Owen Island. 160 PROF. E. VON MARTENS ON THE SHELLS N.B.—Cyclophorus speciosus, Philippi, Zeitschr. f. Malacozoo- logie, 1847, p. 123 (Cyclostoma), figured by Pfeiffer & Kuster, Cyclost. pl. 25. figs. 1-3; Pfeiffer, Mon. Pneum. 1. p. 56, locality unknown, appears to be a species distinct from all these forms, and perhaps the same as that figured in the ‘ Conchologia Indica,’ pl. 33. fig. 4, under the name of awrantiacus; the figure called ©. speciosus in this last work, pl. 104. figs. 4 & 7, is again different. The true C. malayanus, Bens., from Penang Island, is, according to the figure given by F. Stoliczka in Journ. As. Soc. Bengal, vol. xli. pt. 2, pl. 10. fig. 5, remarkably more conical and elevated than any of the varieties of aurantiacus here described. 2. CycnopHorus opHts, Benson; Theob. § Hanl. Conchol. Ind. pl. 144. fig. 6. Allied to OC. aguila, Sow., but the peristome very broad. Elphinstone Island. 3. CycropHorus ExPANsus, Pfeiffer, Proc. Zool. Soe. 1851, p. 242; Mon. Pnewm.i. p. 65; Pfeiffer § Kuster, Cyclostoma, pl. 89. figs. 20, 21; Reeve, Conch. Icon. xiii. pl. v. fig. 18; Conchol. Indica, pl. 2. figs. 3, 4, (Pl. XV. figs. 7, 8.) Mergui. (Seems confined to the Tenasserim coast.) In the specimens collected by Dr. Anderson the expansion of the peristome is still broader than in the figures given by Reeve and the Conchol. Ind. 4. CYCLOPHORUS ZEBRINUS, Benson. (a) typicus: acute angulatus, peristomate albo.— Benson, Asiat. Journ. v. 1886, p. 855; Pfeiffer & Kiister, Cyclost. pl. 34, figs. 21-23 ; Mon. Pnewm. 1. p.71; Conchol. Ind. pl. 2. fig. 2; Nevill, Hand-lisé, i. p. 268. King Island. I cannot distinguish the specimens collected on that island from the normal zebrinus, which is stated to live on the Khasi hills. Khasi hills, Bhamo (Anderson). (6) aureolabris.—Nevill, Hand-list Moll. Ind. Mus. i. p. 268. Peristome intensely yellow. Mereui. Sibsagar (Peale). (c) ambiguus: minor, obtuse angulatus, costulis spiralibus obsolescentibus, fulvus, infra suturam maculis fuscis et albidis ornatus, subtus fasciolatus, umbilico sat angusto, peristo- mate albido. Diam. maj. 28, alt. 21; apert. diam. et alt. 15 millim. (Pl. XV. fig. 9.) OF MERGUI AND ITS ARCHIPELAGO. 161 Mereui, Owen and Sullivan Islands. Allied to C. Cantori, Bens., from Penang Island, in which, however, the last whorl is distinctly more inflated ‘above and below; also C. Cantori varies considerably in size at the same locality, for instance, between diam. maj. 21 and 27. 5, Lacocuitus scisstmarGo, Benson; Blanford, Ann. § Maq. Nat. Hist. (8) xiii. p. 452; Conchol. Ind. pl. 6. fig. 7. Sullivan Island. 6. LEPTOPOMA VITREUM, Chemnitz; Reeve, Conch. Icon. xiii. pl. iii. fig. 15. Uniformly white variety. Diam. 16, alt. 16, apert. 10 millim. Sullivan Island. Micobars, Salang, most islands of Maalyan Archipelago. 7. LepropoMa ASPIRANS, Benson, Conchol. Ind. pl. 6. fig. 4. Sullivan Island ; only a young specimen. Tenasserim and Pequ. 8. MrcaLtomastoma (CoProcHILUS) SECTILABRE, Gould, Bost. Journ. Nat. Hist. 1844, vol. iv. p. 459, pl. 24. fig. 10; Conchol. Ind. pl. 7. fig. 3. King Island. Penang, Perak. 9. Henicina ARAKANENSIS, Blanford, Contributions to Indian Malacology, v. 1865, p. 21; Conchol. Ind. pl. 6. fig. 9; Pfeiffer, Mon. Pneum. iv. p. 283. Sullivan Island. Arakan, Pegu, Andaman Islands. STYLOMMATOPHORA. 10. Nantna (Hemipnecta) rerrorsa, Gould, Bost. Journ. Nat. Hist. 1844, iv. p. 455, pl. 24. fig. 5; Pfeiffer, Monogr. Helv- ceorum, i. p. 77, Helix, pl. 110. figs. 4-6; Conchologia Indica, pl. 25. fig. 6. Sinistral, distinctly perforate, the keel blunt in full-grown specimens. Young specimens are comparatively higher than adult ones. Pataw, Mergui; Elphinstone, Sullivan, King, and Owen Islands. Also collected previously by Rev. Fr. Mason at Tavoy, and by Theod. Philippi at Merguz. 11. Nanya (Rorunarra) anceps, Gould, loc. cit. iv. p. 454, pl. 24. fig. 4; Pfeiffer, Mon. Hel. i. p.80, Helix, pl. 88. figs. 8-10; Stoliczka, Journ. As. Soc. Bengal, vol. xl. pt. 2, p. 231, pl. 17. figs. 1-3; Conchol. Ind. pl. 80. fig. 1. Sharply carinated, nearly imperforate. Mergui and Sullivan Island. Zuvoy, Moulmein. 162 PROF. E. VON MARTENS ON THE SHELLS 12. Naniwa (DurGELEA?) HonESTA, Gould; Pfeiffer, Mon. Hel. i. p. 57; Stoliceka, loc. cit. p. 248, pl. 17. figs. 6-14; Conchol. Ind. pl. 90. fig. 10. Sullivan Island, Owen Island. Moulmein, Arakan. 13. MacRocHLAMYS RESPLENDENS, Philippi, Zeitschr. f. Mala- kozool. 1846, p. 192; Pfeiffer, Mon. Hel. i. p. 56, Helix, pl. 110. figs. 7-9; Conchol. Ind. pl. 51. fig. 4; Godwin-Austen, Land- Moll. of India, iv. pl. 26. fig. 1. Zediwon, near Mereui, Sullivan Island, King Island. Hoge (Th. Philippi), Salang (Weber), Bhamo (Anderson). 14. MacrocHiamMys acerRRA, Benson; Pfeiffer, Mon. Hel. v. p- 100; Conchol. Ind. pl. 51. fig. 2. Meregui, King Island, Owen Island. Hitherto only known from Mereui. 15. MacrocHLamys convaLtata, Benson; Pfeiffer, Mon. Hel. iv. p. 46; Wovitat. Conchol. pl. 36. figs. 14-16; Conchol. Ind. pl. 88. figs. 2, 3. Recognizable by the very narrow whorls. Mereui, Sullivan and Owen Islands. Tenasserim and Pegu. 16. Macrocutamys PANSA, Benson; Pfeiffer, Mon. Hel. iv. p- 28; Novitat. Conch. pl. 36. figs. 11-18 ; Conchol. Ind. pl. 56. Hay, Ih Upper surface rather flat and somewhat costulated. Sullivan Island. Ava, Prome. 17. Herix (Purrmora*) GaBata, Gould, loc, cit. iv. p. 454, pl. 24. fig. 9 (1844) ; Reeve, Conch. Icon. vii. Helix, pl. 127. fig. 766; Conchol. Ind. pl. 14. fig. 4: (net good). Helix merguiensis, Philippi, Zeitschr. f. Malakozool. 1846, p. 192; Pfeiffer, Mon. Hel. i. p. 397, Helix, pl. 106. figs. 7-9; Reeve, Conch. Icon. vii. pl. 176. fig. 1205; Conchol. Ind. pl. 14. fig. 7. Mereui, King Island. TZuvoy. A very similar species lives on the northern and eastern part of the island of Celebes; it bas been identified with A. gabata by H. Adams (Proce. Zool. Soc. 1865, p. 408); but by comparing the specimens collected by Dr. Anderson with those collected by Mr. Staudinger, and named H. pilisparsa by me (Sitzungsberichte d. Gesellsch. naturf. Freunde in Berlin, 1885, p. 192), I find the following differences :-— * J. de Morgan, “Moll. terr. et fluv. de Perak,” in Bull. Soc. Zool. de France, 1885, x. p. 384, a paper with which the author became acquainted whilst this list was in the press. OF MERGUI AND ITS ARCHIPELAGO. HI. gabata. Mergui. Diam. maj. 18-202, alt. 9-10 millim. The upper whorls rising each a little above the following. Pale horn-colour, the keel some- what darker brown, also in the last whorl; no peculiar coloration of the suture. Reflected part of the peristome narrow, about 1 millim. Umbilicus with nearly perpen- dicular walls. 163 Hi. pilisparsa. Minahassa. Diam. maj. 28, alt. 10. The three upper whorls not rising one above the other. Pale greenish grey, the suture marked with a chestnut- brown band, the keel of the last whorl of the same colour as the rest of the shell. Reflected part of the peristome broad, about 2 millim. Umbilicus with more sloping walls. Helix pilisparsa is beset with short hairlets on its upper and lower face. Gould mentions no hairs in his description of H. gabata; and Anderson’s specimens have no hairs, but they are all somewhat worn, and they show some roughness, which may be due to the presence of hairs in the fresh state. Philippi describes his H. merguiensis as “ pilis sparsis brevibus obsita.” 18. Butrmus (AMPHIDROMUS) ATRICALLOSUS, Glowld, loc. cit. (1844) vol. iv. p. 457, pl. 24. fig.3; Reeve, Conch. Icon. v. Bul. pl. 31. fig. 188; v. Martens, Ostasiat. Landschnecken, p. 77. Bulimus perversus, var., Pfeiffer, Mon. Hel. iii. p. 309, Bulimus and Achatina, pl. 40. figs. 10, 11. Mergui forest and King Island. 17 dextral and 4 sinistral specimens have been collected. Tavoy, Salang (Weber), Penang. 19. Srenogyra GRacttis, Hutton, Journ. As. Soc. Bengal, i. p. 84 (Bulimus) ; Pfeiffer, Mon. Hel.ii. p.157; Reeve, Conch. Icon. v. Bulimus, pl. 69. fig. 495; ». Martens, Ostasiat. Land- schnecken, p. 375, pl. 22. fig. 18, pl. 19. fig.5; Conchol. Ind. pl. 238. fig. 4. Mergui. Widely distributed from Oisgangetic India to Amboina and Timor, probably sometimes transported by human agency with vegetables, earth, &e. 20. Crausin1a (Oosprra) Purtipprana, Pfeiffer, Zeitschr. f. 164 PROF. E. VON MARTENS ON THE SHELLS Malakazool. 1846, p. 69 ; Mon. Hel. ii. p. 423; Kiister, Monogr. of Clausilia, pl. 11. figs. 7-9; Conchol. Ind. pl. 118. fig. 10. Sullivan Island. Mergui (Th. Philippi). 20 4. Cravstt1a ANDERSoNTANA, Mollendorff, Journ. As. Soe. Beng. vol. li. pt. 2, p. 12, pl. 1. fig. 12. “Nearly related to Cl. insignis, Gould, of the same province.” Mergui (Nevill § Méllendorf’). 21. SrREPTAxis sonipuLus, Stoliezka, Journ. As. Soc. Bengal, xl. pt. 2, p.166, pl. 7. fig. 10; Pfeiffer, Mon. Hel. vii. p. 493 ; Conchol. Ind. pl. 98. fig. 7. Sullivan Island. Moul mein. 22. SUCCINEA SEMISERICA, Gould, Proc. Bost. Soc. Nat. Hist. ii. 1846, p. 100; Pfeifer, Mon. Hel. ii. p.10; Conchol. Ind. pl. 67. figs. 2, 3. Mergui. Zavoy, Moulmein, Rangoon, Arakan, Bengal. B. FRESH ATER MOLLUSCA. 23. Panupina pigona, Blanford, Proc. Zool. Soc. 1869, p. 445 ; Conchol. Ind. pl. 115. fig. 7. Perhaps only a variety of P. bengalensis, Lam. (see Nevill, Hand- list, vol. 11. p. 22), from which it is only distinguished by smaller size and by the two blunt keels continued also on the last whorl. Rangoon. Zuavoy, Moulmein, Pe gu. 24, AMPULLARIA CONICA, Gray, var. EXPANSA, Nevill, Hand-list Moll. Indian Mus. ui. p. 5. Ampullaria paludinoides (Cristofori Philippi from Mangalore), Conchol. Ind. pl. 114. fig. 5. Rangoon, with the preceding. Pegu. 25. Nerrrrna (NERIPTERON) AURICULATA, Lamarck in Eneycl. Meéthodique, Vers, pl. 455. fig. 6; Hist. Nat. Anim. s. Vert. ed. 1, vi. p. 106, ed. 2, viii. p. 572; Quoy 5 Gaimard, Voy. ‘Astro- labe,’ Atlas Zool. pl. 65. figs. 6-8; v. Martens, Neritina, p. 30, pl. 6. figs. 138-15. Sullivan Island, in fresh water. Fresh specimens marked with dark radiating bandlets. The species is widely distributed from Ceylon to the Philippines, Moluccas, and New Ireland; and lives elsewhere also in brackish water. OF MERGUI AND ITS ARCHIPELAGO. 165 26. Neritmya (CritHon) BREVisPINA, Lamarck, Hist. Nat. Anim. s. Vert. ed. 1, vol. vi. p. 185, ed. 2, vol. viii. p. 572 ; Sowerby, Thesaur. Conch. vol. ii. pl. 110. figs. 45, 51,52; Reeve, Conch. Icon. vol. ix. Weritina, pl. vi. fig. 28; v. Martens, loc. cit. p. 156, pl. 17. figs. 1-4. King Island Bay, rocks in fresh water. Widely distributed from the Nicobar Islands to New Caledonia. » Var. mutica (without spines), Sowerby, Thes. Conch. ii. pl. 110. fig. 48; v. Martens, loc. cit. figs. 2, 3. tai subgranosa, Sowerby, Conchol. Illustr. no. 41, fig. 14 ; Thesaur. Conch. ii. p. 524, pl. 110. fig. 35; Reeve, Conch. Icon. ix. Ner. pl. v. fig. 24. On rocks, freshwater, Sullivan and King Island, with the preceding. 27. Neririna (CLITHON) AVELLANA, Récluz, Revue zoologique, 1842, p. 76; Sowerby, Thesaur. Conch. ii. p. 527, pl. 109. figs. 9, 10; Reeve, Conch. Icon. ix. Ner. pl. xiv. fig. 64; v. Wartens, Monogr. Neritina, p. 174, pl. 18. figs. 5-9, & 11, 12. Sullivan Island, with WV. auriculata and N. brevispina, var. mutica. The coloration is somewhat variable, yellowish or reddish or greenish, with scattered pale spots; some specimens also with interrupted dark bands. Borneo, Philippines, Formosa. Some other species of Veritina, see below nos. 56-59. 28. Unto mararinaris, Lamarck, Hist. Nat. Anim. s. Vert. ; Reeve, Conch. Icon. xvi. Unio, fig. 297; Conchol. Ind. pl. 48, fig. 2. Rangoon. Bengal. 29. CyRENA PROXIMA, Prime, Annals of the Lyceum of Nat. Hist. of New York, vii. 1864, p. 85, with woodcut. Sullivan Island, fresh water. Salang (Weber), Siam. C. SUBMARINE MOLLUSCA. The estuaries of the rivers and the mangrove-swamps nourish a certain number of peculiar species of Mollusca, some of which are air-breathing, others truly aquatic; but all may be found at the same spot and are quasi-intermediate between the freshwater. and truly marine fauna. 166 PROF. E. VON MARTENS ON THE SHELLS a. PULMONATA. AURICULIDA. 30. Pyrura pLicata, Férussac, Prodrome Tabl. Moll. Terr. p- 101, no.2 (Scarabus); Kiister, Monogr. Auriculacea, p. 9, pl.1. figs. 3,4; Pfeiffer, Mon. Auricul. p. 76; Reeve, Conch. Icon. xii. Scarabus, fig. 23. Rangoon, Zediwon near Mergui in mangrove-swamps. Among decaying vegetation flooded at spring-tides, King Island; on trunks of mangrove-trees, King Island. Found also in Bengal, the coast of Coromandel, Rangoon, Moulmein, Pulo Penang, and Stam. 31. Pyrnia tricona, Lroschel, Archiv f. Naturgeschichte, 1838, p. 207, pl. 4. fig. 3; Reeve, Annals 5 Mag. Nat. Hist. 1st ser. vol. ix. 1842, p. 219, pl. 4. fig. 2; Kister, Auricul- pl. 1. fig. 6; Pfeiffer, Mon. Auricul. p.'75 ; A. Adams and Reeve, Voy. of the ‘Samarang, Moll. p. 56, pl. 14. fig. 12; Reeve, Conch. Icon. xu. Scarabus, fig. 22. Still more compressed and comparatively shorter than the preceding. Thapo, King Island; Sullivan Island. Ceylon, Rangoon, Bin- tang, Borneo, Luzon. 32. CASSIDULA AURIS-FELIS, Brugquiére, Pfeiffer, Mon. Auricul. p-118; Kuster, Auricul. p. 13, pl. 4. figs. 9,10, copied from Chemnitz, Conch.-Cab. ix. pl. 121. figs. 1043, 1044. Auricula fusca, Hombron et Jacquinot, Voy. au Pole Sud, Moil. pl. 9. figs. 7-0; Reeve, Conch. Icon. xx. Auricula, pl. iv. fig. 25. Mergui, on mud-flats; King Island, mangrove-swamps; Kis- seraing Island. Widely distributed in the Malayan Archipelago (Java, Moluccas, Philippines). 33. CasstpuLA Brnsont, Pfeiffer, Novitat. Conchol. i. pl. 12. figs. 17,18; Mon. Auricul. p. 111. Recognizable in fresh state by vertical rows of stout hairs. Elphinstone Bay. Port Canning, Singapore, Amboina, Luzon. 34. Auricuta Jupa, L., Pfeiffer, Monogr. Auricul. p. 180; Woodward, Man. Moll. pl. 12. fig. 85; Reeve, Conch. Icon. xx. pl. ii. fig. 16, &c.; Sowleyet, Zool. of the Voy. of Bonite, ii. p. 515, pl. 29. figs. 19, 20 (living animal). OF MERGUI AND ITS ARCHIPELAGO. 167 Very variable in form and size; largest specimen 60 millim. long. King Island and Kisseraing Island, Mergui. Port Canning, Arakan, Penang, Andamans, Singapore. Widely distributed in the Malayan Archipelago, extending to the Philippines and Northern Australia. 35. AURICULA (AURICULASTRA) sUBULA, Quoy and Gaimard, Voy. ‘Astrolabe, Moll. ii. p. 171, .pl. 18. figs. 89, 40; Adams and Reeve, Voy. ‘Samarang, Zool. pl. 14. fig. 15, copied Adams, Gen. pl. 82. fig. 1; Reeve, Conch. Icon. xx. pl. ii. fig. 12; v. Mar- tens, Moll. Mauritius, p. 207. Mergui, on mud-flats. Port Canning. Throughout the Wa- layan Archipelago to New Ireland. 36. Metameus orrmonicus, Petit, Proc. Zool. Soe. 1842, p: 202; Pfeiffer, Mon. Auricul. p. 31. King and Elphinstone Islands. Nearly one-coloured speci- mens. Ceylon, Bombay. ONCHIDIID”. 37. ONCHIDIUM VERRUCULATUM, Cuvier, Semper, Reisen im Archipel der Philippinen, vol. iti. 1877, p. 255, pl. 21. fig. 1, pl. 22. figs. 3,4; Bergh, Zool. Challenger, vol. x. p. 148, pl. 8. fig. 14. Dorsal tubercles rounded, rather large, nearly equal, some on the hinder part compound, brush-like ; eye-spots in small groups on retractile tubercles. Colour above grey or greyish brown, with few scattered black spots ; below pale, one-coloured. Owen Island, littoral. Red Sea, Nicobars, Moluccas, Timor, Australia, Japan. 38. ONCHIDIUM TIGRINUM, Stoliczka, Journ. As. Soc. Bengal, vol, xxxvill. pt. 2, 1869, p. 105, pl. 15. fig. 2. Dorsal tubercles very small and numerous, not crowded, inter- mixed with some larger ones, which are sometimes very long and soft; some with eye-spots. Colour above brown, marbled with large black spots, which are often confluent in a longitudinal direction ; below pale yellow; only the head grey or nearly black. Also in this species the dorsal eye-spots are grouped to 2-3 on large retractile tubercles, as in the preceding and the following species. Sullivan Island. Port Canning. 168 PROF. E. VON MARTENS ON THE SHELLS 39. OncHIDIUM corracEuM, Semper, loc. cit. Dorsal tubercles small, unequal; eye-spots in small groups. Colour above brown, with very large black patches, one longi- tudinal in the median line; under surface of the mantle blackish. Mantle cather rigid. | Sullivan Island, highest “level of beach.” Nicobars, Singa- pore, Siam, Philippines, Moluccas, Austraha. AMPHIBOLID &. 40. AMPULLARINA BURMANA, Nevill, Journ. As. Soc. Bengal, 1867, pl. 2. figs. 7-10. Mergui, on mud-flats. Mouth of the Irawaddi, Pegu, Bombay. 6. PECTINIBRANCHIA anv SCUTIBRANCHIA. CoLUMBELLID2. 41. CoLuMBELLA (Pustostoma) Ductostana, Sow., Heeve, Conch. Icon. xi. pl. xv. fig. 76. Mergui, mud-flats, in society with Neritina crepidularia. King and Elphinstone Islands. This is the only species of Rhachiglossate proboscidiferous Gastropods ; its dull-brown colour differs remarkably from that of other Columbelle, and agrees more with that of the inhabitants of brackish water. Malacca, Singapore. CERITHIIDA. 42, CERITHIUM PATULUM, Sow. Thes. Conch. vol. ii. p. s71, pl. 179. fig. 74; Reeve, Conch. Icon. xv. pl. v. fig. 38. Cerithium gibberosum, Dunker, Moll. d. Novara Exped. pl. 1. fig. 7. Recognizable by a strong rough varix on the back of the last whorl opposite to the aperture. Mergui, King Island Bay, littoral. Elphinstone Island Bay, on trunks of mangrove-trees; Kisseraing Island. Singapore, Celebes, Moluccas, Philippines, Carolines. 43. PoTaMIpEs (CERITHIDEA) oBrusus, Sow., Kiener, Species d. Cog., Cerithium, pl. 29. fig. 2; Hombron 5 Jacquinot, Voy. Podle Sud, Moll. pl. 23. fig. 3; Reeve, 1.c. xv. Cerithidea, pl. i. fig. 4. Mergui, King Island Bay, on mangroves. NVécobars ?, Salang, Singapore, Celebes, Caroline Islands. OF MERGUI AND ITS ARCHIPELAGO. 169 44, PotamrpEs (CERITHIDEA) QUADRATUS, Sow., Reeve, Conch. Icon. xv. Cerithidea, pl. i. fig. 5. King Island. Salang, Malacca, Singapore. 45. PoramMIpES (CERITHIDEA) FLUVIATILIS, Potiez and Mi- chaud, Galérie d. Moll. pl. 31. figs. 19, 20; Kiener, Cerithium, pl. 29. fig.3; Reeve, Conch. Icon. xv. Tympanotonos, pl. ii. fig. 9. Murex cingulatus, Gmelin, Chemnitz, Conch. Cab. vol. iv. fig. 1492, is probably the same species. Mergui, King Island Bay, littoral; Elphinstone Island, on trunks of mangrove-trees and on sand below them, immediately below high-water mark; Sullivan Island, 4 fathoms; Sullivan, high-water mark. Salang, Singapore. 46. PotamMIpEs (CERITHIDEA) ALATUS, Philippi, Abbildungen, Cerithium, pl. 1. fig. 11. Very near Cerithiwm micropterum, Kiener. Mergui, mud-flats; Kisseraing Island; Laloon Bay, Elphin- stone Island. Madras. 47. PLANAXIS PYRAMIDALIS, Gmelin, Chemnitz, Conch.-Cab. vol. iv. figs. 1170, 1171; Reeve, Conch. Icon. xx. pl.i. fig. 4; Quoy J Gaimard, Voy. ‘Astrolabe, Moll. pl. 33. figs. 25-29. Nga Islet in King Island Bay, in grass at the spring-tide level ; Owen and Sullivan Islands. Red Sea, Zanzibar, Mauritius, Seychelles, Tranquebar, Ceylon, Salang, Penang, Singapore, Celebes, Philippines, Vanikoro, New Caledonia. Very near P. sulcatus, Born, from the West Indies. LirroRInipa. 48. Lirrorina scaBra, L., Rumph. Amboinsche Rariteitkamer, p: 98, pl. 29. fig. Y (Buccinum foliorum); Philippi, Abbild., Lit. pl. 5. figs. 3-5 ; Reeve, Conch. Icon. vol. x. Littorina, pl. v. fig. 21. Mergui, King Island, mangrove-swamps; Cruro islet, between King Island and Hayes Island, on mangrove-trees flooded at spring-tides; Elphinstone Island, on stems of mangrove-trees at high-water level; Sullivan Island. Zanzibar, Mauritius, Sey- chelles, Ceylon, Salang, Singapore, Moluccas, New Guinea, Tonga. 49. Lirrorina InTeRMEDIA, Philippi, Abbildungen, Lit. pl. 5. figs. 8, 9 (not Reeve, Conch. Icon. x. pl. xvii. fig. 101). Near to the preceding ; but the last whorl quite round, without keel, and of smaller size. Mergui, mud-flats; King Island; Elphinstone Island Bay, on 170 PROF. E. VON MARTENS ON THE SHELLS ~ mangrove-trunks ; Kisseraing. Red Sea, Natal, Madagascar, Maldives, Ceylon, Nicobars, Merqui, Philippines, Samoa Islands, Tahiti. : 50. Lirrortna MELANOstoma, Gray, Philippi, Abbild., Lit. pl. 5. fig. 16; Reeve, Conch. Icon. x. pl. ix. fig. 45. Mergui, King Island Bay, in grass and on mangrove-trees at spring-tide level. Ceylon, Singapore, Borneo. 51. Lirrorina RUBROPICTA,n. sp. (PI. XVI. fig.2,af) Testa elato-conica, solida, anfractibus plano-declivihus, spiratim sul- catis, ultimo ad basin carina crassiuscula prominula cincto ; pal- lide flava, strigis sanguineis rectis vel obliquis, interdum inter- ruptis picta ; apertura parviuscula, margine columellari sat dilatato. Long. 18, diam. 11; aperture long. 92, diam. 6 millim. Number of the spiral furrows on the last whorl between the suture and the keel 7-9, on the base 10-12; keel in some speci- mens subnodulose. King Island Bay, in grass and on mangrove-trees flooded at spring-tides. DL. conica, Philippi, loc. cit. vol. iii. p. 9, pl. 6. figs. 1, 2, and Reeve, J. ¢. x. pl. vill. fig. 36, Nevill, Hand-list, ii. p. 149, found by Th. Philippi at Mergui, appears to be very near to this variety ; but is described as being a thin shell, and its colours are different. The variety of ZL. carinifera figured by Philippi, loc. eit. pl. 5. fig. 24, agrees very much with our specimens. JZ. arboricola, Reeve, /.¢. x. pl. vi. fig. 27, is quasi-intermediate between this species and L. scabra. PALUDINIDA. 52. SYENOTHYRA MONILIFERA, Benson, Annals & Mag. Nat. Hist. (2) xvii. 1856, p. 497; Conchol. Indica, pl. 87. fig. 4; Nevill, Hand-list, 1. p. 44. Mergui, on mud-flats in society with Assiminea and Ampulla- rina. Tavoy. ASSIMINEID A. 53. ASSIMINEA BREVICULA, Pfeiffer (Hydrocena), Mon. Pneum. ii. Suppl. p. 156; Nevill, Journ. As. Soc. Bengal, vol. 1. pt. 2, 1881, p- 159, pl. 7. figs. 6, 6a; Hand-list, ii. p. 67. Assiminea miniata, v. Martens, Ann. & Mag. Nat. Hist. 1866, 3rd ser. voi. xvii. p. 204. OF MERGUI AND ITS ARCHIPELAGO. — 171 Recognizable by its bright red colour and an impressed line below the suture. Mergui, on mud-flats, with the preceding. Irawady delta, Arakan, Andamans, Malacca, Singapore, Borneo, Philippines, Amoy. NERITIDZ. 54, NERITA LINEATA, Chemnitz, Reeve, Conch. Icon. vol. ix. Nerita, pl. ii. fig. 13 ; Hombron & Jacquinot, Voy. Péle Sud, Moil. pl. 17. figs. 23-25; Tenison-Woods, Proc. Linn. Soc. of N. 8. Wales, vol. v. 1880, p. 120; v. Martens, Monogr. of Nerita, p. 15, pl. 4. figs. 12-15. Mergui, mud-flats ; King Island; Elphinstone Island, on sands immediately below high-water mark, on mangrove-trees ; Crow Islet between King and Hayes Islands, high-water level ; Kis- seraing Island. Ranges from Mergui and the Nicobars to North-eastern Aus- tralia and Viti Islands. Merguz, Nicobars, Penang, Singapore, Stam, Philippines, Northern Australia, Samoa and Viti Islands. 55. Nerira PLaNnosPira, Anton, Verzeichniss der Conchylien, 1839, p. 80; Philippi, Abbildungen, Nerita, fig. 1; v. Martens, Nerita, p. 28, pl. 4. figs. 4-7. Nerita atropurpurea, Récluz, Revue Zool. 1841, p. 107; Journal de Conchyliologie, i. pl. 11. fig. 3; Reeve, 1. c. ix. pl. viii. fig. 38. Elphinstone Island Bay, on mangrove-trunks. Nicobars, Singapore, Java, Celebes, Moluccas, West Australia, Philippines, Samoa Islands, Carolines. 56. Neritina (Dostra) creprputarta, Lam. Hist. Nat. Anim. s. Vert. ed. 1, vi. p. 185, ed. 2, viii. p. 572; Sowerby, Conchol. Illustr. Neritina, fig. 25 ; Thes. Conch. ii. pl. 118. figs. 189-144; Reeve, Conch. Icon. vol. ix. Neritina, pl. viii. fig. 88; v. Martens, Monogr. Neritina, p. 37, pl. 7. figs. 1-14. Rangoon ; Mergui, mud-flats; Elphinstone Island Bay, sand- flats ; Sullivan Island, highest tide-level, and tidal stream; Kisseraing Island. The variety with blackish-coloured aperture (VV. cornu-copie, Benson, IV. melanostoma, Troschel) has been found intermingled with typical red-coloured specimens at three of these localities: Mergui, Elphinstone Island Bay, and Kisseraing Island. At LINN. JOURN.—ZOOLOGY, VOL. XXI. 15 172 PROF. E. VON MARTENS ON THE SHELLS Mergui this species lives associated with Nerita lineata and Columbella Duclosiana. Bengal, Tranquebar, Mergui, Singapore, Bangkok, Java, Borneo, Celebes, Philippines, Japan. 57. Neririna (Dostta) GueErintit, Récluz, Revue Zool. 1841, p. 814; Sowerby, Thesaur. Conch. ui. pl. 111. fig. 272. A pretty little shell, shining blackish with white spots. Mergui, mud-flats, associated with Assiminea brevicula ; King Island. Swmatra. 58. Nerirrya (Crituon) SowErsyana, fécluz, Proc. Zool. Soc. 1842, p. 174; Sowerby, Thes. Conch. u. pl. 109. figs. 5-8; Reeve, Conch. my ix. pl. xx. fig. 89, a-d; v. Martens, Monogr Neritina, p. 172, pl. 18. figs. 1-4. ; King Island, littoral; and Elphinstone Island Bay. This species was hitherto not known so far westward, its geographical distribution ranging from Southern Japan and China to the Gulf of Siam and the Philippines. At Hongkong T have found it also in sea-water, in company with Littorina. 59. Nerrriva (CuitHon) Uananensis, Lesson, Voy. de la ‘Coquille, Zool. p. 379; Reeve, l. c. ix. pl. xxxvi. fig. 168; v. Mar- tens, Monogr. Neritina, p. 193, pl. 20. figs. 1-24. Neritina Mertoniana, Récluz, Proc. Zool. Soc. 1843, p. 71; Sowerby, Thes. ii. figs. 242-246. A handsome little species, resembling somewhat WV. virginea, L., from the West Indies, but essentially distinct in the operculum ; extremely variable in colours, usually ornamented with very fine dark lines on a shining greenish ground. Elphinstone Island, immediately below high-water mark, on sand; King Island ; Sullivan Island, highest water-mark. Widely distributed, extending from Madras and Ceylon to Southern Japan, the Carolines, Viti Islands, and Northern Australia. Commonly found in brackish water. ce. BIVALVIA. OstTREID 2. 60. OsTREA cucULLATA, Born, Testacea Muse: Ces. Vindob. 1780, pl. 6. figs. 11, 12; Reeve, Conch. Icon. xvii. pl. xvi. fig. 34. Shape of the shell very variable, often wrinkled and angular ; size ordinarily rather small ; substance solid, white ; edges blackish OF MERGUI AND ITS ARCHIPELAGO. 173 blue. Fixed on shells, stones, &c.; encrusting the rocks below nigh- and low-water levels. Elphinstone Island Bay, and on sand below mangrove-trees. Widely distributed in the Indian seas. Red Sea, Mozambique, Ceylon, Siam, Sumatra, Timor, Moluccas, Philippines. 61. Ostrea mytinorEs, Lam., Rumph. Amboin. Rariteit- Kamer, pl. 46. fig. 0; Reeve, Conch. Icon. xvii. pl. i. fig. 3. Of oblong flat shape. Ordinarily fixed on wood. Elphinstone Island Bay, on stems of mangrove-trees. Ceylon, Moluccas. 62. OsTREA NIGROMARGINATA, Sowerby, Reeve, l. c. xviii. pl. 38. fig. 85. Very flat and thin, inside white in the centre, dark violet at the periphery. Elphinstone Island Bay, on the trunks of mangrove-trees. Arakan. 63. OsTREA ECHINATA, Quoy and Glaimard, Voy. ‘Astrolabe, Zool. ili. p. 155, pl. 76. figs. 13, 14. Ostrea spinosa (by mistake from the French name “ épineuse”’ in the volume cited above), Reeve, Conch. Icon. xviii. pl. xxx. fig. 79. Small, rather flat, beset with blunt blackish spines. Elphinstone Island Bay, with the preceding on mangrove- trunks. OP oO On two Species of Actiniz from the Mergui Archipelago, collected for the Trustees of the Indian Museum, Calcutta, by Dr. John Anderson, F.R.S., Superintendent of the Museum. By Professor ALFRED C. Happon, M.A., M.R.I.A. (Com- municated by Dr. Joun AnvErson, F.R.S., F.L.8.) [Read 16th June, 1887.] (Puates XIX. & XX.) Two species of Actinie from the Mergui Archipelago were sub- mitted to me by Dr. John Anderson, both of which have proved to be undescribed. The more interesting form, which is the type of a new genus, was unfortunately in such a bad state of preservation that most of the epithelial tissues had entirely disappeared. Although this specimen was partially dissected and a portion removed for microscopic examination, care was taken not to destroy its value as a Museum specimen. The other species was represented by three specimens, one LINN. JOURN.—ZOOLOGY, VOL, XXI. 21 “248 PROF. A. C. HADDON ON TWO SPECIES OF of which was devoted to the microtome, the other two are uninjured. Except where otherwise stated, the following descriptions ‘apply to the specimens as they appear after preservation in alcohol, and in a very contracted condition. In my definitions I have largely followed the method of procedure advocated by Professor R. Hertwig. Myrtacris*, n. gen. Hexactiniz [as defined by R. Hertwig] with slightly developed endodermal muscles in the upper portion of the body-wall, and strong mesenteric retractor muscles ; a large number of mode- rately long, slightly contractile, subequal, polycyclic tefitacles, the marginal row being papilliform ; numerous complete mesen- teries [“septa’’ of Hertwig]; reproductive organs present on all the mesenteries; wall, smooth below, provided with suckers above. Myrractis TuBrcona +, n. sp. (Plate XIX.) Horm. Cylindrical; base not.expanded, thrown into a number of radiating ridges, with concentric rugosities, thus giving it a reticulate appearance ; scapus thin-walled, with the mesenteries shining through in the less contracted portions, transversely wrinkled; the closeness of the folds in the most contracted portion of the body it gives a satin-like lustre; capitulum non-retractile, transversely folded, but not nearly to the same extent as the scapus, provided with numerous suckers; the latter are most developed above, and become less prominent below; at the region where the capitulum imperceptibly passes into the scapus the suckers are very irregular in size and dispo- sition, and give a perforated appearance to the body-wall. Margin of disk thrown into folds. Tentacles moderately long, conical, fairly uniform in size in eight or nine rows, over four hundred in number, not counting the marginal row. Gonidial furrows prominent. Colour. “Disk and tentacles pale green. My impression is that they were barred or spotted.” [J. A., IZS.] Uniform grey, in spirit. The green colour in the living animal is almost cer- tainly due to the presence of zooxanthelle, which occur in enor- * Muvpios innumerable, axris a ray. tT So named from its habit. AOTINIE FROM THE MERGUI ARCHIPELAGO. 249 mous numbers in the endoderm of the upper portion of the body, and but sparsely in the rest of the column. Dimensions. Contracted specimen in spirit—height 40 millim. ; diameter of column 22 millim. below, 25 millim. Oe: Length of tube (in spirit) about 260 millim. Habitat. Deeply burrowing in mud-flats, low spring-tide, French Bay, King Island, Mergui Archipelago (February 1882). The animal inhabits a thick slimy tube formed by the threads of cast-off cnide and foreign matter. I have received the following memorandum from Dr. An- derson :— “The large Actinia I found burrowing in the extensive mud- flats exposed at spring-tides in French Bay, King Island. There was a small depression in the mud around the disk and tentacles, and as they were filled with water, the tentacles were more or less expanded, of considerable size, and prominent. The disk was large, but whether it expanded much beyond the column, or at all, I cannot say. The upper stratum of mud was so soft that I sank halfway up to my knees-in it; but the burrow of the Actinia extended deep below this; and I consequently expe- rienced considerable difficulty in digging it out. When removed from its burrow, it was very flaccid, but had contracted to about 9 inches in length.” From the foregoing account we may conclude that the fully extended animal measures some 18 inches (460 millim.) in length. It is probable that when fully distended the disk extends beyond the diameter of the column, making it somewhat salver-shaped. As in Cerianthus, the tube is composed of innu- merable cnide felted together; entangled amongst these are large numbers of unexploded nematocysts and foreign bodies, such as grains of sand, spicules of sponges and alcyonaria, diatoms, and the hyphe of afungus. The possession of symbiotic alge must be very advantageous to this tubicolous actinian ; and it is not surprising that they are mainly massed in the only portion of the animal which is exposed to the light. The figures on Plate XIX. sufficiently explain themselves. It must be remembered that the greater portion of the epithelial tissues are lost by maceration. The ectoderm is entirely lost, most of the endoderm has separated from the lower portion of the body and from the mesenteries; enough, however, is present 21* 250 PROF. A. C. HADDON ON TWO SPECIES OF in patches to prove that the zooxanthelle occurred sparsely. The endoderm coating the generative region of the mesenteries (Pl. XIX. fig. 6) appears to be ofa slightly different character from that of the more distal portion; in the latter granular gland-cells are very abundant; the mesenterial filaments (craspeda), as usual, contain a large number of granular unicellular glands, but I cannot discover any nematocysts. In the capitular region of the body the endoderm is much better preserved, as will be seen from fig. 7; it is crowded with symbiotic alge. At this region of the body the muscular folds of the endoderm, which usually remain simple, are very slightly branched (Pl. XIX. fig. 7). The mesogloea or “mesoderm ”’ appears to be entirely fibrous, the wavy appearance being due to contraction (figs. 6 and 7). The mesenteries are ninety-six in number, the formula being 12+12424448; all of them are perfect, that is reach the cesophagus ; lower down the mesenteries of different orders can be recognized by their length and relative size of the longi- tudinal muscles, the latter being very well developed (Pl. XIX. fig. 5). All the mesenteries bear reproductive organs. The specimen under examination possessed only ova (fig. 6). The gonidial grooves are very well developed (Pl. XIX. fig. 4) ; above they have thick swollen margins, but lower down the latter are flattened bands. The cesophageal wall is thin, and can be divided into an upper folded portion and into a lower more diaphanous moiety. The nematocysts (figs. 8 and 9) vary in size from about ‘00225 to ‘0035 of an inch, and in breadth from about ‘00075 to ‘0013 of an inch. No barbs are to be seen on the proximal portion of the thread. There is a certain amount of external resemblance between this species and Cereus pedunculatus (Penn.) (Sagartia bellis, EH. & S.), at least in such characters as the warty capitulum, smooth scapus, numerous somewhat short tentacles in several rows, of which the outermost is papilliform ; but the latter is a typical member of the Sagartide in having acontia and in the six pairs of primary mesenteries being sterile although others reach the cesophagus. It is possible that the -_ { lower half ... 3) yA aaa re Boece et acs { upper half...) 4 35 35:75 5 eee Wiameor stalk ..2..dscsccvashesua Absent. 7 5 8 Diam. of terminal vesicle ...... Absent. 8:5 | Inconspicuous. 14 Number of immature leaves ...| 450 circa. | 450 cirea. 500 circa. 439 circa. Number of developed leaves ...! 110 circa, | 85cirea. 100 cirea. Number of small leaves at top Olerachis ..62.,ccvausescseasae eee: 35 18 26 8 Number of polypes per leaf ... 40 42 42 40-44. HMierzht of leaf 2... .cscsesc.ceeeco- 2:5 2 15 3-3°5 Greatest distance apart of leaves 35 3 a (sce AIM OMARIS ccseceecerecees acece 37X3 3X2°5 4x3 8x27 VIRGULARIA PROLIFERA, sp. nov. (Plate XXIII. figs. 16, 17.) Colony slender, rod-like, dark brown or black in colour *. Stalk short, with a very obvious terminal vesicle, often incon- spicuous from contraction, separated by a constriction from the rachis. A well-marked lateral zooid stripe at each side of lower end of rachis ; the lowermost leaves placed laterally, and forming small transverse ridges very closely packed together. Fully developed leaves in upper third of rachis alternating with one another, and slightly overlapping along dorsal surface of rachis; not more than 2 millim. apart. Polypes 22 to 80 in number; the full number present in the immature leaves. Siphonozooids in single trausverse rows at bases of leaves. Axis thick and rigid in rachis ; upper end truncated and projecting beyond soft parts, or merely covered by thin skin; lower end tapering rapidly, entering the stalk, but not reaching the vesicle; axis oval in transverse section, and with the surface corrugated. We have established this species for 15 specimens from the Mergui Archipelago. Nearly all these are perfect at their lower * Dr. Anderson informs us that this dark colour, amounting to blackness in some cases, is due entirely to the action of the spirit in which the specimens ‘were preserved. 280 PROF. MARSHALL AND MR. G. H. FOWLER ON THE ends, but all show the truncation of the upper end of the rachis that is so characteristic a feature of the genus Virgularia. The species approaches most closely to V. Lovenii, Kolliker, of which only a single fragment, from Port Jackson, Australia, has as yet been described *. In V. Lovenii the leaves are, however, much further apart (8-4 millim.) than in V. prolifera (1-2 millim.), and of smaller size; the autozooids also are less distinct from one another, and the siphono- zooids are described and figured as arranged in irregular trans- verse rows, while in V. prolifera the rows are very regular. Kolliker’s figures} of V. Lovenit are even more unlike our spe- cimens than is his description, so that we feel fairly confident that the new species will prove to be a good one. The principal measurements of four of our specimens, including the most divergent examples, are given in the following table :— SS SS ee a aa, Sra | ii a iin ian Ps habe mbar eels a b @. d Length of colony.........sseeeersseeeees 243 165 170 263 Length of stalk.....-....eeseeeereterecees 25 3l AD 43 Length of rachis .........:0s:eseseee00 218 13 125 920 Length of lateral zooid stripe of lower end of rachis .........+-----++: a7 10 15 99 Length of rachis with immature IGRI ees onepecoseoconooaseboogosHupdedode 110 63 65 116 Length of rachis with developed LOAVES. ......0ceceeececet este recsereeeeees 76 58 30 80 Length of upper end of rachis with small leaves ........-.-.seeceeeese etre 5 B 15 2 Greatest width of feather ..........-. 65 a 5 12 Diam. of rachis in middle of length. 3 2:2 25 4-5 IDrayan, OH SHAM j4c6seoseononccooncoscoodes 4:7 4 +5) 6:5 Diam. of terminal vesicle ...........- 5 9 5 17 Diam. of axis, upper end.............-. 2x18 13x11 2x17 2x17 Number of immature leaves in lower part of rachis ..........--seseessen 200 circa. | 150 circa. | 150 cirea. | 220 circa Number of developed leaves ......... 44 2 14 4D Number of small leaves at top of TYEE sco ancogeognosconepaqqe2b0005400. 098 3 3 15 3 Greatest distance apart of leaves ... 2 2 15 2 Number of polypes per leaf ..... ... 24 22 26 30 Height of largest leaf ...... ........... 2°5 3 13 4 Veutral border of largest leaf......... 2:2 3 1:2 5 * Kolliker, op. cit. p. 201, and pl. xiii. figs. 121, 122. + Kolliker, op. cit. pl. xiii. figs. 121, 122. PENNATULIDA OF THE MERGUL ARCHIPELAGO. 281 Section IV. VeRETILLER. Family i. CAVERNULARIIDE. Genus CAVERNULARIA, Valenciennes. CAVERNULARIA OBESA, Val. (Plate XXIII. fig. 18.) Of this variable species there are twelve specimens in the col- lection, all from the Andaman Islands. The majority of these agree in all respects with the descrip- tion given by Koélliker * ; two specimens, however, present special characters, and may be described as a distinct variety. Cav. OBESA, var. a. » The two specimens in question, while agreeing in all essen- tial respects with the typical form, are characterized by their very irregular shape. In one the stalk is absent, apparently cut off by the dredge. The rachis is cylindrical and of nearly uniform diameter in its lower three-fourths; the upper fourth is much narrower, and is separated by a marked constriction from the lower part, from which it projects somewhat obliquely as an irregular finger-like process. The second specimen, which is drawn the natural size in fig. 18, is complete. The stalk is very shor§; the rachis, which is rather flabby in texture, expands from below upwards, and is produced at one side into a rounded terminal knob or bud. This knob appears to be the seat of most active growth, inasmuch as on it the polypes are smaller and much closer together than in other parts. The whole of the surface of the rachis between the polypes is covered, as usual in this species, with minute siphono- zooids. This irregular mode of growth, curiously like the budding of Alcyonium, is probably to be associated with the absence, in Cavernularia obesa, of the calcareous axis usually found in Pennatulida. For the sake of comparison we give the principal measurements of some of the specimens, including those of the second example of var. a. * Kolliker, op. cit. pp. 388-843, and pl. xxii. figs. 199-201. 282 PROF. MARSHALL AND MR. G. H. FOWLER ON THE a b ¢ d ée. |Var. a Length of colony...........2....02+0 232 | 172 | 120 69 41 79 Meng thvot stale cen. scnees cesses sect 44 39 27 19 9 13 Length of rachis ..............-.0.++- 188 | 1383 93 50 32 66 Diam. of rachis, greatest............ 38 35 40 20 13. | 25 Diam. of rachis, in middle......... 32 27 30 20 13 22 Diam. at junction of rachis and Blalie ac capeneaoceinre Memrecanmectucee 27 25 27 12 10 8 Average distance apart of polypes} 15) 15] 115} 18) 16) 25 Diam. of polype-mouths............ OF) 0-5) O57 |), 0:8) See O ah en Family u. Lirvarrmp 2. Genus Litvarta, Valenciennes. LITUARIA PHALLOIDES, Pallas. (Plate XXIII. figs. 19-21.) Of this species Kolliker* notes that though it is probably widely distributed in the Indian Ocean, yet the actual number of recorded specimens is very small. Klliker’s description is drawn up from a single specimen in the Paris Museum from Sumatra, and during the voyage of the ‘Challenger’ a single example only was obtained, from Japan +. In Dr. Anderson’s collection there are eleven adult specimens, ten from the Andaman Islands, and one from the Mergui Archi- pelago, and nine young specimens from the Mergui Archipelago. The adult specimens are all much alike; the majority are truncated at the upper end of the rachis, but two others are perfect, and bear small polypes at the extreme end. The speci- mens agree closely with the description given by Kolliker, the only points of difference of any moment that we have noted being the following :— There is no line of boundary between the rachis and the stalk. The autozooids (polypes) extend lower down the rachis than the siphonozooids, but these lower ones are of very small size. There is in many specimens a very obvious plane of symmetry, the au- tozooids gradually increasing in size from the dorsal to the ventral surface. The siphonozooids do not cover the whole surface of the rachis between the autozooids, but are very distinctly arranged in rings around the latter. The cups * Kolliker, op. cit. pp. 313-816. t Zool. Chal]. Exp., Report on the Pennatulida, p. 32. PENNATULIDA OF THE MERGUI ARCHIPELAGO. 283 lodging the autozooids when retracted are black or dark brown. Finally the stalk is shorter relatively to the rachis than in Kolliker’s specimen. The single specimen from Mergui is rather paler in colour than the Andaman Islands examples, but agrees with these in other respects. The axis in Lztuaria (fig. 20) extends the whole length of the colony. In the stalk it is slender, and ends below in a flexible hocked extremity. Passing up into the rachis it gradually increases in size, being thickest at its upper end. Along the greater part of its length it is quadrilateral; wider from side to side than dorso-ventrally, and grooved longitudinally on all four faces. Its upper part presents laterally a number of cup-like depressions, lodging the deeper parts of the polype-cavities. These depressions, which increase in size and depth towards the top of the axis, are separated from one another by thin sharp- edged partitions, produced at places into prominent teeth (fig. 20), which during life come very close to the surface of the rachis. In the young specimens (fig. 21), which vary in length from 13 to 19 millim., the fleshy coenenchym of the rachis is very scanty, and the polypes few in number. The axis is very well developed, and its surface is deeply excavated to form cups for the lodgment of the polypes, the partitions between the cups coming quite to the surface, and forming a conspicuous mosaic pattern. The top of the rachis and axis is pointed, and the polypes are largest some little distance below it. In the smallest specimen there are 10 well-developed polypes, but no siphonozooids; in the largest of the nine there are about 20 polypes and a few siphonozooids in addition. The principal dimensions of one of the adult specimens are as follows :— Thenpthyotcolomye ox. cs. ses neccecs sees 145 mm. hen gbliom Shallletgesces seer vt salsh.ce een) GZ Whenpthvottacitneyedtsrts.c. fee. seveeecee tye 83 Dian: of bopyOl LACHISy g.2.6-)c-2t2-2s8es Diam. at junction of stalk and ane) Jepe WDictma./om shallciee sepeee cia. eat esos ee Saas. 3°5 Diam. of terminal vesicle ....:.............. 5 LINN. JOURN.—ZOOLOGY, VOL. XXI. 24 284 PROF. MARSHALL AND MR. G. H. FOWLER ON THE Genus Poricenta, Gray. POLICELLA MANILLENSIS, KOlliker. Of this species there are two specimens ; one from the Andaman Islands, the other from the Mergui Archipelago. The two differ a good deal in comparative firmness or flaccidity, in the varying degree of protrusion of the polypes, in colour, and in other secondary points. The figure given by Kolliker * is, in many respects, intermediate between the two. In the Andaman Islands specimen the whole coenenchym is compact and firm; the axis is about three fourths the length of the colony ; the autozooids are mostly in a state of complete retraction, and when expanded are smaller than in the other specimen. Along the lower 20 millim. of the rachis the auto- zooids are smaller, almost colourless, and arranged in longitudinal rows, separated by longitudinal folds of the cutis. The siphono- zooids are exceedingly numerous, occupying the whole of the surface of the rachis between the autozooids, except in the lowest 20 millim., where they are absent. There are no calcareous spicules in the rachis, but small otolith-like bodies, 0-008 x 0:004 millim., occur in considerable numbers in the deeper layers of the stalk. The general colour of the rachis and stalk is yellow-ochre; the bodies of the autozooids are dark brown, paler at the base, and with yellowish-white tentacles. In the specimen from the Mergui Archipelago the coonenchym is much less firm, the rachis being soft and fleshy, and the stalk only slightly denser. The axis is shorter, hardly more than half the length of the colony, and more slender. The autozooids are larger, and are in a great many cases fully expanded; the tran- sition from the fully-formed ones of the upper half of the rachis to the immature ones at its lower end is much more gradual than in the Andaman Islands specimen. ‘The siphonozooids are smaller and less numerous, and are arranged in longi- tudinal rows between the autozooids. There are a few calcareous spicules in the cutis of the rachis, and numerous otolith-like bodies in the stalk. The rachis and stalk are almost colourless; the autozooids are a dark purplish brown in their distal third, transparent at their bases, and have white tentacles. * Kolliker, op. cit. pl. xxii. fig. 189. PENNATULIDA OF THE MERGUI ARCHIPELAGO. 285 The principal dimensions of the two specimens are as follows :— Andaman Islands . . specimen. Mergui specimen. ength) Of ColOmyierss dase. asciacuee ene 168 175 Hien ethos Stalllkeweneeesereeeme acer acer: 48 37 Wena thvok rachisieemestssesesceere sc 120 138 Mengsthi ot axis’ seas eeerasecsneree sare: 120 92 Mirae. of shally. sevcnutetieestec asec ses: 17 us IDENT OUETPYESVE): “cconccaosadcocdeaonaasee 19 11 Diam. Of axis’ s-teeisecsssuseses sents 3°09 X2°5 2x18 Length of largest autozooid ......... 8-10 11 Diam. of largest autozooid ............ 11 14 Tentacles of largest autozooid ...... 26 4 Diam. of immature autozooid ...... 0°64-0°5 0:54-0-4 Diam. of siphonozooids ............... 0-4 0:16 POLICELLA TENUIS, sp. nov. (Plate XXIII. figs. 22, 23.) Colony slender and of somewhat flabby consistency ; nearly uniform in width along its whole length, tapering slightly at both ends. Stalk slhghtly firmer than rachis, but not separated from it by a sharp line of demarcation. Axis rigid, less than half the length of the colony, quadrangular with rounded angles and slightly grooved sides. Polypes very long and slender, completely retractile, largest about the middle of the rachis, rudimentary at lower end of rachis. Siphonozooids covering whole surface of rachis between the polypes. A few small calcareous bodies in the rachis, and small otolith-like bodies in the stalk. Of this form a single specimen was obtained from the Mergui Archipelago. The whole colony, including the polypes, is of an ashen-grey colour; the rachis is soft, wrinkled, and its surface markedly slimy. The axis extends about halfway down the stalk, and not quite halfway along the rachis. The great length and slenderness of the polypes, the absence ot any line of demarcation between rachis and stalk, the shortness of the axis, and the general flabby condition of the whole colony serve to distinguish the species at once from P. manillense. The principal measurements of the specimen are as follows :— dhenpth Ob colony 328 e oe. ace seen ce yenencs 252 mm, Nene the ote siablea remiss 3. 5.5 .5525) csenes 68 hens thy ot rachis). 2.Ap-.. .5.-.08sc002 184. enebhy of amivan sense ss 02 0...000susen ns 110 ‘286 PENNATULIDA OF THE MERGUI ARCHIPELAGO. Dram: Or stale Wee se cere eee earn 12 mm. Diana. Obtachis Aen. seen eee eee nana 13 Tat. \OL aS es eee ee ee eee eee 45 x 4: Length of largest autozooid ............ 12-14 Diam. of largest autozooid ............... 08 Tentacles of largest autozooid............ 3°5 Diam. of immature autozooid ............ 0:48 Diamjoh siphenozoolds:ssenee esse. ees ~ 0°16-0°24 Length of calcareous bodies of nace. 06 Diam. of otolith-like bodies of stalk ... 0:006 DESCRIPTION OF THE PLATES. In Figs. 5, 16, 20, and 22 the lower ends of the specimens have been drawn by the lithographer as bent up in an unnatural manner, in order to accom- modate the figures to the size of the Plate. The specimens are naturally straight. Fig. Fig. PiatTe XXII. 1. Pteroeides elegans, latero-dorsal view, x 1. 2. P. elegans, leaf, under surface, <3. 3. P. Lacazii, var. a, leaf, under surface, <1. 4. P. Lacazti, var. 8, dorsal surface, <1. 5. P. Lacazii, var. 8 with supernumerary leaves, ventral surface, x1. 6. P. Lacaztt, var. B, leaf, under surface, x1. 7. P. chinense, var. a, dorsal surface, x 1. 8. P. chinense, var. a, ventral surface, x1. 9. P. chinense, vay. a, leaf, under surface, x 1. Prats XXIII. 10. P. chinense, var. 8, dorsal surface, x 4. 11. P. chinense, var. B, leaf, under surface, x 4. 12. P. Hsperi, var. a, dorsal surface, x 4. 13. P. Hsperi, var. a, leaf, under surface, x #. 14. P. Espert, var. B, dorsal surface, x 4. 15. P. Esperi, var. B, leaf, under surface, x4. 16. Virgularia prolifera, sp. nov., dorsal surface, x 1. 7. V. prolifera, sp. nov., leaf, X3. 18. Cavernularia obesa, var. a, X #. 19. Lituaria phalloides, x1. 20. L. phalloides, axis, <1. 21. L. phalloides, young specimen, x4. 22. Policella tenuis, sp. nov., X1. 23. P. tenuis, sp. nov. -@ Caleareous bodies from rachis, x 210; (0) Otolith-like Dodie from stalk, x 210. ——_ MYRIOPODA OF THE MERGUI ARCHIPELAGO. 287 Report on the Myriopoda of the Mergui Archipelago, collected for the Trustees of the Indian Museum, Calcutta, by Dr. John Anderson, F.R.S., Superintendent of the Museum. By R. I. Pococr, Assistant in the Zoological Department, British Museum. (Communicated by Dr. Jonn ANDERSON, E.B.S., F.L.S8.) [Read 1st December, 1887. ] (Puates XXIV. & XXV.) No species of Myriopoda have hitherto, so far as I am aware, been recorded from the Mergui Archipelago, but considering the proximity of this group of islands to the mainland of the Malay Peninsula, it is not surprising that most of the large and con- spicuous forms obtained are referable to species which have been from time to time described from various parts of the Oriental Region. Those that are new are, with one exception, small and incon- spicuous individuals, which would in all probability have been overlooked or ignored by any but a scientific collector. Very little need here be said about the Chilopoda. One specimen only, a species of Himantarium,is new. ‘The rest are well known Oriental forms. With regard to these I have deemed it sufficient to give references to the excellent descriptive papers of Dr. Meinert and Dr. Haase. The Diplopoda are in some respects of greater interest, and have been treated in consequence at greater length. Knowing from experience the immense difficulties to be encountered in the endeavour to identify merely from descriptions species of this group, I have thought it advisable to describe and figure, whether old or new, every specimen occurring 1 the collection. Fortunately, in most cases, individuals of each sex were taken; it has been possible, therefore, to examine the male copulatory apparatus, and to point out the specific distinctions presented by this organ. I have described as new one species of Glomeris, two of Paradesmus, two of Spirostreptus, and one of Spirobolus. It is with great pleasure that I take this opportunity of ex- pressing my obligations to Dr. Meinert and to Dr. Karsch for kindly comparing most of the specimens here enumerated with the types of species preserved in the Museums at Copenhagen and at Berlin, to which I had no access. With the object of assisting fellow-workers, by affording them some means of ascertaining what has already been done with regard to this group of animals in the Hast, I have added at the 288 MR. BR. I. POCOCK ON THE end of my paper a list of the principal publications which treat in any way of the Myriopoda of the Oriental Region. Of these special mention may be made of the excellent monograph of the Chilopoda published by Dr. Erich Haase (“ Die Indisch-Austra- lischen Chilopoden,” Abh. Ber. zool. Mus. Dresden, 1887). I. CHILOPODA. Family ScoLOPENDRIDS. Genus Scotoprenpra, Linn. Syst. Nat. p. 1062, ex parte ; Newport, Trans. Linn. Soc. xix. p. 377. ScOLOPENDRA sSUBSPINIPES, Leach, Trans. Linn. Soc. xi. p. 383. Var. DE Haantr, Brandt, Recueil ete. p. 59. This variety, characterized by the absence of spines from the under surface of the anal femora, is very commonly met with in the Oriental Region. Specimens were taken in Sullivan Island, King Island, and Kisseraing. Genus Orostiema, Porath, Bih. Sv. Vet.-Akad. Handi. B. iv. p. 18. Syn. Branchiotrema, Kohlrausch, Arch. f. Naturgq. Jahrg. 47, p. 70. OTOSTIGMA CARINATUM, Porath, op. cit. p. 20. Var. INSULARE, Haase, op. cit. p. 69. Four specimens, one from Sullivan Island and three from King Island. This southern variety of the Chinese species has been recorded from Java and Ceylon. Family GEOPHILID#. Genus Mzcistoceruatus, Newp. Proc. Zool. Soc. x. p.178. MECISTOCEPHALUS PUNCTIFRONS, Wewp. t. c. p. 179, 1842. Syn. M. heros, Meinert, Proc. Amer. Phil. Soc. xxiii. p. 214, 1886. One adult specimen from Mergui, one adult and one young from Sullivan Island, and one young from King Island. A widely distributed Oriental species. Dr. Meinert, by whom these specimens were examined, identified them with his Mecistocephalus heros, a species recorded from the Island of Mauritius. After carefully comparing them with the type specimen of Mecistocephalus punctifrons (Newport), and finding that they differ from it in no constant character, I have MYRIOPODA OF THE MERGUI ARCHIPELAGO. 289 been obliged to add heros to the list of synonyms appertaining to M. punctifrons. For these synonyms, see Haase, op. cit. p. 104. Genus Onpunaus, Meinert, Nat. Tidsskr. 8. vii. p. 17. ORPHNHZUS BREVILABIATUS, Newport, sp. (Plate XXIV. figs. 2, 2 a.) Syn. Geophilus brevilabiatus, Mewport, Trans. Linn. Soc. xix. p. 436. Geophilus bilineatus, Peters, Reise Mossam., Ins. p. 581, pl. xxiii. fig. 4. Orphneus lividus, Weinert, Nat. Tidsskr. 3. vii. Deploe One female specimen from Sullivan Island. This specimen was kindly identified by Dr. Meinert with his species Orphneus lividus, but since it agrees in all respects with the type specimen of Geophilus brevilabiatus (Newport), which is preserved in the British Museum, there is no doubt that Dr. Haase (op. cit. p. 111) is perfectly correct in his supposition that Dr. Meinert redeseribed Geophilus brevilabiatus (Newport) as Orphneus lividus. To the list of synonyms made out by Dr. Haase for this species may be added G. bilineatus (Peters). This species is very abundant in the Oriental Region. Genus Himantarium, C. Koch, Syst. Myr. p. 82; Meinert, Nat. Tidsskr. 3. vii. p. 21. HimMantTartum mnpicum, Meinert, Proc. Amer. Phil. Soc. xxiii. p-. 228. (Plate XXIV. figs. 3-3 6.) One male specimen from King Island, named by Dr. Meinert. The type of this species was taken at Kulu. Hrmanrarium MEINeRtr, sp.nov. (Plate XXIV. figs. 1-14.) Length 85 mm. Body narrowed anteriorly and posteriorly. Maxillary feet almost reaching the frontal margin; smooth; sternum twice as wide as long; with anterior margin slightly sinuate and unarmed; basal segment unarmed; claw strongly curved and unarmed. Cephalic plate smooth, slightly wider than long; posterior margin almost straight; not covering maxillary feet posteriorly. Basal plate a little narrower than the cephalic plate, four times as wide as it is long. Pre-basal plate visible. Antenne long, at the base in contact, tapering towards the apex ; hairy; segments longer than wide; ultimate segment slightly longer than the penultimate. 290 MR. RB. I. POCOCK ON THE Dorsal plates smooth, strongly bisulcate; area between the sulci irregularly striated longitudinally. Ventral plates with shallow median depression; porous area occupying the posterior portion of the plate. Anterior pair of feet a little shorter and a little more slender than the succeeding pairs. Posterior pleure not coxiform, clothed with short hairs ; porous: last ventral plate with lateral margins slightly converging posteriorly ; with rounded angles and straight hinder margin. Anal feet (in the female) much longer than the preceding pair ; slender ; ultimate segment equal in length to the penultimate and unarmed. 115 pairs of legs. A single female specimen from Sullivan Island. I have named this species after Dr. Meinert, to whom so much of our knowledge of the Chilopoda is due. IT. DIPLOPODA. | Family GLOMERID2. Genus Giomertis, Latr. Hist. Nat. d. Crust. iti. p. 44; Leach, Zool. Mise. iu. p. 32, 1817. [GLOMERIS CARNIFEX, sp.n. Segments shining, black above, with testaceous posterior margins; lateral portion of second segment pink or pale brick-red ; lateral margins of the remaining segments either reddish or testaceous ; posterior half of posterior somite pale pink or brick-red.—Tenasserim. Collected by Mr. E. W. Oates; see Note, p. 301.] GLOMERIS CARNIFEX, var. PALLIDA, var. n. (Plate XXIV. figs. 7, 7a.) Colour of under surface of head and of somites testaceous ; upper surface of somites black, with testaceous posterior and lateral margins; a central longitudinal testaceous line, and a large lateral testaceous spot, which in the anterior somites unites with the marginal lateral testaceous patch. Segments shining; thickly and finely punctured.. First dorsal plate with two transverse striz; second with from seven to ten lateral strie ; remaining dorsal plates with from three to five strie. Eye on each side consisting of from six to eight ocelli arranged in a linear series and of a single ocellus situated on the outside MYRIOPODA OF THE MERGUI ARCHIPELAGO. 291 of the upper extremity of this series. In one female specimen the left eye consists of sixteen ocelli, nine being arranged in a linear series, with three on the inside and four on the outside: of the series. This abnormal arrangement calls to mind the aggre- gate eye of the Spherotheria. Posterior dorsal plate of different individuals exhibiting dif- ferent degrees of emargination. In the male the coxe of the eighteenth pair of feet are not coalesced, and these limbs are relatively larger when compared with the copulatory feet and with the preceding pairs, than they are in, e. g., G. connexa. Copulatory feet very stout, race of five segments ; inter- coxal lamina pyriform, with short and slender lateral processes ; second segment towards its distal end giving off inwardly a seti- ferous process ; third segment bearing two processes, an anterior and a posterior—the former short, conical, setiferous, the latter broad and somewhat quadrate; fourth segment bearing an upturned tooth; fifth segment curved. Nine specimens, five males and four females, preserved in spirit of wine. From Elphinstone Island. This variety differs from the typical form in the absence of the red colouring-matter on the segments. The occurrence of this genus in the Oriental Region is of peculiar interest, since its headquarters appear to be the Medi- terranean district of the Palearctic Region. In the Ethiopian, Oriental, and Australian Regions its place is taken by the allied genera Spherotherium and Zephronia. In 1865, however, Dr. Wood (Proc. Acad. Nat. Sci. Philad. p. 172) described a species of Glomeris from Hong Kong. To this he gave the name bicolor; but his description of it is so inadequate, that I am unable to say whether or not it is identical with this species from Tenasserim and Mergui. So far as may be judged by the description, it appears to apply to a different form. Family PoLYDESMID4. Genus Srenonta, Gray, Todd's Cyclop. Anat. Phys. ii. p. 546. Subgen. AcantHopusmus, Peters, Monatsber. K. Preuss. Akad. Wiss. Berlin, 1864, p. 546. ACANTHODESMUS PILIPES, Pefers, t. c. p. 544. (Plate XXIV. figs. 44: ¢. ) g and 2. Length about 74 mm., width 13 mm. 292 MR. R. I. POCOCK ON THE Colour for the most part dark reddish brown above, paler beneath; keels, antenne, and legs testaceous. In young specimens the prevailing colour is a light reddish brown, the central portion - of each dorsal plate being scarcely darker than the keels and legs. One adult female also presents this peculiarity of coloration. Keels and keel-bearing portion of each dorsal plate densely and finely granular, with a row of larger granules at the posterior margin. Posterior dorsal plates marked indistinctly with three transverse rows of tubercles. Anterior dorsal plates more coarsely granular than the posterior. External margin of each keel very obscurely denticulated, and, at the hinder end of the body, produced posteriorly into a short sharp process. In the young specimens, 7. e. those possessing but 19 somites and of which the males are without copulatory feet, the granules are relatively coarser and the lateral denticles of the keels much more strongly marked than in the adults. In the largest individual of the series of adults, which is unfortu- nately a female, the lateral margins of the keels are smooth. Hach somite provided with three tubercles on the outside and two on the inside of the point of articulation of the legs. Legs and antenne thickly clothed with short hairs. First dorsal plate nearly double as wide as itis long; anterior and posterior margin bearing a single row of tubercles. Hach anal valve with a single tubercle ; subanal plate with a tubercle on each side of the middle line. In the male the copulatory foot is composed of two subequal segments ; in the proximal segment the proximal half ig slender and simple, the distal half stout; in the distal segment the proximal half is stout, the distal half slender and terminating in two long, approximately equal, hook- like processes. This species is allied to Stenonia margaritifera (Gervais, Ins. Apt. iv. p. 102), and to Stenonia Schetelyi (Karsch, Archiv. Naturg. 1881, p. 87), but differs from both in the shape of the copulatory foot. This organ is in St. Schetelyi terminated by a single long curved process; in St. margaritifera by two curved processes, one long and one short; and in Sé. pilipes by two long curved processes. Eleven adult specimens (three males and eight females) and four young specimens (two males and two females) were brought from Sullivan Island, King Island, and Owen Island. My thanks are due to Dr. Karsch for the name of this species. It is perhaps worth while to point out in connection with this MYRIOPODA OF THE MERGUI ARCHIPELAGO. 293 species that the long series of forms from which the above de- scription has been taken shows well to what an extent characters which have been regarded as valuable for the separation of Species may vary with age in individuals which are without doubt specifically identical. Genus Parapresmus, Sauss. Linn. Hntom. xii. p. 325. PaRaDESMUS KarscHt, sp. nov. (Plate XXIV. figs. 5-5 6.) Length about 43 mm., width about 5 mm. Colour: the anterior cylindrical portion of each somite very dark chocolate-brown above and at the sides ; testaceous beneath. Upper surface of keel-bearing portion yellow with brown anterior margin; lateral portions brown; sternal portion testaceous. Upper and under sides of keels testaceous. First dorsal plate testaceous, with patch of brown colour towards the anterior margin. Legs pale brown ; head and antenne black. Body smooth and shining. Keels horizontal, with very thick lateral margin, upon which is situated the foramen repugnatorium. Keels of the first segment well developed and not projecting below those of the second. First dorsal plate more than double as wide as it is long; very nearly as wide as the second, and double as long as the keel- bearing portion of the second. Head with a median longitudinal sulcus. Kach dorsal plate bearing a transverse sulcus, running from the base of one keel to the base of the other. Posterior somite triangular, truncate, with an anterior larger and a posterior smaller tubercle on each side; subanal plate bituberculate. Copulatory foot of the male slender and curved, terminating with two hooked dissimilar processes: the posterior of these two processes is wider and at the apex tridentate; the anterior, slender and pointed, is closely adherent to the posterior. Five male and five female adult specimens, preserved in spirit of wine, from King Island and Sullivan Island. The form of the copulatory foot shows that this species, which I have named after Dr. Karsch, is closely allied to Paradesmus vicarius (Karsch, Archiv f. Naturg. 1881, p. 38). PARADESMUS CRUCIFER, sp. nov. (Plate XXIV. figs. 6-60.) Length about 60 mm., width about 5 mm. Colour: upper surface of each somite pale reddish brown, with 294: MR. BR. I. POCOCK ON THE a median longitudinal darker band running from the anterior to the posterior border. Basal portion of upper surface of keels dark brown, passing into yellow towards the apex; raised margin of keels clear yellow; a dark-coloured band passing from the base of one keel to that of the other, and cutting the longitudinal band at right angles, forms with it a cross-shaped mark. Upper portion of the sides of each somite dark chocolate-brown, passing below and on the underside into light brown; under surface of keels pale yellow. Head almost black. Posterior portion and keels of first dorsal plate yellow ; anterior portion black. Legs clear yellow; antenne yellow, with apical segment and distal end of penultinate segment brown. Body smooth and shining. Keels almost horizontal, slightly raised, situated at the summit of the sides of the segments. Antero-external border very convex and bearing in a depression the foramen repugnatorium. Keels of first segment well developed and slightly depressed. First dorsal plate more than double as wide as it is long; very nearly as wide as the second and double as long as the keel- bearing portion of the second. ; Keels of posterior segments strongly projecting backwards. Head with a median longitudinal sulcus. Hach dorsal plate bearing a transverse sulcus running from the base of one keel to that of the other. Posterior portion of each dorsal plate obscurely striated longitudinally. Posterior somite triangular, truncate, bifid, bearing three tubercles on each side. Subanal plate rounded, with a tubercle on each side of the middle line. A single female specimen from King Island. The right antenna is abnormally developed, having one segment fewer than the left. This species may at once be distinguished from the preceding by the difference of colour, by the slightly raised keels, and by the convexity of the antero-lateral margins of the keels. Family Iunipa. Genus Sprrostreptus, Brandt, Bull. Mose. 1833, p. 203. Subgen. Nopoprex, Brande, SPIROSTREPTUS(NopopyGe) oprnatus, Karsch, Zeits. Naturwiss. liv. p. 23. (Plate XXV. figs. 2-2 c.) Length 153 mm. Number of somites 62 to 66. MYRIOPODA OF THE MERGUI ARCHIPELAGO. 295 Hind half of each somite brown with reddish posterior margin ; head, antenne, and first dorsal plate light brown; legs clear yellow. Somites smooth and shining. Lower lateral portions of the hinder half of each somite longi- tudinally striated ; fore part of each somite concentrically striated. Belly-grooves oblique ; those on the central somites as long as the two basal segments of the legs. First dorsal plate not extending laterally below the succeeding ones; antero-inferior border rounded, with margin elevated and thickened. The groove that marks this thickening extending up to and beyond the outer margin of the ocular area; postero- lateral portions striated. Forehead with median sulcus. Posterior somite produced into a short, slightly upturned spine, projecting slightly beyond the anal valves. Anal valves with margins thickened and slightly compressed ; sub-anal plate triangular, marked off from the posterior segment by a groove. In the male the antenne are relatively longer and the margin of the anal valves more convex than in the female. The anterior lamina of the copulatory organ produced below into two processes, the inner of which is slender and styliform. The upper slender portion of the anterior lamina is attached to a small triangular plate, by which it is connected with the corre- sponding portion of the opposite side. The posterior lamina, viewed from the front, is seen to be dilated below, rod-like above; the inferior border of the lower dilated portion giving off two processes, an external and an internal; the external process projecting downwards and outwards. ‘To the rod-like upper portion is attached the central portion of the copulatory organ. This consists of a slightly curved, elongate piece, which below is produced into an upcurled membranous expansion. At the proximal end of this is a simple styliform process, the upper margin of which is slightly serrated. This distal end of the membranous portion is bifid and setiferous. From the outer side towards the distal end springs a long curved spur. Four specimens, three females and one male, from Sullivan Island. The species was described by Dr. Karsch from Tenasserim. SPIROSTREPTUS (NODOPYGE) ATERRIMUS, sp. Lov. (Plate XX V. figs. 1-1 d.) Length 217 mm. Number of somites 66-67. 296 MR. R. I. POCOCK ON THE Hind half of each somite shining black, with reddish tinge at its posterior margin ; anterior portion black but less shining. Head dark brown, shining. Legs and antenne shining dark brown, with distal margin of each segment yellow. Each somite divided by a sulcus, which is deeper at the sides than above, into an anterior and posterior portion: posterior portion smooth above, striated at the sides and below; anterior portion marked towards its free margin by fine concentric strie. Belly-grooves oblique; those of the posterior somites shorter than those of the central and anterior somites. First dorsal plate not extending laterally below those that succeed it; antero-inferior border rounded, with raised and thickened margins; the groove that marks this thickened margin reaching up to the ocular area; postero-lateral portions very faintly striated. Forehead with median sulcus. Posterior segment produced into a short upturned spine, projecting slightly beyond the margin of the anal valves. Anal valves with margins thickened and strongly compressed ; sub-anal plate triangular, not separated by a groove from the posterior segment. In the male the antenne are relatively longer than they are in the female ; the head is shorter; the raised margin of the first dorsal plate thicker, and the free border of the anal valves more convex. Anterior lamina of copulatory organ simple and spatulate, dilated below, slender above; the apex of the upper slender portion attached to a small triangular plate, by which it is con- nected with the corresponding piece of the opposite side. The posterior lamina, viewed from the front, dilated below, rod-like above; the inferior border of the lower dilated portion giving off two precesses, an external and an internal; the external process projecting downwards and inwards. The anterior and posterior lamine of the copulatory organ are continuous behind, and they together form a sheath for the central lamina, which is above attached to the superior rod-like portion of the posterior lamina. Each central lamina consists of a slightly curved, elongate, more or less cylindrical piece, which below is produced into an up- curled membranous expansion. At the proximal end of this there is an elongate slender piece, terminated by a small sharp hook. From the inner margin near its proximal extremity this membranous portion gives off a sharp, slightly curved spur; its MYRIOPODA OF THE MERGUI ARCHIPELAGO. 297 distal extremity, which is very much curled, terminates in three irregular processes, the central of which bears a series of fine bristles. Two specimens, one male and one female, from Mergui. This species was identified by Dr. Karsch as a variety of Sp. opinatus, but the form of the copulatory foot, an organ which that naturalist had no opportunity of examining, serves at once to distinguish it. From the form of this organ it appears to be allied to S. lankaensis (Humbert), but in other particulars it is undoubtedly different. SPIROSTREPTUS REGIS, sp. nov. (Plate XXV. figs. 3, 3 a.) Length 55mm. Number of somites 61. Hind half of each somite deep brown, with paler margin ; front half testaceous ; anal somite testaceous; margins of valves aud apex of spine brown; first dorsal plate testaceous in the centre, brown in front and behind, with anterior and posterior margins pale yellow. Antenne, legs, and front of head testa- ceous. Body smooth and shining. Each somite divided by a sulcus into an anterior and posterior portion. Posterior portion below marked with the usual longi- tudinal striz ; above very faintly grooved in the same direction. Grooves less strongly marked in the anterior than in the posterior somites. First dorsal plate not extending laterally below the succeeding one; lateral portion striated and much attenuated; antero- inferior margin very round and marked off by a groove. Forehead with median sulcus. Posterior somite produced into a very short, very slightly upcurled spine, which projects slightly beyond the margins of the anal valves. . Anal valves with margins thickened and slightly compressed ; posterior border very convex; sub-anal plate triangular, marked off from posterior somite by a sulcus. A single female specimen from King Island. Genus Spirozotus, Brandt, Bull. Mosc. 1838, p. 202. SPIROBOLUS CauDuLANUS, Karsch, Zeits. Naturwiss. liv. p. 60. (Plate XXV. figs. 4-4 6.) Length 75 mm. Number of:somites 52. Each somite pale olive-green, with darker posterior portions ; centre of the dorsal portion blood-red; posterior somite and 298 MR. B. I. POCOCK ON THE anal valves very pale olive-green; antennz, legs, and region of labrum ferruginous. Each somite marked below by a sulcus, which becomes fainter and finally disappears towards the dorsum. Foramen repugna- torium situated immediately behind this sulcus, above the middle of the somite; a small area surrounding the foramen black and smooth. Hach somite thickly and finely punctured ; lateral inferior portion as high as the foramen, striated. Posterior portion of each somite more strongly striated, less strongly punctured. First dorsal plate laterally scarcely overlapping and not ex- tending lower than the second; anterior border nearly straight, forming with the posterior border a blunt rounded angle; antero- inferior margin with a strongly marked groove. Lower portion of clypeus with strongly marked central sulcus ; upper portion of sulcus very faintly indicated. Labral region marked with two impressions on each side of the middle line. Posterior somite produced into a stout, blunt process, which projects slightly beyond the margins of the anal valves. Margins of anal valves strongly thickened and compressed. Sub-anal plate posteriorly angulate. A single female specimen from King Island. The specimen described by Dr. Karsch, which is also a female, was from Siam. The male appears to be unknown. SPIROBOLUS PHRANUS, Karsch, t. c. p. 65. (Plate XXYV. figs. 6-6 e.) Length 52mm. Number of somites 55. Posterior portion of each somite testaceous, anterior portion brownish grey. Legs, antenue, and lower portion of clypeus testaceous. Each somite marked with circular sulcus into an anterior and a posterior portion; very finely punctured ; laterally and infe- riorly longitudinally striated. Dorsally the central portion is furnished with numerous linear elevations, which, running parallel to the margins of the somite, and anastomosing in every direction, give rise to a reticulated pattern ; the interstices formed by the intersection of these elevations posteriorly break up into more or lese elliptical areas, and disappear on the hinder portion of the somite. Foramen repugnatorium inconspicuous, situated upon the middle portion of the somite. Somites not provided with scobina. MYRIOPODA OF THE MERGUI ARCHIPELAGO. 299 First dorsal plate laterally narrowed, not projecting below the second ; anterior border merging almost imperceptibly with the lateral; not striated ; marked with marginal sulcus. Lower portion of clypeus with a longitudinal median sulcus, upon each side of which are two widely separated punctures. Last somite produced into a blunt process, which scarcely projects beyond the margins of the anal valves. Margins of anal valves very slightly compressed, convex. Sub-anal plate triangular. Anterior lamina of copulatory organ is more or less quadrate, and is attached to that of the opposite side by a conspicuous trian- gular piece; each of the upper angles of the triangular piece is produced into a long process which curves over the upper end of the semiquadrate lamina; the anterior lamina is on each side extended backwards and comes into contact with the posterior lamina, which itself, more or less quadrate, forms the posterior wall of the channel in which lies the central foot-lamina. Attached to the upper margin of the anterior lamina and pro- jecting backward from it, there is a simple slightly curved rod, with the posterior extremity of which articulates the central lamina. This consists of a stout piece, with smooth curved _ rounded anterior border, blunt distal end, and with inner and hinder borders membranous and excavated. In the lower portion of the excavation lies a curled pointed flagellum. Four specimens, two males and two females, from King Island, and Owen Island. The female of this species, described from Bangkok, has hitherto only been known. SPIROBOLUS ANDERSONI, sp. nov. (Plate XXV. figs. 5-5 d.) Length of large specimen 52 mm. Number of somites 55. Anterior and posterior portions of each somite testaceous ; central portion slate-coloured ; legs, margins of first dorsal plate, antenne, and region of labrum testaceous. Each somite divided by two circular sulci into three parts. Foramen repugnatorium situated between the middle and posterior divisions ; middle and posterior divisions strongly striated at the sides; dorsally marked with scattered crescentic impressions; posterior portion finely striated longitudinally. Entire somite finely punctured. The crescentic impressions form a well-marked line running parallel with the margins of the somite; this line is fainter upon the posterior than upon the anterior somites. LINN. JOURN.—ZOOLOGY, VOL. XXI. 25 300. MR. R. I. POCOCK ON THE Lateral portions of first dorsal plate very much narrowed; anterior margin meeting the posterior margin in a rounded angle; margin of the angle and of the lower half of the dorsal plate with raised border; not striated. Lower portion of the clypeus with well-marked sulcus, upon each side of which are four punctures. Posterior segment produced into a more or less pointed process, which projects beyond the margins of the anal valves. Margins of anal valves convex and not compressed. Sub-anal plate triangular, with posterior angle rounded. Anterior lamina of copulatory foot wide above, narrow below, and at its distal end abruptly passing into a slender projection ; inner margin nearly straight; outer margin sinuate. Laterally it is in contact with the posterior lamina, which is pointed below, and bears near the distal extremity on the outer side a conspi- cuous indentation. Above there is a simple slender piece, articu- lated to the free extremity of which is a backwardly-projecting claviculiform rod. To the posterior end of this rod articulates the central lamina, which apparently consists of two segments, an upper and a lower; the two together, being hollowed out behind, form a complete sheath, chitinous in front, membranous in the rear. Upper segment slightly curved, with smooth round anterior margin, giving off at the point of junction with the lower segment two short processes; lower segment much smaller than the upper, terminates below in a pointed projection. Four specimens, two males and two females, from Elphinstone Island. Norr.—At the time when I began to draw up this Report upon the Myriopoda of the Mergui Archipelago, it was not possible, owing to the lack of similar Reports, to compare directly the fauna of this group of islands with that of any one district in the Oriental Region. An exception, however, to this statement must be made in the case of Ceylon; for the Myriopoda of this island have been worked out by Mons. A. Humbert. All that could be said in this respect was that the islands present general faunistic affinities—which certainly is true enough—with the rest of the Indian and Indo-Malayan area. But while the present paper has been in the hands of the printers I have fortunately had an opportunity of examining wo extensive collections of Burmese Myriopods. The first of MYRIOPODA OF THE MERGUI ARCHIPELAGO. 301 these was made by Sig. M. L. Fea, and has been kindly instrusted to my care by the Marquis G. Doria for the purpose of identify- ing the specimens it contains. The second, still more extensive than the first, was amassed by Mr. HE. W. Oates, who has, with great liberality, lately presented it in its entirety to the Natural History Museum. An inspection of these two collections is sufficient to show that the Myriopod fauna of Mergui is in most respects obviously related to that of South Burmah, and has certainly been derived from it. Consequently, in the case of the species of Glomeris, described on p. 290, I have thought it advisable to insert the description of what I consider is probably the parent species, namely that occurring on the mainland, and to treat the insular form as a variety. Otherwise, if the Mergui form be now described as a new species, it will be necessary, when reporting on the Burmese collection, to make the Burmese form the variety ; that is, the continental, and probably therefore the parent, form will stand as a variety of its own descendant—the insular form. On the other hand, it is desirable to consider another view of the case which would arise if there were met with on the mainland specimens resembling the Mergui form, pallida and others constituting a series of gradations from it to the red- bordered form carnifex. In that case carnifex should perhaps be considered a variety of pallida. Or, again, supposing even that pallida does not occur on the mainland, there is still the possibility that it (the Mergui form) may uot be derived from the Burmese form as it at present exists, but that it may be the unmodified descendant of a form which on the mainland, owing to keener competition, has been transformed into carnifex, while in Mergui it has remained un- changed, safe from such competition in its insular isolation. In that case either the two forms should constitute distinct species, or carnifex should rank as a variety of pallida. But to support this last hypothesis there is no evidence. In fact such evidence as there is, namely half a dozen specimens of carnifex from Tenasserim, and half a dozen of pallida from Mergui, is in favour of the view which has been adopted, 2. e. that pallida is a variety of carnifex. If the question of the relationship is capable of solution, the solution can only be arrived at by the exertions of collectors in both the districts in parts of which specimens haye hitherto only been taken. 802 MR. R. I. POCOCK ON THE Bibliography. Gervais, P.—Myriopodes,in Walckenaer’s Hist. nat. des Insectes, Aptéres, iv. Paris, 1847. Haasr, E—Die Indisch-Australischen Myriopoden (Chilopo-— den). Berlin, 1887. Humpert, A.—“ Essai sur les Myriopodes de Ceylan,” Mém. Soc. Phys. et Hist. nat. Genéve, xviii., 1865. Karscu, F.—“ Zum Studium der Myriopoda Polydesmia,” Archiv fiir Nature. xlvu. p. 36, 1881. Karscu, F.—“ Neue Juliden des Berliner Museums,” Zeitschr. Naturwiss. liv. p. 1, 1881. Kocn, C.—Die Myriopoden. Halle, 1863. Kocu, L.—“ Japanesische Arachniden und Myriopoden,” Verh. zool.-bot. Ges. Wien, xxvil. p. 787, 1878. Kontravuscen, C.—“ Gattungen und Arten Scolopendriden,” Archiv f. Naturg. xlvi. p. 50, 1881. Metnert, Fr.—‘ Myriopoda Mus. Cantab.,” Amer. Phil. Soe. 1886, p. 161. Myriopoda Mus. Havn.: Copenhagen, 1886. Prtrers, W.—Monatsber. d. konigl. preuss. Akad. Wiss. Berlin, 1864. Porats, C. O. v.—‘ Om nigra exotiska Myriopoder,” Bihang K. Svensk. Vet.-Akad. Handl. iv., 1876. Saussure, H. pe.—“ Description de divers Myriopodes du Musée de Vienne,” Verh. zool.-bot. Ges. Wien, xix., 1869. Témosvary, E.—Myriopoda a Joanne Xantus in Asia orientali collecta. Enumeravit speciesque novas descripsit. Term. Fuzetek, ix. p. 62. Vogrs, E.—‘“ Beitrige zur Kenntniss der Juliden,” Zeitschr. wiss. Zool. xxxi., 1878. Note.—Not to overburden the text, I have purposely refrained from giving references to many works which treat generally of the Myriopoda. An almost complete list of the papers dealing with Oriental and Australian Chilopoda occurs scattered through Dr. Haase’s monograph, of which special mention has been made ; and in Dr. Latzel’s ‘Die Myriopoden der Oster.-Ungar. Monar- chie,’ ii. (Wien, 1884), will be found a nearly complete list, up to date, of all the publications of which this group (Myriopoda) constitutes a part or the whole of the subject-matter. MYRIOPOVA OF THE MERGUI ARCHIPELAGO. 303 DESCRIPTION OF THE PLATES, Pratz XXIV. Big. 1. Aimantarium Meinerti, sp.n. Anterior end of body, from above. la. Pe 3 Anterior end of body, from below. 16. Be 5 Pesterier end of body, from beiow. 2. Orphneus brevilabiatus. Anterior end of body, from above. 2a. $3 a Posterior end of body, from below. 3. Himantarium indicum. Anterior end of body, from above. 3a, es Anterior end of body, from below. 3b. Bi Fe Posterior end of body, from below. 4,4a, 46. Acanthodesmus pilipes. Krom above. Ac. H 06 Copulatory foot. 5. Paradesmus Karschi, sp.n. From above. 5a. i; P, Copulatory foot. 56. 5 59 Apex of copulatory foot. 6,6a,66. Paradesmus crucifer, sp.n. From above. 7. Glomeris carnifes, sp. n., var. pallida, nov. Copulatory feet. Wea Nes e Fe D i Highteenth pair of feet. Puats XXV. Fig.1. Spirostrepius aterrimus, sp. nu. Anterior end of body, frem the side. la. BS . Posterior end of body, from the side. 16. < i A median somite, from below. de. > 5 Copulatory apparatus, from the front. id. Hs - Internal lamina of copulatory feot. 2. a5 opinatus (Karsch). Anterior end of body, from the side. 2a. 5 i Posterior end of body, from the side. 26. 7 $6 Copulatory apparatus, froma the front. 2. 5 3 internal Jamina of copulatory appa- ratus. ay S regis, sp. n. Anterior end of body, from the side. 3a. 39 ee Posterior end of body, frem the side. 4, Spirobolus caudulanus (Karsch). Anterior end of body, from the side. Aa. 7 54 Posterior end of body, from the side. 4d. 35 45 Posterior end of body, from below. D. % Anderseni, sp.n. Antericr end of body, from the side. 5a. 3 3 Posterior end of body, frem the side. 5d. 35 ¥ Copulatory apparatus, from the front. Be. 5 “ Cepulatory apparatus, from the side. 5d. 4 Internal jamina of cepulatory apparatus. 6. pie anus (Karsch). Anterior end of body, from the side, 6a. 0 5 Posterior end of body, from the side. 6 0. * s Copulatory apparatus, from the front. Ger 5, _ Copulatory apparatus, from the side. 6d. s 3 Internal lamina of copulatory apparatus. 6 e. i ae Apex of internal lamina of copulatory foot. LINN. JOURN.—ZGOLOGY, VOL. XXI. 98 804 DR. P. H. CARPENTER ON THE Report on the Comatule of the Mergui Archipelago, collected for the Trustees of the Indian Museum, Calcutta, by Dr. John Anderson, F.R.S., Superintendent of the Museum. By P. Herpert Carrventer, D.Sce., F.R.S., F.L.S., Assistant Master at Eton College. [Read 21st June, 1888.] (Puatrs XXVI. & XXVIT.) THE Comatule collected by Dr. Anderson at Mergui were all obtained at one locality, King Island. Most of them belong to the genus Anfedon, two species of which are represented by five and by twelve examples respectively ; while there are three other individuals belonging to as many different species, one of whichis new toscience. The genus Actinometra is represented by three examples of a new and remarkable type, which I found to be the host of a parasitic Myzostoma. Three of the species of Antedon were similarly infested; and the Myzostoma-species found on them have been placed in the hands of Professor von Graff for identification and description. The following list contains the names and specific formule of the Mergui Comatule, which are classified ou the principles set forth in the Report on the Comatule dredged by the ‘Challenger ’*. Genus ANTEDON, de Freminville. Series I. Elegans-group. A, Andersoni, sp.n. 7 Description of the Specimens. ANTEDON ELEGANS, Bell. Specific Formula, A. R.3.2. (2). a 1882. Antedon elegans, Bell, Proc. Zool. Soe. Lond. 1882, p. 534. 1882. Antedon elegans, Carpenter, Proc. Zool. Soc. Lond. 1882, pp. 746, 747. 1884. Antedon elegans, Bell, Rep. Zool. Coll. H.M.S. ‘Alert,’ Lond. 1884, p. 162, pl. xii. figs. B, B a. 1888. Antedon fluctuans (elegans), Carpenter, Zool. ‘Chall.’ Exped. part lx. 1888, pp. 94, 264, pl. vin. Habitat. King Island. Five specimens. Two of them “ sub- littoral ;’ two “on corals; one with the cirri coiled round a Gorgoniid. Remarks. This species was first described by Bell in the ‘Alert’ Report. But he overlooked its most important character, the syzygial union of the two outer radials. Three examples of it were dredged by the ‘Challenger,’ and were described by myself as Antedon fluctuans; for I was then in ignorance of the real character of A. elegans. This I only discovered subse- quently, when examining Bell’s type for the purpose of deter- mining its relation to the other tridistichate species of Antedon with articulated radials. ‘The sheet containing the description of A. fluctuans had then been printed off, and the plate lettered with this name; but a note was inserted further on in the Report* to point out the identity of A. fluctuans with A. elegans, Bell; and the latter name was used both in the classified list of Antedon- * Zool. ‘Ohallenger’ Exped. part Ix., 1888, p. 264. 306 ‘DR. P. H. CARPENTER ON THE species on p. 58 and in the distribution-lists at the end of the Report. The five examples of A. elegans from Mergui are mostly larger than those obtained by the ‘Challenger’ and ‘ Alert’ in the Arafura Sea and Torres Strait respectively. The arms of the largest one reach 10 centim. in length, and their earlier joints are relatively shorter, with a more wedge-shaped outline and a greater tendency to overlap than is visible in the ‘Challenger’ specimens. The number of arms is small, however, rarely exceeding thirty; for the post-palmar series which occur in three of the four individuals obtained by the ‘Challenger’ are not present at all in those from Mergui; and the full complement of palmar series is rarely found on any ray. As arule, only the two inner series are present; so that there are six arms to the ray, viz. 1,2, 2,1, asin A. spinifera; while the distichal axillaries are sometimes altogether absent. Both these conditions are well shown in the specimen figured by Bell. On the other hand, the Mergui forms show but little tendeney to any variation from the type of two palmars, such as occurs in ely spedines and in one of those obtained by the * Challenger. The rays of the ee are quite free laterally; but those of the largest specimen from Mergui are more closely in contact, and the distichal joints sometimes exhibit a tendency to the straight-edged and wall-sided character which is so marked in many deep-sea Comatule. This is much more distinct in the Philippine variety of A. elegans, which I hope to describe shortly together with the other Comatule obtained by Professor Semper in the same locality. All the Mergui specimens are much more darkly coloured than those obtained by the ‘ Challenger’ and ‘Alert,’ two of them being almost black; another is a dark reddish brown, mottled with lighter patches ; and one has a more uniform lighter shade of the same colour. The youngest individual has its cirri coiled round a Gorgoniid (Plevaura) of the same dark reddish-brown colour as itself; while a Myzostoma infesting one of the two blacker specimens is as darkly coloured as its host. ANTEDON ANDERSON], sp.n. (Plate XXVI. figs. 1-5; Plate XXVILI. fig. 8.) bc Specifie Formula. A. BR. 2.2. 2, 2, — COMATULZ OF THE MERQGUI ARCHIPELAGO. 307 Description of an Individual. Centro-dorsal a thick disk, bearing about forty cirri, which reach 60 millim. in length. They consist of 60-70 tolerably uniform joints, the distal halves of which have sharp spines. First radials partially visible; the second and third narrow, strongly convex, and united by syzygy. The rays are quite free laterally, and divide four or five times ; each series of two articulated joints, the first nearly square, and the axillary pentagonal, often as long or longer than wide. All these joints are relatively deep and narrow, with a strongly rounded dorsal surface. Arms very numerous, fifteen or eighteen to the ray, with compressed joints, the lower ones oblong, and their successors more unequally quadrate. A syzygy in the third brachial, with others following at very uncertain intervals (5-18 joints); but they are apparently altogether absent in some arms. The first pinnule (on 2nd brachial) is slender and tapering, con- sisting of 385 or more elongated joints, and reaching nearly 25 millim. in length. The next few brachials bear quite short pinuules, with only some six or eight joints ; and their successors increase slowly in length, but never become specially long. Disk much incised, and not regularly plated, though the integument is very dense and tough. Colour very dark, almost black—probably deep purple in life,— with lighter patches on the arms. Sacculi very abundant on the pinnules. Disk 25 millim.; spread 35 centim. Habitat. King Island; sublittoral. One specimen and a detached disk. Remarks. Thisis a fine species which may be referred for the present to the Hlegans-group; though it differs from the three members of the group which are at present known in certain essential characters. If other species resembling it should even- tually be discovered, it may be useful to establish a second group in Series I. of the Antedon-species, and to call it the Andersoni- group. The three existing members of the Hlegans-group are all tridistichate, and have a well-plated disk; whereas Antedon An- dersoni is bidistichate, and the disk has nothing like the large plates covering the interpalmar areas which occur in A. multi- radiata, A. elegans, and A. microdiscus. But, on the other hand, it is very tough and leathery, and the ambulacral grooves are more or less completely closed by the approximation of their 308 DR. P. H. CARPENTER ON THE -sides. This is also visible in the lower parts of the brachial -ambulacra, which are often entirely closed by an irregular alterna- tion of processes from opposite sides (Pl. XX VI. figs.4,5). There is, however, no indication either of side-plates or of covering- plates on the pinnule-ambulacra, which are of the usual cha- racter. But isolated portions of the brachial ambulacra effervesce strongly with acid, and the perisome would therefore seem to contain a cousiderable amount of diffused limestone particles which are not concentrated into definite spicules or plates, as in most other Crinoids. This would partly account for the hardness and leathery character of the perisome on the disk. The condition of the disk and the bidistichate rays are the essential points of difference between A. Andersoni and the three existing members of the Hlegans-group. It resembles, but sur- passes them allin the great length of its cirri (Pl. XX VII. fig. 8), and also in the length of the first pinnule; but this pinnule is on the second brachial and not on the second distichal as in the Hlegans-group, while its successors do not decrease slowly in length, but exhibit a sudden and remarkable diminution in size (Pl. XXVI. fig. 2), that of the third brachial ccensisting of but half a dozen small joints. The following pinnules increase gradually in length, but never reach any considerable size. Another characteristic feature of A. Andersoni is the convex shape of the joints forming the rays and their subdivisions, and also the lateral compression of the arm-joints. Owing, however, to the rays being so widely separated, there is no trace whatever of that lateral flattening of their bases which is so characteristic of the Basicurva, Spinifera, and Granulifera-groups, and occasionally shows itself also in A. elegans. It is very marked in the fossil A. costata, for which Walther* has recently proposed to restore the generic name Solanocrinus, originally applied to this species by Goldfuss. For he believes that the fossil species which he refers to this genus are devoid of the syzygies in the arms which occur more or less frequently in other Crinoids. He attempts to establish some other characters which would distinguish the genus from Antedon—an attempt which he would scarcely have made had he been better acquainted both with the literature of the subject and with the condition of many recent species * “(Untersuchungen uber den Bau der Crinoiden, mit besonderer Berick- sichtigung der Formen aus dem Solenhofener Schiefer und dem Kelheimer Diceraskalk,”’ Paleontographica, 1886, Bd. xxxii. p. 175. COMATULE OF THE MERGUI ARCHIPELAGO. 309 of Antedon, as I have pointed out elsewhere*; and the only character, therefore, on which he can possibly rely for the separation of WSolanocrinus from Antedon is the presence of syzygies in the arms of the latter and their absence in those of the former genus. - But the material on which he has founded this generalization seems to me to be altogether insuffi- cient. Few, ifany, of his very limited number of specimens have as many as forty arm-joints remaining, and these are rarely in a satisfactory state of preservation ; so that it is somewhat rash to speak positively about the total absence of syzygies in the arms of Solanocrinus. In fact, I have shown reason to believe that syzygies are present even in some of the arms which are figured and described by Walther as being entirely devoid of them. On the other hand, Antedon Andersoni is remarkable for the rarity of the syzygies in the arms. It was along time before 1 could discover any at all, except that in the third brachial. In fact, I did not succeed in finding any in some arms; while in others they are often separated by intervals of ten or a dozen joints. In A. elegans and A. multiradiata the second syzygy may not be till the fortieth or even the sixtieth brachial, and the intervals between its successors may be fifteen or twenty joints. Were these species in the fossil state, therefore, with only the lowest portions of the arms preserved, and that but badly, it would be easy to overlook the syzygy in the third brachial, and to infer that none were present in the arms at all; though such an inference would not be in accordance with the facts of the case. I cannot but suspect, therefore, that Walther’s attempt to establish the absence of syzygies as a diagnostic character of Solanocrinus is due partly to a generalization on imperfect material, and partly to an insufficient acquaintance with the variations in the distribution of the syzygies among recent Comatule. Any member of the Hlegans-group, preserved in the fossil state, would make a fairly good Solanocrinus; for each species has a relatively large centro-dorsal, bearing a good number of cirri, with few syzygies between the brachials, but one between the two outer radials. This latter condition certainly occurs in Solanocrinus costatus, and probably also in S. imperialis and * “The Generic Position of Solanocrinus,” Ann. & Mag. Nat. Hist. 1887, ser, 5, vol. xix. pp. 82, 83. 310 DR. P. H. CARPENTER ON THE S. gracilis, as I have explained elsewhere*; and I am inclined to regard these last-mentioned species as the ancestral forms of the existing members of the Hlegans-group. On the other hand, Antedon scrobiculata and A. aspera, with a bifascial articulation between the two outer radials, were the Jurassic representatives of the majority of the recent species of Antedon, in which the two outer radials are also united by a bifascial joint. Antrpon Miupertt t, Mill., sp. (Plate XX VII. figs. 6, 7.) Specific Formula. A. = 1888. Antedon Milberti, Carpenter, Zool. ‘Chall. Eap. part |x. p. 194, pl. xxxv. figs. 4-6. A dozen examples of this widely distributed species were ob- tained at King Island, half of them from mud-flats exposed at spring-tide. They are mostly of a light reddish-brown colour, but one is more yellowish brown, and another is almost white. Most of the larger specimens have the bases of the rays some- what flattened laterally, as is often the case in this species, and there is a good deal of variation in the relative sizes of the lower pinnules. The fourth pinnule on the side is sometimes consi- derably shorter than the third, and sometimes nearly equal to it (Pl. X XVII. figs. 6, 7). This species is infested by a Myzostoma, which will be described by Professor von Graff. ANTEDON sPrcaTA, Carpenter. (Plate XX VII. figs. 3-5.) Specific Formula. A. 2. 2. (2). = 1881. Antedon spicata, Carpenter, Notes from the Leyden Museum, 1881, vol. ii. p. 190. ~ A single individual, which I take to belong to this species, occurred at King Island (sublittoral). But it has rather more cirri than the type specimen at Leyden, and in this respect ap- proaches the allied species Antedon indica and A. tuberculata, which resemble it in having long and stiff pinnules on the fourth and fifth brachials. In A. indica, however, the first pinnule is much smaller than the large second one, as is well shown in Smith’s figuret, while in A. spicata it may nearly equal its suc- * Ann. & Mag. Nat. Hist. 1887, ser. 5, vol. xix. pp. 83-87. t The bibliography of this species will be found in the ‘Challenger’ Report. t Zoology of Rodriguez, Echinodermata: Phil. Trans. 1879, vol. elxviii. pl. li. fig. 30. COMATUL® OF THE MERGUI ARCHIPELAGO. 311 cessor in length, though it is far more slender (Pl. XX VII. fig.3). That of A. tuberculata is also short, though stiffer than in the other two forms. This species approaches A. spicata, however, iu the character of its third pinnule, which is composed of elongated joints like those of the second, and not of numerous smaller joints as in A. indica. In some arms of A. spicata this third pinnule is smaller on the outer than on the inner side of the arm, 7. e. the pinnule on the seventh is larger than that on the sixth bra- ehial (Pl. XX VII. fig. 3). But the component joints of these large and stiff pinnules have not the extreme length which they reach in A. tuberculata; and the characters of this Mergui example of A. spicata confirm my separation of this species from A. tuberculata; for the latter has but twelve joints in a second pinnule which reaches 15 millim. long, while in the former species a pinnule of the same length consists of sixteen joints or more. In both alike, however, the rays have marginal projections which seem to be absent in A. indica. But the cirri of A. tuber- culata are stouter, though with a somewhat smaller number of joints than occur in A. spicata (Pl. XX VII. fig. 4). The type specimen of the latter has no post-palmar axillary, but one occurs in the Mergui example, which necessitates the addition of a 2 (in brackets) to the specific formula. ANTEDON CONJUNGENS, Carpenter. (Plate X XVII. figs. 1, 2.) Specific Formula. A. 2. 2. 2. é 1888. Antedon conjungens, Carpenter, Zool. ‘Chall.’ Exp. part Ix. p. 233, pl. xlv. fig. 1. One mutilated individual which seems to belong to this species was obtained at King Island (sublittoral). Like the other Coma- tule from this locality it is very darkly coloured, while the two specimens found by the ‘ Challenger’ on the Zebu Reefs are light grey, with occasional dark patches, and the margins of the lower parts of the rays are more produced towards the ventral side than is the case in the Merguiform. The characters of the cirri and of the arm-divisions are, however, the same in both; aud the pin- nule-arrangement is also generally similar in the two types. The largest pinnule is on the fourth brachial, and it is much larger on the outer than on the inner arm of each distichium; in the former ease the pinnule on the second brachial is also of con- = LINN. JOURN.—ZOOLOGY, VO. XXI. 21 312 DR. P. H. CARPENTER ON THE siderable size, but on the inner arms it is a good deal smaller (Pl. XX VII. figs. 1, 2). . ; The chief point of difference between the Mergui and the Phi- lippine specimens is in the size of the third pinnule, that on the sixth brachial. In the outer arms of the Mergui individual (Pl. XX VIL. fig. 1) its length relatively to that of its predecessor on the fourth brachial is but little smaller than in the type-speci- mens from Zebu; but on the inner arms (Pl. X XVII. fig. 2) the difference between the second and third pinnules is more marked. Those of the type specimens are sometimes nearly equal, though not always so; but in the Mergui form the difference is often considerable (Pl. XX VIL. figs. 1,2); it is not so great, however, asin Antedon protecta, in which the third pinnule is much reduced in size, not only on the inner, but also on the outer arms. ACTINOMETRA NOTATA, sp. 0. (Plate XXVI. figs. 6-12.) f f" , Specific Formula. A. R. EPP 3 ). seve Centro-dorsal a thick disk, bearing 30 or 35 marginal cirri. These have about 25 joints, the later ones shurt and wide, with but little trace of spines. First radials more or less concealed ; the two outer ones united by syzygy. Arms 31 to 50 or more in number. The distichal and palmar series each of two joints united by syzygy, with one or two further divisions of the same character; the first two brachials also united by syzygy. The next syzygy is sometimes in the third or fourth, but usually not till the tenth or fifteenth brachial, and others follow at intervals of 2-4 joints. The lowest brachials are nearly oblong, and their successors triangular and wider than long, soon becoming more quadrate, and finally nearly oblong again. The first pinnule is on the second brachial, and is very long and flagellate with a large terminal comb, reaching nearly 40 millim. on the outside of the ray. The following pinnules dimi- nish rather rapidly in length, and lose their comb after about the eighth brachial, but never become specially short. The two basal joints of the first three or four pinnules on each side are more or less carinate. Mouth obscurely radial ; the disk may have calcareous granules in the anal interradius, or be entirely naked. All the arms are grooved. COMATULE OF THE MERGUI ARCHIPELAGO. 313 Colour in spirit, dark blackish brown. Disk 30 millim. ; spread 25 centim. Habitat. King Island ; sublittoral. Three specimens. Remarks. This fine species exhibits the same peculiarities of the rays and their subdivisions as are characteristic of Actinometra paucicirra; but whereas the presence of palmar series is an ex- ception in A. paucicirra, so that the number of arms is limited to twenty, palmars are always present in 4. nofata. Furthermore, they may be followed by one or even by two post-palmar series (Pl. XX VL. fig. 7), and the number of arms therefore is sometimes twice as great asin Actinometra paucicirra. In the latter species, too, which normally has but four arms to the ray, the two outer arms generally have a syzygy in the third brachial; but in A. notata, with six to twelve arms on the ray, this character occurs but rarely (Pl. XXVI. fig. 6). The latter species is further distinguished from A. paucicirra, which has no cirri in the adult condition, by the large size of the centro-dorsal, and its numerous and well-developed cirri (Pl. XX VI. figs.11,12). It would seem, ‘however, that the centro-dorsal of A. notata undergoes a certain amount of retromorphosis before reaching maturity ; for it is relatively largest in the youngest individual (Pl. XX VI. fig. 8), partly concealing the second radials, which are united laterally, and its dorsal surface, though flat, is not hollowed in any way. In the two adult individuals, however, portions of the first radials are visible, in one case a considerable amount (Pl. XXVI. fig. 7), while the dorsal surface of the centro-dorsal is distinctly hollowed. The disk of the youngest individual is entirely naked; while those of the two larger forms bear well marked calcareous granules in the anal interradius. The arrangement of the ambulacra in one of them is very singular (Pl. XX VI. fig. 6). The mouth seems to be radial, and the number of groove-trunks connected with the peristome is very considerable. The aboral portion of the left an- tero-lateral ray B*, which includes the arms borne upon its pos- terior distichal axillary, has an altogether abnormal groove-supply. The ambulacra of its anterior arms (6°) are directly connected with the peristome, as is often the case; one would therefore expect to find those of its posterior arms, b*, supplied by a branch of the single primary ambulacrum, which in the ordinary species of Actinometra passes round the disk to reach the left postero- lateral ray (see woodcut). In the specimen before me, however, the ambulacrum proceeding in this direction from the left posterior Palle B14 DR. P. H. CARPENTER ON THE angle of the peristome comes to a sudden end on the disk, imme- diately after its first bifurcation; and all the ambulacral grooves D2 D1 Diagram of the disk of a normal Actinometra, with interradial mouth *. The dotted lines mark the interambulacral regions of the disk. A, A,.... H, BE, the five pairs of secondary ambulacra. of the corresponding ray (C) together with those of the distal arms on the B ray (6*) are connected with the single groove- trunk, which comes round the right side of the disk to supply the hinder arms of the D ray (Pl. XX VI. fig. 6). I cannot account in any way for this abnormal arrangement, which does not appear to be accidental, at any rate so far as the union of the right and left posterior ambulacra is concerned (C* and D'). But it is just possible that the parasitic growths which appear upon some of the brachial ambulacra may have also shown themselves on the disk, and have destroyed the connection between the pri- mary groove-trunk of the left posterior ray and its peripheral branches, a connection which was not fully restored by the re- generation of that part of the disk. But I imagine that it would be going too far to assume that the connection between C* and D’ ambulacra arose in consequence of this loss ; for there are so many cases in which a large proportion of the hinder arms of an Actinometra are entirely devoid of ambulacra, that there would not seem to be any absolute necessity for the isolated left poste- * From the Report on the ‘Challenger’ Comatule, by kind permission of the Editor, Dr. John Murray. COMATULE OF THE MERGUI ARCHIPELAGO. SLE rior arms in this individual being brought into communication with the peristome. It would be interesting to learn to what extent these arms are isolated ; whether, for example, the water-vessel continues on- ward in its normal course, although there is no ambulacrum above it. I think it not improbable that such might be the case, as it certainly is so in the ungrooved and non-tentaculiferous arms of several species. The parasitic growths to which I have referred above are of a very singular character. They only present themselves upon this one individual, and occur along some of the brachial ambulaera, blocking them more or less completely. Some of them have been removed and sent to Professor von Graff, who will report upon them separately. DESCRIPTION OF THE PLATES. Pruate XXVI. Figs. 1-5. Antedon Andersont, sp. n. 1. Dorsal view of the calyx and arm-bases, x 2. 2. Side view of the second and following brachials, with their pinnules, x 2. 3. Side view of the lower part of an arm, X 2. 4. Portion of a brachial ambulacrum, as seen after removal of the pinnules, x 4. 5, The same, with one pinnule in situ, x4. Figs. 6-10. Actinometra notata, sp. n. Fig. 6. A disk, with abnormally distributed ambulacra, x 13. 7. Dorsal aspect of the adjacent portions of two rays in an adult indivi- dual, x 2. 8. Dorsal aspect of the calyx and arm-bases in an immature specimen, x 9. Dorsal view of the middle part of an arm, x 2. 10. Side view of the second and following brachials, with their pinnules, X 2. 11. A cirrus, x 2. 12. Another, less mature, x 2. Puate XXVII. Figs. 1, 2. Antedon conjungens, Carpenter. Fig. 1. Side view of the second and following brachials in the outer arm of a distichium, with their pinnules, x 3. . The same part of an inner arm X 3. ie) 316 PROF. P. M. DUNCAN AND MR. W. P. SLADEN ON THE Figs. 3-5. Antedon spicata, Carpenter. Fig. 3. Side view of the second and following brachials, with their pinnules ; the second pair of pinnules have their ends broken away. x 3. 4, A cirrus, X 3. 5. Dorsal view of the middle part of an arm, xX 3. Figs. 6, '7. Antedon Milberti, Miull., sp. Fig. 6. Side view of the second and following brachials, with their pinnules, x 2. 7. The same, from another individual, x 2. Fig. 8. Antedon Andersoni, sp. n. Fig. 8. A cirrus, X 2. On the Echinoidea of the Mergui Archipelago, collected for the Trustees of the Indian Museum, Calcutia, by Dr. John - Anderson, F.R.S., Superintendent of the Museum. By Prof. P. Martin Deaanes M.B. (Uond.), F. R. S., F.L.S., and W. Percy Suiapen, F.G.S., Sec. L.8. [Read 21st June, 1888. | Tur Echinoidea collected by Dr. Anderson are represented by six species; and although these are all known forms their association in such a limited area is remarkable, and, so far as we are aware, without precedent. The fact that all the regular Echinids belong to the family Temnopleuride is especially striking; aud the circumstance is the more noteworthy, asin a collection from the Andaman Islands, described last year by Prof. Jeffrey Bell, not a single Temnopleurid is recorded; and, furthermore, out of nine genera mentioned by him as occurring at the Andaman Islands, not one is represented in the collection placed in our hands from the Mergui Archipelago. All the species, with the exception of one, are essentially Indian-Ocean forms; the majority of the examples, however, present a certain amount of variation when compared with spe- cimens from other localities which is sufficient to impart a local character. These differences are recorded in the following notes ; but we have not thought them of sufficient importance to warrant in any case their recognition by name as a definite variety. ECHINOIDEA OF THER MERGUI ARCHIPELAGO, 3h7 Perhaps the most interesting form in the collection, which is not a characteristic Indian-Ocean species, is Arachnoides placenta. The home of this Echinid is Australia and New Zealand; and, with the exception of an example in the Boston Museum from Burmah, mentioned by Alex. Agassiz, no other occurrence of the species in the Indian Ocean proper is on record. Subclass EUECHINOIDEA, Bronn. Order DIADEMATOIDA. Suborder STHEREOSOMUATA. Family TEMNOPLEURIDE. Subfamily TemNoPLEURINA. Genus TEMNOPLEURUS, Agassiz. 1. TEMNOPLEURUS TOREUMATICUS (Klein), Agassiz. Cidaris toreumatica, Klein, 1734, Nat. Disp. Echin. p. 22. Temnopleurus toreumaticus, Agassiz, 1841, Monogr. Scutelles, p. 7. Locality. King Island (native name Padaw). Genus Satmacis, Agassiz. 1. SatMacts suncata, Agassiz. Salmacis suleata, Agassiz, 1846, Cat. Rais., Ann. Sct. Nat. vol. vi. p. 359. Locality. King Island (native name Padaw); 25th Jan. 1882. Remarks. Test slightly conical, with large well-marked pits. Spines rather short, those on the actinal surface a rich dark purple or violet, but white at the base and occasionally at the tip; close to the peristome more white is present. Mailiaries and many secondaries altogether white. ; Colour of the test green, with a brighter or yellowish shade along the median areas of the ambulacral and interambulacral areas. 2. Saumacis DussuMIERI, Agassiz. Salmacis Dussumieri, Agassiz, 1846, Cat. Rais., Ann. Sci. Nat. vol. vi. p- 359. Locality. King Island (native name Padaw); 25th Jan. 1882. Remarks. Most of the specimens of this species known in Museums are denuded of spines, The example under notice is well preserved. The spines at the ambitus are remarkable for their length and disproportionate size in relation to the other 318 THE ECHINOIDEA OF THE MERGUI ARCHIPELAGO. spines on the test ; the Urchin, when viewed from above, has in consequence the appearance of being furnished with a richly variegated fringe. These spines are white, banded on the outer two thirds with narrow rings of reddish purple. The other spines on the test, which are small, delicate, and sharply pointed, are white. The colour of the test is creamy white. The naked median areas are broad and very conspicuous. 3. SALMACIS BICOLOR, Agassiz. Salmacis bicolor, Agassiz, 1841, in Valentin, Anat. Genre Echinus, p- Vill. Locality. King Island (native name Padaw); Jan. 1882 ; sub- littoral. Remarks. One of the examples from King Island is somewhat higher and more conical in the test than the other specimen ; and both are relatively higher and more conical than examples from Mauritius. In general habit and coloration the lower example from King Island strikingly recalls examples from Madras. This may probably bea variety. The colour of the spines is light green, banded with rich reddish purple and a light pinkish purple at the base, both on the abactinal and actinal surfaces. Order CLYPEASTROIDA. Family La eanip 4a, (subfamily) A. Agassiz. Genus Lacanum, Klein. 1. LaGanuM DEPRESSUM, Agassiz. Laganum depressum (Lesson § Garnot, MS.), Agassiz, 1841, Monogr Scutelles, p. 110. , Locality. King Island (native name Padaw) ; 25th Jan. 1882. Family ScureELLiIpa, Agassiz. Subfamily ARACHNINA. Genus ARACHNOIDES, Klein. 1. ARACHNOIDES PLACENTA (Linné), Agassiz. Echiuus placenta, Linné, 1766, Syst. Nat. ed. xii. p. 1105. Arachnoides placenta, Agassiz, 1841, Monogr. Scutelles, p. 94. Locality. King Island (native name Padaw) ; Feb. 1882. Remarks, The single example collected by Dr. Anderson is THE ASTEROIDEA OF THE MERGUI ARCHIPELAGO. 319 of large size, and differs somewhat in the marginal contour from Australian and New-Zealand specimens ; the odd anterior radial area being rather more prominent, and the anterior pair of inter- radial areas flatter in their curvature, which causes the margin of the test to be less fully rounded in front, and the greatest breadth to be more conspicuously posterior to the postero-lateral petals. The marginal contour is, however, subject to such a great amount of variation throughout the family, that we do not con- sider it of sufficient importance to give a name to the variety ; and. until a further series of examples is available, we confine ourselves to the simple record of the circumstance. On the Asteroidea of the Mergui Archipelago, collected for the Trustees of the Indian Museum, Calcutta, by Dr. John Anderson, F.R.S., Superintendent of the Museum. By W. Percy Siapen, F.G.S., Sec. LS. [Read 21st June, 1882. ] (Puate XXVIII.) Tue collection of Asteroidea made by Dr. Anderson in the Mergui Archipelago, although small, is particularly interesting. It is noteworthy, not only from the fact that it contains several new as well as rare forms, but also because some ot the examples which I have referred to known species show variations which are sufficient to impart a character to the collection as a whole, and to indicate the existence of local conditions whose action upon types of a more plastic nature than that of the series of forms so far collected would probably result in new morphological developments. That the representatives of other forms occur in this area is highly probable; and it seems to me, therefore, a reasonable expectation that a number of “new species” may ultimately be found in the Mergui Archipelago when further dredging operations are carried out. From what I have seen, I think it is not too bold to throw out the suggestion that the Mergui area may be looked upon as a moulding ground wherein Malayan types assume a modified form, approaching to a certain extent the Indian-Ocean facies, but maintaining a iocal and independent character. 320 MR. W. PERCY SLADEN ON THE It is interesting to note that out of twelve species of Aste- rids from the Andaman Islands recently determined by Prof. F. Jeffrey Bell*, only one-—Archaster typicus—occurs in the Mergui collection; and out of seven genera, only two are repre- sented—Archaster and Astropecten. Dr. Anderson has kindly given me detailed particulars of the localities, which I append verbatim, not only on account of their intrinsic interest, but as furnishing an explanation of the character of the fauna :— “The locality in King Island from which the Asterids and Echinids were obtained is a small bay on the eastern side of the island, near its northern end. It is well sheltered as it opens towards the north, and is protected by high land to the west, south, and east, the mountains to the west and south rising to an altitude of 2530 and 2125 feet. It is thus completely shut in from the storms of the south-west monsoon. The bay is shallow, as its depth ranges only from 2 to 9 fathoms, the average being 4 fathoms. Its bed is almost entirely covered with a deep deposit of mud brought down by a number of small streams that flow into it, especially at its head, from which the sea retires for about two miles at low water, exposing extensive mud- flats deeply furrowed by the channels of the little rivers. A few small islands occur at the limit of low water, and off one of them my vessel was stationed for about a month. At low tide the mouth of one of the streams was close to the island, in line with its seaward face, while another occupied a similar position on its eastern side. Theisland was only a few acres in extent, and was surrounded by mud-flats except on its northern side, which had a rocky shore. Here at low water, with a freshwater stream flowing out through the mud-flat on either side, sponges, corals, and Alcyoniid and Gorgoniid Alcyonaria abounded, and were partially exposed at spring-tides, the water bathing them being richly charged with mud. The Asterids and Hchinids were found under these conditions, also the Comatulids, and the few Hydroida and Actinie, and the great mass of the Mollusca described by Prof. v. Martens. “ The sea between King Island and the mainland, and along the entire coast, from Tavoy Point to the Pak chun estuary, contains * Proc. Zool. Soc. Lond. 1887, p. 140. ASTEROIDEA OF THE MERGUI ARCHIPELAGO. ByeIL much less salt than it does around the outer islands of the Archi- pelago, as the Tavoy and Tenasserim rivers discharge a great body of water, supplemented by the outflow of many other but smaller streams. Another result of this freshwater discharge is that the bed of the sea around the inner islands is covered by a thick layer of mud brought down by these rivers. King Island is situated 10 miles to the west of Mergui. “The conditions, however, that prevail at Owen Island are very different, as this island, which is about 73 miles south of King Island, and nearly 30 miles to the west of the main land, lies fully exposed to the Bay of Bengal. The little bay in this island, visited by me, occurs at its southern end. Its head was margined by bright yellow sand—high and dry—on which were numerous examples of a Spirula thrown up during the storms of the south- west monsoon. This sand was succeeded by a bank of coral, while the sides of the bay were strewn with stems and broken fragments of coral, lying over gravel and sand. On this part of the shore I obtained the Echinoderms from Owen Island, and among them, I believe, more than one species of Sand-star —one, a small active form that rapidly buried itself in the sand when the stones under which it was found were disturbed. “The western side of Sullivan Island also lies open to the Bay of Bengal, and as the prevalent wind at night was from the east, I had, for safety’s sake, to anchor my vessel under the shelter of the high land of the island, within some rocky islets that defined a kind of bay into which a number of small streams flowed. When I attempted to dredge, I found the bottom to be composed entirely of mud about one mile from the shore. It yielded a few Mollusca and some immature Penna- tulids, In the tidal way between the islets and the main island corals occurred in profusion, and among them I obtained the Echinoderms from Sullivan Island. This island is situated about 13 miles to the south of Owen Island. “Sir William James Island is 10 miles to the south of Sullivan Island, and out at sea.—J. A.” 322 MR. W. PERCY SLADEN ON THE Subclass EUASTEROIDEA, Sladen. Order PHANEROZONTA, Sladen. Family ARCHASTERID & (Viguier), emend. Sladen. Subfamily ArcHasTERINz, Sladen. Genus ArcuastEr, Miller & Troschel. 1. Ancaster Typicus, Miiller & Troschel. Archaster typicus, Muller & Troschel, 1840 (April), Monatsber. d. k. Akad. d. Wiss. Berlin, p. 104; System der Asteriden, 1842, p. 65. Astropecten stellaris, Gray, 1840 (November), Ann. & Mag. Nat. Hist. vol. vi. p. 181. Archaster nicobaricus, Mobius(n. sp. Behn, MS.), 1859, Neue Seesterne des Hamburger und Kieler Museums, p. 13 (Abhandl. a. d. Gebiete Naturw. hrsq. v. d. naturwiss. Verein, Hamburg, Bd. iv. Abth. 2, 1860). Localities. King Island (native name Padaw); Feb. 1882. Sir William James Island; 7th Dec. 1881. Family ASTROPECTINID 2 (Gray), emend. Subfamily AstropPEcTININaz, Sladen. Genus AstTRoPECTEN, Linck. 1. As1ROPECTEN ANDERSONI,n.sp. (Plate XXVIII. figs. 1-4.) Localities. King Island (native name Padaw); Feb. 1882; sublittoral. Sullivan Island (native name Lampz); Feb. 1882; 10 fathoms. Rays five. R=50mm.; r=12 mm. R>4,. Breadth of a ray between the third and fourth supero-mar- ginal plates, 10°55 mm. The majority of the examples collected are about two thirds this size. Rays elongate, narrow, tapering gradually to the extremity, which is rather obtuse. Disk small. Interbrachial ares slightly rounded. The paxillar area is compact and uniform, from three to four times the breadth of the supero-marginal plates at about midway between the base and the extremity of the ray. The paxille are moderately large and distinctly stellate, the tabulum bearing in the centre from one to four short papilliform spinelets, and the ASTEROIDEA OF THE MERGUI ARCHIPELAGO. 323 margin surrounded by eight to twelve rather longer claviform spinelets, which radiate horizontally. There is a little diminution in the size of the paxille towards the centre of the disk, and much crowding, but no trace occurs of any epiproctal prominence or peak whatever, its position being frequently occupied by a slight invagination. The paxille are arranged in short transverse rows at the sides of the rays, the irregular median space being broad. The paxille become very small towards the end of the rays. The supero-marginal plates, which are about thirty in number from the median interradial line to the extremity, are small, rather higher than broad, the disproportion of the dimensions being greatest at the base of the ray, and appear slightly tumid when viewed from above. They are covered with papilliform granules which are uniform in size and shape, and not very clos-ly placed ; and fine cilia are present in the furrows between successive plates. Each supero-marginal plate bears near its abactinal margin a single erect tapering spinelet, the size of the spinelets decreasing gradually along the ray. The infero-marginal plates, which are broader than high, extend slightly beyond the level of the superior series, and form a gently rounded curve towards the actinal surface. Each plate bears a single elongate, delicate, subcylindrical, sharply pointed lateral spine, directed horizontally and at an angle of about 45° to the axis of the ray. Behind the lateral spine is a single small com- panion, similar in shape and character, but not more than one third the length. In large specimens the first miliary spinelet or squamule near this spine may be larger than any of the others; but there is no trace whatever of a transverse series of spinelets along the aboral margin of the plate. In large specimens there may also be a single small spine above and external to the larze lateral spine. The surface of the plate is covered with short papilliform spinelets rather than squamules, which are robust, uniform, and widely spaced ; and the furrows are occupied by numerous, more delicate and cilia-like spinelets. The armature of the adambulacral plates consists of short and rather robust spines, which form only two distinct series. The inner or furrow series consists of three short, cylindrical, slightly tapering spinelets, which radiate apart and arch over the furrow, the middle spine being longest. The outer series consists of two unequal spinelets, the aboral one being very large, robust. 324 MR. W. PERCY SLADEN ON THE conical and pointed, and the companion one little more than one fourth the length, cylindrical and obtusely tipped. The large robust spine stands perpendicularly, and the small papilla is usually directed at an angle towards the furrow and adorally. On the outer surface of the plates near the base of the ray, espe- cially in large examples, there may be one or two similar papilla ; but I do not consider them sufficiently important to rank as a third series. The mouth-plates are elongate and narrow, with a single row of eight to ten short, robust, conical spinelets on their surface, which are very small outwardly, but increase in length as they approach the mouth, the innermost spine being longer than any of the others and directed horizontally. On the free margin of the mouth-plate there is a lineal series of short, rather robust spinelets, directed horizontally, which increase in length as they approach the inner extremity of the plate ; the innermost spinelet, being very little shorter than the innermost spinelet of the super- ficial series above-mentioned and standing on the same level, forms with it the horizontal fan of mouth-spines which proceeds from each mouth-angle and covers the mouth. The madreporiform body is small, and situated at about its own diameter distant from the margin. . Colour in alcohol, a light shade of chocolate-brown, or an ashy grey, in the latter case being lighter. Remarks. This species is the most nearly related to Astro- pecten javanicus, Liitken, from which, however, it may be dis- tinguished by the narrow marginal plates, by the character of the adambulacral armature, and by the spinulation of the infero- marginal plates. The facies of the two forms is quite different, although, from its general structure, I am inclined to think that A. Andersoni is probably a descendant of A. javanicus, or of a common ancestor, modified by isolation and changed conditions of existence. 2. AstropecTEN Hempricuit, Miller § Troschel. Astropecten Hemprichii, Miller § Troschel, 1842, System der Asteriden, p. 71. ? Astropecten articulatus, Michelin, 1845, Essar d'une Faune de l'Ile Muurice, Mag. de Zool. 2¢ série, 7¢ année, p. 24 (non Asterias articulatus, Say, 1825). Astropecten mauritianus, Mobius, 1881, Beitr. z. Meeresfauna d. Insel Mauritius, p. 0 (non Astropecten mauritianus, Gray, 1840). ASTEROIDEA OF THE MERGUI ARCHIPELAGO. 325 Locality. Sir William James Island; 7th Dec. 1881. Remarks. I feel little hesitation in referring a single example to this species, which has recently been carefully described and figured by De Loriol* on the basis of material obtained from Mauritius. The type specimen, preserved in the Berlin Museum, was collected by Hemprich and Ehrenberg in the Red Sea. The form appears to be closely allied to Astropecten scoparius. 3. ASTROPECTEN NOTOGRAPTUS, n. sp. (Plate XXVIII. figs. 5-8.) Locality. King Island (native name Padaw). Rays five. R=165mm.; r=6mm. R>2‘5r. Breadth ofa ray between the second and third supero-marginal plates, 5°5 mm. Rays rather broad at the base, tapering rather rapidly on the outer portion to a pointed extremity. Interbrachial ares subacute. The paxillar area is wide, measuring more than three times the width of the supero-marginal plates about midway between the base and the extremity of the ray, and is very regular in composition. The paxille, which are large and compactly crowded, have a wide tabulum on which are borne from five to eight low uniform granules; and eight to eighteen very short papilliform spinelets, little more than elongate granules, surround the margin and radiate outward horizontally. In the centre of the disk a. well-developed conical peak is present. The supero-marginal plates, about seventeen or eighteen in number from the median interradial line to the extremity, are slightly broader than long, and form a well-developed rounded margin tothe ray. The surface of the plates is covered with large, slightly spaced granules which diminish a little in size at the margins, and become more or less cilia-like in the sutures or channels between neighbouring plates. On the innermost plate on each side of the median interradial line is a small, but well- developed tubercle ; but no spinelets or tubercles of any kind are borne on the other supero-marginal plates. The infero-marginal plates, which are much broader than high, do not extend beyond the superior series. Each plate bears a single lateral spine, of moderate length, which tapers throughout, is sharply pointed, cylindrical, and very slightly flattened. At the base of this spine are one or two small compressed spinelets * Mém. Soc. Phys. Hist. Nat. Genéve, t. xxix. No. 4, p. 74, pl. xxi. figs. 7, 8. 326 MR. W. PERCY SLADEN ON THE or enlarged squamules, one of which is usually more prominent and near the aboral margin of the plate. No other spinelets are present on the infero-marginal plates, which are covered with rather large, moderately well-spaced, uniform squamules. The armature of the adambuiacral plates consists of short robust spinelets, which form two distinct series and an indistinct median series. Theinner or furrow series consists of three short, robust, obtusely tipped spinelets which radiate apart and arch over the furrow, the middle spine being longest. The outer series consists of two spinelets which are shorter and more robust than the furrow series, and have a flat subspatulate form; and the aboral spinelet of the pair is frequently larger and much broader than its companion, but sometimes subequal. The indistinct median series consists of two very small papilliform spines, one placed on each maryin of the plate, which might almost be counted as the outer spinelets of a furrow series of five spinelets. The mouth-plates are elongate and narrow, with a single row of eight to ten short, robust, papilliform spinelets on their surface, which are small outwardly but increase in length as they approach the mouth, the innermost spinelet being longer than any of the others and directed horizontally. On the free margin of the mouth-plate there is a lineal series of short, rather robust spinelets, directed horizontaliy, which increase in length as they approach the inner extremity of the plate, the innermost spinclets being long and forming the horizontal fan of mouth-spines which pro- ceed from each mouth-angle and cover the mouth. The adambu- lacral plate adjoining the mouth-plate is much broader and shorter than the others, and bearsa lineal series of eight or nine short papilliform spinelets on each side, the two series being apposable. . The madreporiform body is entirely hidden by paxille. Colour in alcohol, an ashy grey mottled with lines and bars of chocolate-brown. On the inner third of the ray there is a line of colour adjacent to the marginal plates which is continuous with. and meets the corresponding band of the adjacent ray on the disk, forming a V-shaped mark thickened in the angle. At the junction of the median and outer third of the ray is a broad transverse band of colour which passes over the paxillar area and marginal plates uninterruptedly. Remarks. This species is allied to Astropecten granulatus, Miiller & Troschel ; but is distinguished by the character of the ASTEROIDEA OF THE MERGUI ARCHIPELAGO. 327 marginal plates, by the spinulation of the infero-marginal plates, and by the armature of the adambulacral plates. The presence of the small tubercle on the innermost pair of supero-marginal plates in the interbrachial are, and the colour markings also serve to distinguish the forms. -Astropecten notograptus presents several points of affinity with A. monacanthus, mihi; but the broad marginal plates, the large paxille, the simple spinulation of the infero-marginal plates, and the difference in the character of the adambulacral armature (although only slight) serve to distinguish the Mergui species. Subfamily Lurp1ina, Sladen. Genus Lutp1aA, Forbes. 1. Lurpra ForrFicirEr, Sladen. Luidia forficifer, Sladen, 1888, Zool. ‘Chall.’ Exp. part iis ., Report on Asteroidea, p. 258, pl. xliv. figs. 5 & 6, pl. xlv. figs. 5 & 6. Localities. King Island (native name Padaw); Feb. 1882. Sir William James Island ; 7th Dec. 1881. Remarks. One adult example, unfortunately in a bad state of preservation, and a small one, almost too young for accurate determination, appear to me to belong to this species. It was dredged during the ‘ Challenger’ Expedition in the Arafura Sea and in Torres Strait at a depth of 6 to 28 fathoms, on sea-bottoms of coral-mud and green mud. 2. Lurpra macunata, Willer & Troschel. Luidia maculata, Miller & Troschel, 1842, System der Asteriden, p. 77: Locality. King Island (native name Padaw); 24th Jan. 1882; sublittoral. A single young example having nine rays. The major radial dimension 1s 65 mm. Family PENTAGONASTERID A, Perrier. Subfamily Gontoptscina, Sladen. Genus Gonropiscus, Miller §& Troschel. 1. Gonropiscus artTicuLAtus (Linné), de Loriol. Asterias articulata, Linné, 1753, Mus. Tessinianum, p. 114, tab. ix. fig. 3. LINN. JOURN.—ZOOLOGY, VOL. XXI. 28 328 MR. W. PERCY SLADEN ON THE Artocreatis altera species, Seba, 1758, Thesaurus, t. iii. p. 11, tab. vi. figs. 7 & 8. Goniaster articulatus, Liitken, 1864, Videnskab. Medd. naturh. Foren. 7 Kjébenhavn, p. 147. Goniodiscus articulatus, De Loriol, 1854, Rec. Zool. Suisse, t.i. p. 638, pl. xxxv. figs. 1-17. Locality. King Island (native name Padaw); Jan. 1882; sub- littoral. : Remarks. This handsome form was described and figured by Linné in the ‘ Museum Tessinianum ;’ and the same example is © stated by Liitken* to have been the original of Seba’s figure in his ‘ Thesaurus,’ t. ii. pl. 6. figs. 7&8. Until four years ago the species—excepting the existence of the well-preserved type— might be said to have been lost sight of, and its locality was unknown. In 1884, M. P. de Loriol gave a careful description and excellent figures of an example collected at Singapore; he also discussed the erroneous views of previous writers on the species in question. With M. de Loriol’s determination I entirely agree ; and his description accords closely with the notes which I made when examining the Linnean type of Asterias articulata in the University Museum at Copenhagen. The specimen collected at Mergui by Dr. Anderson is inter- mediate in size between Linné’s specimen and that described by de Loriol, the measurements being R=66 mm.,r=34 mm. In general outline it approaches more nearly to the type than does de Loriol’s large example, the interbrachial are being more widely rounded, which causes the rays to appear rather more defined. In other respects the Mergui example accords closely with the description of that from Singapore; and I feel no doubt as to the specific identity of the three examples. Family ASTERINID & (Gray), emend. Perrier. Subfamily Astrrininm, Sladen. Genus Nrpantuta, Gray. 1. NEPANTHIA SUFFARCINATA, n. sp. (Plate XXVIII. figs. 9-12.) Locality. Owen Island; 2nd Jan. 1882. Rays five. R=48 mm.; r=138-15 mm. R>8r. Breadth of * Videnskab, Medd. naturh. Foren. i Kjobenhayn, f. 1864, p. 148. ASTEROIDEA OF THE MERGUI ARCHIPELAGO. 329 a ray at the base, 15 mm.; breadth at 10 mm. from the base, 10 mm. — Rays elongate, semicylindrical, flattened actinally, broad and inflated at the base, then rapidly becoming narrower, and main- taining a nearly uniform breadth until near the extremity, which is obtusely rounded. Interbrachial arcs acute. Abactinal area of the disk more or less inflated, marked with well-defined channels along the median interradial lines which extend nearly to the centre. Actinal surface plane; with the margin abruptly angular. The abactinal area is covered with small, narrow, conspicuously crescent-shaped plates, which are disposed in regular alternating longitudinal rows. Within the concavity is placed a single papula, which is guarded on its adcentral side by small plates (usually two in number, but sometimes more are present), ail included within the are of the crescentiform plates. The plates bear a great number of uniform microscopic spinelets which form a compact velvet-like covering. The plates along the sides of the ray are somewhat modified in form, often appearing jawbone- shaped rather than crescent-shaped, and the longitudinal dispo- sition of the series is even more conspicuous than in the median radial region. . The marginal plates are very small, and the infero-marginal series forms the angular ambitus of the ray, the superior series being quite in the lateral wall of the ray. The plates of the inferior series are slightly larger and more definite than their companions, and all bear compact groups of microscopic spinelets similar to those on the abactinal plates. The armature of the adambulacral plates consists of:—(1) A furrow series of 7 or 8 spinelets united by membrane, which radiate apart, and form a fan slightly obliquely placed and high in the furrow; the spinelets are cylindrical, obtusely tipped, and the middle ones are longer than the others. (2) On the actinal surface of the plate is an obliquely placed semicircular fan of 5 or 6 obtusely conical, robust, papilliform spinelets which radiate apart ; and behind these is an irregular tuft of minute cilia-like spinelets. In the actinal interradial areas four longitudinal rows of inter- mediate plates extend along the ray up to the extremity ; on the disk four other rows may be counted, but these die out gradually, and do not extend far beyond the base of the ray. The plates of 28* 330 THE ASTEROIDEA OF THE MERGUI ARCHIPELAGO. the series adjacent to the adambulaeral plates are slightly larger than any of the others; and all the intermediate plates bear com- pact tufts of numerous microscopic conical and sharply pointed spinelets. The madreporiform body is rather large, and is situated nearer the centre of the disk than midway between that point and the margin. Its surface, which is somewhat undulating, is marked with wide and much convoluted striations. Several prominent small plates surround the margin. Colour in alcohol, a dirty ashy grey, with a slightly brownish shade. Remarks. This species in some respects occupies an inter- mediate. position between Mepanthia maculata, Gray, and Ne- panthia brevis, Perrier; but it differs from both of these by its general facies, by the different character of the lateral series of plates along the ray, by the small, truly crescentiform plates of the median abactinal area, and by the character of the armature of the adambulacral plates. Genus Asterina, Nardo. 1. ASTERINA CEPHEUS (Miller & Troschel), v. Martens. Asteriscus cepheus, Valenciennes, MS. Asterina Burtonii, Gray, 1840, Ann. § Mag. Nat. Hist. vol. vi. p: 289. Asteriscus cepheus, Miiller & Troschel, 1842, System der Asteriden, . 41, Asterina cepheus, v. Martens, 1866, Archiv f. Naturgesch. Jahrg. xxxii. Ba. i. p. 85. Localities. King Island (native name Padaw); Feb. 1882. Sir William James Island ; 7th Dec. 1881. Remarks. The examples of this species collected in the Mergui Archipelago are rather more discoid than usual, the interbrachial arcs being less incurved than usual; the spinulation also is much more delicate and cilia-like. The differences, how- ever, do not appear to me to be sufficient to warrant their recog- nition by name ; and a good series of examples is desirable before they can be ranked as a variety with any degree of certainty. MAMMALS ELC. FROM THE MERGUI ARCHIPELAGO. 331 DESCRIPTION OF PLATE XXVIII. Fig. 1. Astropecten Andersoni, n. sp. Abactinal aspect, magnified 14 dia- meters. 2. 4 a Actinal aspect, magnified 13 diameters. 3. Pe * A portion of the abactinal surface, magnified 15 diameters. 4. B 59 Adambulacral and infero-marginal plates, magnified 8 diameters. 5. Astropecten notograptus, n.sp. Abactinal aspect, magnified 3 dia- meters. 6. 3 - Actinal aspect, magnified 3 dia- meters. We y . A portion of the abactinal surface, magnified 40 diameters, 8. * bp Adambulacral and infero-marginal plates, magnified 14 diameters. 9. Nepanthia suffarcinata, n. sp. Abactinal aspect, magnified 13 dia- meters. 10. 5 - Actinal aspect, magnified 14 diameters. 11. " mi A portion of the abactinal surface, magnified 15 diameters. 12. % fs Adambulacral plates and adjacent por- tion of the actinal surface, magni- fied 15 diameters. Report on the Mammals, Reptiles, and Batrachians, chiefly from the Mergui Archipelago, collected for the Trustees of the Indian Museum. By Joun AnpeErson, M.D., LL.D., F.BS., E.LS., F.Z.8., &c. [Read 20th June, 1889. ] As the object of the Expedition sent by the Indian Museum to Mergui was to bring together materials for the illustration of the marine fauna of that portion of the Bay of Bengal, it was impos- sible to undertake a systematic investigation of the vertebrate fauna of the islands themselves. A small collection, however, of Mammals, Reptiles, and Batra- chians was formed, and itis now proposed to place the names of the species on record. The Mammalia number 23, the Reptilia 53, and the Batrachia 12 species. 332 DR°J. ANDERSON ON TIE MAMMALS, REPTILES, AND Among the five species of bats represented in the collection, Emballonura semicaudata is new to the Malayan Peninsula; while another, Pteropus edulis, is also an addition to the fauna of the Mergui district. A large bat, probably this species, occurs like- ‘wise on the islands in the neighbourhood of Sullivan or Lampi Island to the south. A race of Sus scrofa is the mammal most generally distri- buted over the Archipelago. It is found on all the large islands, and on islands not over a square mile in extent. It is known to occur as far west as the Elphinstone group to the north, and Clara Island to the south, these two localities, with King Island and Mergui, being the northern and southern limits of my obser- vations. Whether this animal extends to the most westerly chain of islands, stretching from Tenasserim island in the north to Great Western Torres in the south, has not been ascertained, as these islands have not been explored. Tragulus Kanchil is another feature of the Archipelago, and is almost as widely distributed as the pig. On Elphinstone Island it was nearly as numerous as on King Island and at Mergui, where the undergrowth of the forest is alive with it at sundown. After these two species, the squirrels, Sciwrus caniceps and S. bicolor, are the mammals most commonly seen. Arctogale leucotis occurs on King, Owen, and Sullivan Islands, thus rendering it probable that it has a wide distribution over the Archipelago. Paradoxurus hermaphroditus, on the other hand, was only observed on King Island. The two monkeysfound on the islands are Semnopithecus obscu- gus and Macacus cynomolgus; the former being the more widely distributed, while the latter seems to be more confined to the islands near the mainland, where mud-banks are exposed at low water, the food of this monkey consisting largely of Crustacea found in such situations. Tupaia ferruginea is very abundant in the neighbourhood of the few villages on the banks of a creek at the head of the bay, on the north-eastern side of King Island. It was also met with on arecent clearing made by some Selungs in the centre of the island, and again on Elphinstone and Sullivan Islands. The only locality in which I observed the nocturnal Wycticebus tardigradus was King Island, an island intimately linked to the mainland by a succession of islets separated from each other by narrow channels. BATRACIIIANS OF THE MERGUL ARCHIPELAGO. 330 The tiger is found on all the large islands close to the main- land, its most western range being King and Domel Islands; and on the former it is said to be so numerous and aggressive, that the few villagers, on the eastern side, seldom venture into the forest; and at the village of Taing, at the head of the creek already mentioned, it is unsafe to penetrate into the jungle, as the Burmese and Karens settled there wage war on the animal by setting formidable dart- or spear-traps, the triggers of which, so to speak, are thread-like fibres stretched across the runs of wild animals, and, if broken through, entail almost certain death. The tiger, however, is unknown on such western islands as the Elphinstone and Grant groups, and on Sullivan Island, 70 miles to the south and distant about 10 miles from the coast; but it occurs on Campbell aud Forbes Islands to the south of Kisseraing, the former being separated from the main- land by a channel only one mile in width, whereas the latter is eight miles in breadth, but linked to the coast by two small inter- mediate islands, the widest sea-passage being three miles. Both elephants and rhinoceroses find their way on to the island of Kisseraing ; but the former are unknown on any of the other islands. The latter, however, I was informed by Mr. Leslie, of the Maleewon Police, whose duties frequently took him past Campbell and Forbes Islands, occurred on those islands; but whether Rhinoceros sondaicus, the dried hide of which is sold in Mergui bazaars for food, or a two-horned species, he could not say. He also told me that he had once met a two-horned rhinoceros swimming in the sea close to High Island, about twenty miles distant from the mainland, but with islands everywhere in sight. The names of the less prominent mammals met with are recorded in the accompanying list; but all the species, with the exception of the two bats already mentioned and Rhizomys ery- throgenys, are well-known forms on the neighbouring mainland. One of the features of the Reptilian fauna of the Archipelago is the occurrence of Crocodilus porosus in the neighbourhood of almost every island of any size, at least within the area that came under my observation. The great bay on the eastern side of King Island is fringed by mangrove swamps, through which some small freshwater streams fiow. The detritus brought down by these streams has converted the head of the bay into a great mud-bank continuous with the mangrove swamps, and at low water it 1s an 334 DR. J. ANDERSON ON THE MAMMALS, REPTILES, AND extensive mud-flat cut up by the narrow channels down which the streams run. Near its seaward extremity there are a few wooded islets, their rocky beaches facing the sea being rich in corals and Gorgonie, partially visible at the lowest tides, while their other sides continuous with the mud-flats are covered with stony patches, among which are found brilliantly coloured sponges, Pennatulide and Actinie occurring in profusion in the soft deep mud of the great bank. Among these remarkable estuarine conditions this crocodile is frequently seen basking at low water on the banks of the seaward extensions of the streams close to the corals and sponges. On the other hand, it is equally abundant on the rocky shores of Elphinstone, Domel, and Sullivan Islands, all of which are more or less surrounded by coral, washed by the salt sea. The lizard, Varanus salvator, was also met with on all the islands I visited. Calotes Emma is the tree-lizard most frequently seen on the islands; whereas C. versicolor appears to be the species most prevalent at Mergui. The call of the great gecko, G. verticillatus, became a familiar sound to me at night during my sojourn in the Archipelago; and Hemidactylus frenatus I found to be common at the village of Taing, on King Island. Among the shrubs and Casuarina-trees fringing in some places the western shore of Sullivan Island, Draco teniopterus was not uncommon; and I also found it on Elphinstone Island, and observed it in considerable numbers among the dorian and man- gosteen orchards of the eastern side of King Island ; but I did not meet with a single specimen of D. maculatus, which occurs at Mergui along with the former. The skink, Lygosoma maculatum, is much more prevalent and seemingly more widely distributed than Mabuia multifasciata, as it occurs at Mergui, and on King, Elphinstone, and Sullivan Islands, whereas the latter species, which is common at Mergui and on King Island, was not found at Elphinstone Island, and only one specimen was obtained at Sullivan Island. Five snakes were found on Elphinstone Island, viz. Compsosoma melanurum, Tropidonotus chrysargus, Tragops prasinus, Bothrops gramineus, and B. purpureus ; whereas on the much larger King Island, so intimately connected with the mainland, ten species, all distinct from the former, were obtained, viz. Zropidonotus jumceus, BATRACHIANS OF TITLE MERGUI ARCHIPELAGO. 335 PT. nigrocinctus, T. trianguligerus, Hypsirhina enhydris, Hipistes hydrinus, Psammodynastes pulverulentus, Python reticulatus, Naja tripudians, and Ophiophaqus elaps—forms all more or less aquatic in their habits; and a Bothrops, possibly B. cantoris or B. porphyra- ceus, Blyth. Only four species were procured on Sullivan Island, viz. Tropidonotus gunceus, Lycodon aulicus, Dipsas carinata, and Python reticulatus. Vhreesnakes—Tragops prasinus, Naja tripu- dians, aud another example of the foregoing unnamed Bothrops— were encountered on Kisseraing Island in the course of a few hours, which would seem to indicate that that island is rich in snakes. Of the foregoing serpents, Tropidonotus chrysargus and Dipsas carinata are apparently new to the Tenasserim pro- vince. The Hydrophids are extensively represented in the harbour of Mergui, which lies on the seaward face of an island formed by two mouths of the Tenasserim river. The mud-flats lying between these two mouths are studded over with extensive fishing-stakes of an ingenious description, into which the shoals of fish, and the Hydrophids that follow them, have their course directed by long lines of palisades terminating towards the sea in a large ‘chamber from which they fail to escape. At low water, from a platform, the fishermen visit the chambers, and ladle out the contents by means of hand-nets. In this way I obtained nine species of Hydrophids, whereas although I had spent some hours almost daily in the sea among the islands, I did not observe a single species of this genus in any of the localities I visited. It is therefore probable that the species obtained at Mergui are more or less estuarine in their habits, and do not select thoroughly marine situations for their feeding-grounds. The nine species were the following, viz.: H. Jerdoni, H. robusta, H. latifasciata, HH. cyanocincta, H. gracilis, H. stricticollis, H. Jayakari, H. Hardwicku, and Enhydrina valakadyn. The only two of those species hitherto recorded from Mergui are H. Jerdoni and H. latifasciata; but besides the nine, H. nigrocincta, H. striatus, and H. trachyceps * occur in the strong tide-way of the harbour. H. Jayakari is a recently described species from near Muscat f. Chelone mydas is found among the islands; but the only one * It is possible that this species described by Theobald may prove to be Hi, cyanocincta. Tt Boulenger, Ann. & Mag. Nat. Hist. vol. xx. Dec. 1887, p. 408. 336 DR. J. ANDERSON ON THE MAMMALS observed by me was a small specimen that had been captured by the Selungs for food. The only Batrachian worthy of note is the frog, Rana Dorie, recently described by Boulenger from North Tenasserim, and of which I obtained twenty specimens on King and Elphinstone Islands; so thatit is probably widely distributed over the province of Tenasserim. MAMMALIA. Order PRIMATES. Family CERCOPITHECIDS. SEMNOPITHECUS OBSCURUS, Ledd. 1 adult ¢, Elphinstone Island; 2 adults and 1 young 9, Mergui. Common in the forests about Mergui and on the islands of the Archipelago, in large parties, including individuals of all ages. Macacus cynomoraus, Schreber. 1 adult ¢, caught in the fishing-stakes in Mergui harbour. This species occurs on the Mergui coast and in the forest skirting the banks of tidal streams, where it may be observed at low water on the muddy banks, wandering either alone or in small scattered parties, inserting its arm into holes and burrows in the mud in search of the Crustacea which form part of its food, and which it pulls out and devours. I also saw it in similar situations on the islands near the mainland. Order PROSIMI. Family NycricEBIDS. NYcTICEBUS TARDIGRADUS, Linn. 1 adult 9, King Island. This belongs to the small and dark variety that occurs in Eastern Bengal (Chittagong), and ranges through Ar akan south- wards to the extremity of the Malayan peninsula and to some of the neighbouring islands. OF THE MERGUI ARCHIPELAGO. 307 Order CHIROPTERA. Family Preropopipa. PrEROPUS EDULIS, Geoffroy. 1 adult ¢, Taing, King Island. Every evening at sunset numerous large bats, sometimes in great flocks, appeared over the mangosteen, dorian, and areca- palm orchards of the village of Taing, on King Island. The natives asserted that they came from a low-lying densely wooded islet between King Island and Mergui, on the trees of which they hung during the daytime inan immense multitude. The expanded wings of the male measured 5 feet across within a few tenths of aninch. A large Pteropus observed by me at Sullivan Island is also probably this species. It has been found on the Andaman and Nicobar Islands ; but this is seemingly the first time that it has been recorded from the province of Tenasserim ; it has, however, been found at Klang in the Straits of Malacca *. — Family VESPERTILIONIDA, VesPERUGO PACHYPUS, Zemm. 3 3g and3 2, found in the hollow of an old tree, Taing, King Island. VESPERTILIO MURICOLA, Hodgson. 7g and 11 9, Yimiki, King Island, and 4 g and7 9, Taing, King Island. The specimens from Taing were found between the leaves of plantain trees. Family EMBALLONURID&. EMBALLONURA SEMICAUDATA, Peale. 8 g and 6 Q, Sullivan Island; from a small cave in a cliff on the shore, where it occurred in wnenk numbers. Until quite recently this species was known only from the Polynesian subregion and Sarawak +; but its presence at Pulo * Thomas, Proc. Zool. Soc. Lond. 1886, p. 73. + Dobson, Brit. Assoc. Rep. 1880, p. 193. 338 DR. J. ANDERSON ON THE MAMMALS Nias has been noticed during the present year by the Marquis Doria*. Order CARNIVORA. Family Fevip 2. Ferris riers, Linn. 1 adult 2, Taing, King Island. Tip of nose to vent 5 feet 4°30 inches; length of tail 2 feet 4°50 inches. Family VIVERRID &. PARADOXURUS HERMAPHRODITUS, Pallas; Blanford, Fauna of Brit. Ind. §c., Mammalia (1888), p. 108. 1 2 anda ¢ and 9, King Islandf. One of these females had the following dimensions in life :— inches Miprot nose sto wente-pecee sre tees oe ee Ienethyotsballeeerecereree eee neers 18 a ge eM MO Ob E ee ke. saphcaceete 3 ALO) OLE INOS FO CYS cadgnaaos ocasoooogasarce 1°70 HS VE RLOMCAT RMR CR sje acrcicist naan 1:30 This individual was so dark-coloured, that when describing it immediately after death it was entered in my notes as black; but since then (1882) the fur has assumed a distinct brownish tinge. The penis of this species is densely covered with small recurved spines. ARCTOGALE LEUVCOTIS, Blyth; Blanford, 1. ce. p. 115. 1 S, King Island. The dimensions of the living animal were as follows :— inches. Mipyok mosekto) velt puesta eeeaeeee 19 Wenethvotatarl eee eco eee eee 2k a 43 ATM CietOOl den. snomeetancen eee 3:25 ip fOr OSE) GOLCY eC me..e seeder eee 1:70 By 5t0 @Ar oc. cmesitaiaegs store kee eascees 1°30 * Annali del Mus. Civ. di Storia Nat. di Genova, 1889. t These are the specimens mentioned by Mr. Blanford, Proc. Zool. Soc. Lond. 1885, p. 791. OF THE MERGUI ARCHIPELAGO. 339 The general colour was fulvous grey. A feeble line down the back, the muzzle, a spot behind the ear, the feet, and the tip of the tail were brown. I also observed it on Owen and Sullivan Islands. Order INSECTIVORA. Family Tupatip 2. TUPAIA FERRUGINEA, Raffles; Blanford, Fauna of Brit. Ind. (1888), p. 210. 1 g, Mergui; 4 King Island; and 1 Elphinstone Island. Order RODENTIA. Family Scrur1p2. Preromys ora, Tickell; Anderson, An. Zool. Res. 1878, p- 279. 1 g adult, Mergui; 1 juv., Sullivan Island (January). The adult closely resembles an example (B.M. Register, No. 84. 7. 30. 1) of P. oral from the Nilgiris in the British Museum, and another in the same collection (Reg. No. 45. 8. 12. 8) from Travancore, and a third (Reg. No. 65. 5. 20. 2) from an elevation of 4500 to 5000 feet on the Anamallies, but differs from them in the trifling detail of having the latter half of its tail nearly white instead of black. In the British Museum there is a specimen (Reg. No. 85. 8. 1. 125) obtained by Mr. Davison at Kankaryit in Tenasserim* corresponding to P. cineraceus, Blyth; and another+ (Reg. No. 88. 8. 1. 124) collected by the same naturalist at Wimpong Thatone, also in Tenasserim, that 1s intermediate in its coloration between the Mergui and the young individual from Sullivan Island. In the island of Ceylon also, indi- viduals are found resembling the richly coloured variety occurring on the continent, and others that might be referred to P. cine- raceus. The specimen (77. 3. 14. 11) in the British Museum is an example of the former, and the skin (77. 3. 14. 9) of the latter. Moreover, flying-squirrels of this species well tinged with grey, and in which the chestnut colour of the upper parts is almost absent, are found in the Madras Presidency. * Thomas, Proc. Zool. Soc. 1886, p. 67. t Thomas, ibid. 340 DR. J. ANDERSON ON THE MAMMALS ScIURUS CANICEPS, Gray. 2adult g (January), 1 adult 9 (January), and 1 9 (March), Mergui; 1 adult 9 (February), King Island; 1 adult 3g and 2 adult @ (March), Elphinstone Island; and 1 3 (January), Sul- livan Island. These specimens agree with the squirrels from Mergui described by Blyth as exhibiting “ merely a faint mark of ferruginous, and this chiefly on the sides of the neck and body”’*. ScIURUS BICOLOR, Sparrm. 1 3, Mergui; 2 King Island; and 1 ¢, Elphinstone Island. Scrurvs BerpMoret, Blyth. 1d and 1 Q@ (January), King Island. Measurements of the adult female :— inches Miplotmose hove liber: eee ees eae 8:20 emo tlaworatenll x geracrsre ce crclac ache INDEX. Thalysias, 70. subtriangularis, Duch. § Mich., 70. tener, Carter, 62, 70. Thamala miniata, Moore, 42, 60. Thanaos indistineta, Moore, 53. Thecaphora, Hincks, 132. Thenea Wallichii, Wright, 81. Thermesia signipalpis, Walh., 58. reticulata, Walk., 58. Thermesiide, 58. Thyone sacellus, Sedenka, 27. Tirumala Gautama, Moore, 29. Limniace, Cram., 29. septentrionis, Butl., 29. Tornatella solidula, Z., 199. Tornatellide, 199. Trabala irrorata, Moore, 55. Trachycomus ochrocephalus, 142. Tragops prasinus, Reinw., 334, 335, 346. Tragulide, 341. Tragulus Kanchil, Raffles, 332, 341. Trepsichrois Linnzi, Moore, 31. Treron nipalensis, Hodgs., 152. Tridaena crocea, Lamk., var. Cumingii, Reeve, 209. squamosa, Lamk., 209, Tridacnidx, 209. Tridacophyllia, 9. lactuca, Pallas, 2, 9. Tringa minuta, Leis/., 153. Tringoides hypoleucus, Z., 153. Trionychide, 342. Trionyx subplanus, Geoff,, 342. Tritonia, sp., 200. Tritoniide, 200. Trochidz, 195. Trochita extinctorum, Zamk., 193. sinensis, ., 193. Trochus maculatus, var., Kiener, 196. maximus, Koch, 196. niloticus, Z., 196. obeliscus, Gmel., 196. tentorium, Reeve, 196, tubiferus, Kiener, 196. (Obeliscus) pyramis, Born, 196. (Polydonta) concinnus, Philippi, 196. ( ) costatus, Gmel., 196. (——) maculatus, Z., 196. ( ) radiatus, Gmel., 196. Tronga Bremeri, Feld., 30. Trophonia eruca, Clapar., 262. Tropidonotus bellulus, Stoliczka, 345. chrysargus, Schlegel, 334, 335, 346. junceus, Cantor, 334, 335, 345. nigrocinctus, Blyth, 835, 345. punctulatus, Giinther, 346. subminiatus, Reinw., 345. trianguligerus, Reinw., 335, 345. Gmel., 371 Tupaia ferruginea, Raffles, 332, 339. Tupatide, 339. Turbinaria, 20. cinerascens, So/., 3, 20. crater, Pallas, 3, 20. Turbinolide, Ed. § H., 2, 3, 6, 24. reptantes, Dune., 6. Turbo argyrostomus, Z., 195. articulatus, Reeve, 195. concinnus, Dhilippi-Kiister, 195. erassus, Gray, 199. margaritaceus, Z., 195. marmoratus, Z., 195. versicolor, Chemn., 195. cea porphyrites, Martyn, 195. Turdinus Abbotti, B/., 141. Turnix plumbipes, Hodgs., 152. Turritella cingulifera, Svw., 192. columnaris, Kiener, 192. fastigiata, Adams § Reeve, 192. Fragilis, Kiener, 192. trisuleata, Lamk., 192. Turritellidee, 192. Turtur tigrinus, Temm., 152. Ulastrea crispata, Hd. & H., 12. Ulex, 65. Ungulata, 341. Unio marginalis, Zamk., 165. Urtica nayalis, 134. Vadebra Pheretima, Hew., 43. Varanide, 343. Varanus nebulasus, Gray, 344. salvator, Laur., 334, 348. Velutinidee, 188. Veneride, 210. Venus cancellata, Chemn., 212. cochinchinensis, Sow., 212. corbis, Lamk., 212. gallus, Spengl., 213. intuspunctata, Philippi, 214. sinuosus, var., Lamk., 214. Listeri, var., Sow., 212. rimosa, Philippi, 213. textile, Gmel., 213. (Anaitis) calophylla, Jonas, 212. (Antigona) reticulata, Z., 212. ( ) erispata, Desh., 212. (SSR Rus) squamosa, J., 212. (Timoclea) arakanensis, Nevill, 212. (——) imbricata, Sow., 212. (——) scabra, Hanley, 212. Veretillese, 268, 281. Verrucella gemmacea, Milne-Edw. & Haime, 241. Vespertilio muricola, Hodgs., 337. LINN. JOURN.—ZOOLOGY, VOL. XXI. 32 372 INDEX. Vespertilionidee, 337. Xenopeltis unicolor, Remw,., 344. Vesperugo pachypus, Zemm., 337. Xiphigorgia, 238. Viperide, 348. Virgularia, 277, 278, 280. Ypthima Baldus, Fadr., 32. juncea, Rumph., 278. Hibneri, Kirb., 32. Lovenii, K6ll., 280. Marshalli, Butl., 32. prolifera, Marsh. § Fowler, 267, Philomela, Hiibn., 32. 279, 280, 286. Rumphii, Kol/., 267, 277. Zanclopteryx saponaria, Walk., 57. Virgulariex, 267, 277. Zebronia plutusalis, Walk., 59. Virgulariide, 267. Zemeros Flegyas, Cram., 38. Vitessa Suradeva, Moore, 58. Zephronia, 291. Viverride, 328. Zerenide, 57. Vulsella lingua-felis, Reeve, 204. Zetides Agamemnon, L., 50. Zizera pygmeea, Snell., 39. Xantholema hzmacephala, Mil/., 150. Sanegra, Moore, 39. Xenopeltidx, 344. Zygeenide, 54. END OF THE TWENTY-FIRST VOLUME. PRINTED BY TAYLOR AND FRANCIS, RED LION COURT, FLEET STRENT. Mergui Exped. an SOC. JOURN. iSyOity «Weis CML IEG AL * { A.S.Foord. del et ith. Mintern Bros. imp. Jann. Soc. Journ. Zoon Vou. XXL Bu] PM Duncan dir Mintern Bros. ung 4 MADREPORARIA FROM MERGUI! A.S, Foord del et lith MES RARIA 20M MERGUI!. Mergui Exped . LInn.Soc.JOuRN. Zoo Vou.XXI.PL.2. X 450 Berjeau lth 3 CUCUMARIA FORBEST. 4.C.ASSIMILIS. Hanhart imp. Mergui Exped Linn. Soc. Journ. Zoou.Vou. XXIPL.3. HKnight.Chrome ‘ith West, Newman imp. LEPIDOPTERA, MERGUI ARCHIPELAGO. Mergui Exped. _ Linn. Soc. Journ. Zoon. Vou. XXIPL.4. H Knight Chromo_ith. £ West, Newman imp. LEPIDOPTERA, MERGUI ARCHIPELAGO. Linn. eae. Journ. Zoot. Vou. XX. Mergui Exped. Mintern imp. SPONGES, MERGUI ARCHIPELAGO. Berjeau del et hth. re soe Te Linn. Soc.Journn. Zoon. Vou. XXI. Px. 6. Mergui Exped. Mmtern mp. SPONGES , MERGUI ARCHIPELAGO. Berjeau del et hth. Mergui Exped. Linn. Soc. Journ. Zoou. Vow. XX. P1.7. Berjeau de et Lith. SPONGES, MERGUI ARCHIPELAGO. Mintern amp. Linn. Soc. Journ. Zoo. Von. XX. Pi. Mergur Exped . Mintern amp. OPHIURIDZA. MERGUI Berjean del et. ith. eT saa “eed $a; Pa ee raga 7 PT ea Beers » ‘ Pan BY ¥ wa + - ‘ 4 2 a Lee h + ; ny, oan Ma's ; r a ; fai! eae ‘ ¥ + * a 4, oc “ ~ « sy f a A M 4, ae i aie th ‘ = : ; ° 1 i 4 ¥ ae ee aiea. 3h : é : : it Linn. Soc. Journ, Zoon. Vou. XX1. Ph. 2. Mergui Exped. P.M.Duncan dir. MERGUI OPHIURIDA . Mantern. . mp Berjeau del et hth. Bevjeau del et lith Linn. Soc. Journ. Zoot .Vou. XXI. Px.10. P.M. Duncan .dir STRUGIURE OF OPHIURIDA Mintern imp. FF Linn. Soc. Journ. Zoot .Vor. XX]. Pull. oe 1 Ses eae PTT Aa PVD big 9 imp i) M Duncan dir Mintermn Berjean del et hth TRUCT URE OF OPHIUIRIDA a no) Linn. Soc. Journ. Zoot Vou. XXI.Pl.12. Mergiuar Exped. oe a Hincks del. Sele 1S) R HYDROZOA & POLYZOA OF MERGUI ARCHIPELAGO. West Newman ump. Hollickhth Mergui Exped ; tergur | k del . D? Hoe Hammond lth . DICHELASPIS PELLUCIDA , Darwin Mergur hxped, Linn. Soc.Jdournwn. ZoorVon.XX1.P1. 14. Prof. E won Martens #. Duval, del West Newman, Chromo lith CYCLOPHORUS AURANTIACUS vars. Mergui Exped. Linn. Soc. Journ.Zoon Vor. XXI.P).15 West,Newman,Chramo-lith 7, 8. C.HXPANSUS 9.C ZEBRINUS va AMBIGUUS Mergut Focped.. Liw.Soc. Journ. Zoon.Vou.XX1.P1.16. E Durvai,del. Prof. E.von Martens West Newmen, Garomo-ith, iLa-c, NASSA THERSITES var 2a-& LITTORINA RUBROPICTA. eas, ISANDA 2PULUHELGA, Lord, MYTILUS CURVATUS. 5 a-C, MYTILUS ANDERSON. 6o0-b ME SODHSMA AIQUILATHRUM, 7o-b LUVRARTIA NICOBARIGA . Benjeau & Highley del. et hth. ALCYONIDA & GORGONIIDE. Linn. Soc. Journ. Zoor.Vou.XX1. Pu. 18. Berjeau & Highley del. et hth. Mintern Bros. imp. GORGONUDA: & MELITHA IDA: Mergm Exped. Linn. Soc. Journ. Zoo... Vou. XX! Pi. 12) A.C Ml. del. 2 Berjeau & Highley bitin. Mintern Bros. imp. MYRIACTIS TUBICOLA,¢.& spn. A.C.H. det Linn. Soc. Journ. Zoor,. Vou. XX. Pu. peer i ais ¥ r Berjeau & Wighley lth Mintern Bros HORMATHIA ANDERSON], spn 20. Imp Carter hth. Nantern imp. ANNELIDS FROM MERGUI. : LD az WY NOE. — oc. JouRN.. Z00L < | Lin, Mergui Exped . 151 jarmmond hth, Hanhert imo ae AMM. and GHB. < cere i FADS Mery “ i at — Mergui Exped . | Luyw. Soc. Joan, Zoor Vor. XXT. Pr. NO 1EN AHM.and G.HF. del . = aramond.lith Hanhart imp. il Merqui Exped . b) earn et At il DADO ALL OBI SPP SPIED OGM PENNATULIDA OF MERGUI ARCHIPELAGO . ey Merguz Exped, Linn. Soe. Journ. Zoor,.Vor,. XXL.P1 24. Berjean & Highley dith. West, Newman &Co imp MYRIOPODA OF THE MERGUI ARCHIPELAGO. Lisw. Sec. Jounn. Zoot. Vor. XXI . PL 25. E.L.P. del Berjeau& Highley lith. West Newman d&Co imp MYRIOPODA OF THE MERGUI ARCHIPRLAGO. CourrpentEer Berjeau &Highley, del et lith. 1-5, ANTEDON £ 6-10, ACTINOMB1 anw, Soc.Journ. Zoo .Vou. XXL. PL ac. i! Nevwanan & C2 imp. rv cs TT; . ONT, Sp. 7m OTATA, Sp.tv. = iw) x Linn. Soc. Journ. Zoot Vat XX1. PL27. Berjeau &lhghley delet lith. West,Newman &Co.1mp. 1,2 ANTEDON CONJUNGENS Carp 5 5,A.SPICATA, Carp. 6,7.A.MILBERTI, Mill,sp. 8.4.ANDERSONI, sp nv. Sladen. FH. Michael del, et lth. linn. Soc. Journ. Zoor,. Vor. XX PEa2e MERGUI. Mintern. Bros. imp.